Nothing Special   »   [go: up one dir, main page]

Oor Pho - V O OOR PHO Syst MS: Nstallation Iagrams: D NE IDE D NE E I D

Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 244

INDEX - DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: INSTALLATION DIAGRAMS

INDEX
DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: INSTALLATION DIAGRAMS

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR


PHONE SYSTEMS:
Installation Diagrams

http://www.urmetdomus.com
e-mail:info@urmetdomus.it
MT 101-014D (Rev. December 2006)
DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

INDEX - DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: INSTALLATION DIAGRAMS

INDEX
DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: INSTALLATION DIAGRAMS

II

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

INDEX - DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: INSTALLATION DIAGRAMS

INDEX
DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: INSTALLATION DIAGRAMS

INSTALLATION DIAGRAMS

Sec. 1

(Index at the beginning of section)

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS


4+N WIRE ELECTRONIC SYSTEMS

Sec. 1A

(Index at the beginning of section)

1+1 WIRE ELECTRONIC SYSTEMS

Sec. 1B

(Index at the beginning of section)

TRADITIONAL CALL SYSTEMS

Sec. 1C

(Index at the beginning of section)

VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS


COAX ELECTRONIC SYSTEMS

Sec. 1D

(Index at the beginning of section)

5-WIRE ELECTRONIC SYSTEMS

Sec. 1E

(Index at the beginning of section)

INSTRUCTIONS FOR INTERCHANGE OF VARIOUS POWER SUPPLIES


AND MONITORS

Sec. 1F

(Index at the beginning of section)

EASIVOICE SYSTEM

Sec. 2

(Index at the beginning of section)

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

III

INDEX - DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: INSTALLATION DIAGRAMS

INDEX
DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: INSTALLATION DIAGRAMS

NUMERIC INDEX
Diagram Code

Sec. Pag.

SC101-0249E .................................................................... 1a .......... 32


SC101-0252D.................................................................... 1a .......... 22
SC101-0289 I .................................................................... 1a .......... 28
SC101-0440B.................................................................... 1c ............ 4
SC101-0441C.................................................................... 1c ............ 6
SC101-0461B.................................................................... 1c ............ 8
SC101-0482D.................................................................... 1a .......... 58
SC101-0567E .................................................................... 1a .......... 54
SC101-0578G ................................................................... 1a .......... 42
SC101-0735D ................................................................... 1a .......... 60
SC101-0791E ................................................................... 1a .......... 24
SC101-0839D ................................................................... 1a .......... 44
SC101-0844E ................................................................... 1a .......... 50
SC101-0858C ................................................................... 1a ............ 2
SC101-0861D ................................................................... 1a .......... 36
SC101-0863E ................................................................... 1a .......... 38
SC101-0866G ................................................................... 1a .......... 52
SC101-0932C ................................................................... 1b ............ 4
SC101-0937B ................................................................... 1b ............ 8
SC101-1070C ................................................................... 1a .......... 26
SC101-1133C ................................................................... 1a ............ 4
SC101-1134E ................................................................... 1a .......... 56
SC101-1135F.................................................................... 1b ............ 2
SC101-1209C ................................................................... 1a .......... 14
SC101-1210B ................................................................... 1b ............ 6
SC101-1217C ................................................................... 1a .......... 10
SC101-1218C ................................................................... 1b .......... 10
SC101-1226B ................................................................... 1a .......... 30
SC101-1240A ................................................................... 1a .......... 16
SC101-1241B ................................................................... 1b .......... 12
SC101-1243B ................................................................... 1a .......... 40
SC101-1244A ................................................................... 1a .......... 48
SC101-1247A ................................................................... 1c ............ 2
SC101-1248A ................................................................... 1a .......... 20
SC101-1249A ................................................................... 1a .......... 46
SC101-1259B ................................................................... 1a ............ 3
SC101-1269A ................................................................... 1b .......... 16
SC101-1272A ................................................................... 1a .......... 34
SC101-1273A ................................................................... 1a ............ 6
SC101-1280A ................................................................... 1a .......... 12
SC101-1282A ................................................................... 1a .......... 18
SC101-1284A ................................................................... 1a ............ 8
SC101-1327...................................................................... 1b .......... 14

IV

Diagram Code

Sec. Pag.

SV102-0782D .................................................................... 1d .......... 31


SV102-1241D .................................................................... 1d .......... 36
SV102-1349E .................................................................... 1d .......... 34
SV102-1469D .................................................................... 1d .......... 30
SV102-1470C .................................................................... 1e .......... 27
SV102-1574C .................................................................... 1d .......... 30
SV102-1609E .................................................................... 1d ............ 6
SV102-1710D .................................................................... 1e .......... 27
SV102-1712F .................................................................... 1e .......... 26
SV102-2066D .................................................................... 1d ............ 8
SV102-2081B .................................................................... 1e ............ 5
SV102-2082C .................................................................... 1e ............ 4
SV102-2132E .................................................................... 1d .......... 32
SV102-2631E .................................................................... 1d ............ 4
SV102-2633H .................................................................... 1e ............ 6
SV102-2806F .................................................................... 1e .......... 14
SV102-2892D .................................................................... 1d .......... 14
SV102-2902G.................................................................... 1e ............ 8
SV102-2913B .................................................................... 1e .......... 10
SV102-2934C .................................................................... 1d .......... 16
SV102-2935E .................................................................... 1d .......... 22
SV102-2970D .................................................................... 1d .......... 24
SV102-2972D .................................................................... 1d .......... 26
SV102-2978C .................................................................... 1e .......... 29
SV102-3060B .................................................................... 1e .......... 18
SV102-3063A .................................................................... 1d .......... 38
SV102-3078B .................................................................... 1d .......... 18
SV102-3079A .................................................................... 1d .......... 20
SV102-3092D .................................................................... 1e .......... 12
SV102-3094D .................................................................... 1e .......... 20
SV102-3118C .................................................................... 1d .......... 10
SV102-3119A .................................................................... 1d .......... 12
SV102-3121C .................................................................... 1e .......... 16
SV102-3122E .................................................................... 1e .......... 24
SV102-3146D .................................................................... 1d ............ 2
SV102-3147B .................................................................... 1e ............ 2
SV102-3166C .................................................................... 1e .......... 22
SV102-3219....................................................................... 1d .......... 46
SV102-3220....................................................................... 1d .......... 48
SV102-3227....................................................................... 1d .......... 42
SV102-3228A .................................................................... 1d .......... 40
SV102-3229B .................................................................... 1d .......... 53
SV102-3235....................................................................... 1d .......... 44
SV102-3238....................................................................... 1e .......... 27
SV102-3239....................................................................... 1e .......... 26
SV102-3240....................................................................... 1e .......... 27
SV102-3257A .................................................................... 1d .......... 28
SV102-3294....................................................................... 1d .......... 50
SV102-3295....................................................................... 1d .......... 51
SV102-3296A .................................................................... 1d .......... 52

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SECTION 1
(REV.B)

INSTALLATION DIAGRAMS

INSTALLATION DIAGRAMS

Download from:
www.urmetdomus.com
Technical Manuals area
DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1 1

DOOR PHONE AND VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEM - DIAGRAM - Section 1

SECTION 1 CONTENTS
DOOR PHONE AND VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEM - DIAGRAM

Sec.

Pag.

INSTALLATION DIAGRAMS
INSTRUCTIONS FOR INSTALLER .......................................................................................................................................................1 ................ 3
Conductor cross-section .....................................................................................................................................................................1 ................ 3
Wire laying ..........................................................................................................................................................................................1 ................ 3
Instruction for grounding or not of the electronic locks and push button panels.................................................................................1 ................ 4
Door opener service ...........................................................................................................................................................................1 ................ 4
Tv camera unit ....................................................................................................................................................................................1 ................ 4
OPERATING ANOMALIES ....................................................................................................................................................................1 ................ 4
Background noise in outdoor station systems ....................................................................................................................................1 ................ 4
Radio frequency picking .....................................................................................................................................................................1 ................ 4
Non-operation of the call to the loudspeaker ......................................................................................................................................1 ................ 4
Insufficient reception in outdoor station systems ................................................................................................................................1 ................ 4
Whistle or larsen effect .......................................................................................................................................................................1 ................ 4
Intercoms ............................................................................................................................................................................................1 ................ 4
System check and possible failures outdoor station system control...................................................................................................1 ................ 5
1- or 2-user basic video door phone system troubleshooting and solutions.......................................................................................1 ................ 5
Reducing architectural barriers...........................................................................................................................................................1 ................ 5
SYSTEM TYPOLOGIES ........................................................................................................................................................................1 ................ 6
Door phone systems...........................................................................................................................................................................1 ................ 6
Video door phone systems .................................................................................................................................................................1 ................ 6
CHOOSING THE RIGHT SYSTEM........................................................................................................................................................1 ................ 6
Door phone systems...........................................................................................................................................................................1 ................ 6
Video door phone systems .................................................................................................................................................................1 ................ 7

DIAGRAM NOTES

2 sec.1

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

INSTALLATION DIAGRAMS
INSTRUCTIONS FOR INSTALLER

The products described in this technical manual must be used as


expressly intended only, i.e. to build door phone and video door phone
systems.
Any other use must be considered inappropriate and, them, dangerous.
The constructor can not be considered liable for casual damages due
to inappropriate, wrong and irrational use.
The system must be built in compliance with the regulations in
force.
Check that the device is intact after removing it from the packaging.
(do not proceed with installation in the event of faults);
Keep the packaging (plastic bags, polystyrene, etc.) away from
children. Packaging is potentially dangerous.
Before connecting the set install an appropriate separation and
protection switch.
Before connecting the set verify that the data label correspond to the
mains ones.
Ensure that the conditions and data shown in the instruction booklets
are respected for the entire life of the device;
Do not obstruct the openings or fessures for ventilation or heat
elimination.
Before any cleaning or maintenance operation, disconnect the set
by means of the system switch.
In case of failure and/or malfunctioning of the set disconnect it by
means of the general switch and do not damage it. (To repair the set
contact Urmet after sales services)
Do not open or tamper with the monitors: HIGH VOLTAGE live parts
inside.
Avoiding knocking or dropping the device to avoid breaking the
kinescope with consequent projection of glass fragments.
If the above mentioned prescriptions are not followed, the set safety
can be compromised.
The installer must verify that the notices for user are present on the
slave sets.

CONDUCTOR CROSS-SECTION
Connection of traditional call door phone, 4+n wire electronic call
door phone or coax video door phone systems:
Conductor cross-section depends on the length of the connections
and must be able to guarantee a total resistance of less than 5 Ohm
on each.
Distance [m]

Cross-section [mm2]

Call and speech circuit


50
0,5
100
0,5
200
0,8
300
1,0
Door release circuit
50
100
200
300

0,5
0,8
1,0
1,6

Video circuit ()
50
100
200
300

0,8
1,0
1,6
2,5

In the table, the maximum distance is to be interpreted as between the


call station and the furthest door phone or video door phone.
For longer distances:
A) Suitably increase circuit wire cross-section area for voice and call
circuit.
B) Use of a back-up relay for operating door lock circuit is
recommended.
C) Installation of a video distributor Ref. 1794/4A is needed for the
coax wire.
In intercom systems it is advisable never to exceed 200 meters.
Connection of 1+1 wire electronic door phone or 5-wire video door
phone systems.
The system works correctly with a maximum total (forwards and
backwards) line resistance of 12.
Use the following wire cross-section areas according to distance:
Distance [m]

Cross-section [mm2]

Call and speech circuit (terminals 1, 2, CA)


50
0,35
100
0,75
200
1,0
Video door phone power negative (terminal R1)
50
0,75
100
1,5
200
2,5
Video door phone power positive (terminal R2)
50
0,5
100
1,0
200
2,0
Video signal (terminals A, B)
50
0,35
100
0,35
200
0,35 double
Maximum length is between door unit (panel) and the most distant
apartment station (door phone or video door phone).
Up to two house phones can be connected in parallel.
Note: in all sistem foresee the wires for push button panel lamps
lighting with an adequate power transformer (for up to 2 lamps
the system transformer can be used), as well as the wires for
the electric lock opener next to the door.

WIRE LAYING
The wire laying of systems with different voltages is possible not only
in separated conduits but also in the same conduit. In this case all the
wires have an insulation suitable to the highest rated voltage. Wires
of systems incompatible each others as power and telephones TV
antenna, data transmission, must have different conduits and boxes.
By using external conduits it is possible to fail to observe this rule, on
the condition that the incompatible systems are separated by means of
a diaphragm. The internal diameter of the conduits has to be at least
1.3 times the diameter of the circle circumscribed to the wire group that
the conduits have to include, with a minimum of 10 mm.
Never use telephone cables; false calls may occur in installations with
long lines due to problems of cross-talk.

() Data in the table refers to the camera and monitor power wires; a
75 coax wire (e.g. RG59 U75) is required for the video signal.

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1 3

INSTALLATION DIAGRAMS

INSTRUCTIONS FOR INSTALLER

INSTALLATION DIAGRAMS
OPERATING ANOMALIES

INSTRUCTION FOR GROUNDING OR NOT OF THE


ELECTRONIC LOCKS AND PUSH BUTTON PANELS
According the IEC 64-8/4 Rule Point 411-1.2.4, the electronic device
for which measures have been adopted to guarantee that in case of
internal failure, the output terminal voltage cannot exceed the indicated
values (50 Vac and, 120 Vdc not inverted) are source SELV type (ex
BTS).
It is the case of the Urmet door phone power supplies for bar mounting
that have a double insulation and that is belonging to class II (identified
by the double square symbol) and that are conforming to IEC 12/13
Rules.
The active parts of the powered circuits (electric locks and push button
panels) absolutely have not to be grounded (point 411.1.4.1). Only
for information, the power supplies that do not belong to class II but
to class I and, therefore, have not a double or intensified insulation,
belong to FELV class (ex BTF). In this case both the power supplies
and the active parts of the fed circuits have to be grounded.

From the lock releases


of the
house-phones
RELAY

ELECTRIC LOCK
Lock
operation

HOUSE PHONE
POWER SUPPLY

RADIO FREQUENCY PICKING


DOOR OPENER SERVICE
Most apartment stations are equipped with door opener button to
operate one or more electrical locks.
It is not recommended to act on two different locks with the same
button, since the excessive power absorbed by the door opener service
might damage the power supply. In this case it is advisable to use
house phones equipped with an additional button to open the second
lock, or else to use relay switches for servocontrol of the second lock.

TV CAMERA UNIT
To obtain the best reproduction never direct the TV camera towards
strong light sources (i.e. sun, lamps, flashes, flames or reflections).
Normal lighting is supplied by the infrared LEDs included in the TV
camera unit. In case it is necessary the additional lamp lighting up for
the outdoor vision (in particular with separated TV camera solution)
insert a proper relay 788/5 or 788/52 by connecting to the video power
supply.
The contacts will close the circuit of the lamps fed with an external
voltage.

OPERATING ANOMALIES

INSTALLATION DIAGRAMS

BACKGROUND NOISE IN OUTDOOR STATION


SYSTEMS
If, during a conversation a background noise or a rather strong buzzing
are heard, it is necessary to check the power supply and the absence
of failures in the components
One of the causes for the irregular functioning of the system is the 12V
a.c. voltage pick up (for push button panel lamps lighting) from the -
terminal of the loudspeaking unit, rather than from the power supply
output.
In fact, by this mistake, when lamps light up there is a voltage drop
in the common wire between power supply and outdoor station that
gives - on its turn - the above mentioned background noises during the
conversation.
Another cause of buzzing depends by long lines systems. The wire 9,
that closes on the terminal 12 through the electric lock coil, induce
the alternated current in the column. To verify disconnect a wire
from electric lock, if the buzzing disappears the cause is located. To
eliminate it control the lock by means of a auxiliary relay connected as
per following scheme:

Some times a radio broadcast program can be heard in the door


phone handset; this happens when the outdoor station is next to the
radio repeater station. By connecting, between terminals + and 2
of the loudspeaking unit a 100 nF capacitor, the inconvenience will be
overcome.

NON-OPERATION
LOUDSPEAKER

OF

THE

CALL

TO

THE

Check the power supply generates the call sound, by inserting a 45


Ohms loudspeaker between terminals PS and ~0 of the power
supply.
Replace the power unit in the event of a failure.

INSUFFICIENT RECEPTION IN OUTDOOR STATION


SYSTEMS
The following cases may occur:
1) Insufficient reception at both outdoor and indoor stations.
In this case it is necessary to verify that power supply voltage
is not lower than 5,7V d.c. If feeding is normal, the insufficient
reception is caused, in most cases, by a door phone that remains
permanently inserted since, if the handset is unhooked, the hook
contacts do not disconnect it from the system and therefore the
house phones operate as if they were connected in parallel.
2) Insufficient reception at outdoor station only.
If this occurs only when the outdoor station is in connection with a
certain door phone, the defect can be easily eliminated by acting
on the door phone. If, on the contrary, the reception is weak,
independently from the door phone connected to the loudspeaking
unit, the defect is to be found in the loudspeaking unit itself;
therefore it will be necessary to first check that there have been
no wire inversions in the connection to terminals 1 and 2 or
inversions of + and - polarities.
3) Insufficient reception at indoor station only.
Adjust the loudspeaking unit potentiometer by increasing the
volume EXT.

WHISTLE OR LARSEN EFFECT


Should the system present a whistle due to Larsen effect, duly adjust
the two volume potentiometers of the loudspeaking unit reducing
the higher yield channel (INT or EXT). A better result is obtained by
acting on the internal volume.

INTERCOMS
One of the most common connection mistakes in an intercom system
causes the following defect: during test operations the handset gives a
background noise and no conversation can take place.
This is due to a wrong connection on the power supply negative
terminal.

4 sec.1

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

INSTALLATION DIAGRAMS
OPERATING ANOMALIES

The power supplies have two negative outputs: - and -J. The latter
has a series impedance. If, during the installation, a connection is
made on the first output instead of on the second -J, the system will
not work since the impedance function is missing.

SYSTEM CHECK AND POSSIBLE FAILURES


OUTDOOR STATION SYSTEM CONTROL
1) Check that voltage between (+) and (-) terminals is of 6V. If voltage
is normal, there should not be:
a) Any badly connected door phone.
b) Any door phone with permanently unhooked handset.
To make sure that all house phones are properly connected, it is
necessary to measure if between + and 1A and 2 terminals
voltage is present.
Under normal conditions, there should be no voltage. If, on the
contrary, voltage is present, it means that in one or more house
phones both the microphone and the receiver are permanently
inserted.
2) Disconnect +, 1A and 2 terminals wires from the loudspeaking
unit and measure with the ohmmeter between wires 1A and 2:
If the result is infinite the system is in order.
If there is a resistance of about 100 Ohms, some door phone is
always connected.
If the result is 0 Ohms, wire 1A and 2 are in short circuit.
To verify the efficiency of the loudspeaking unit, wires 1A and
2 coming from the installation, must be disconnected and a
provisional connection must be made on a perfectly working
door phone; if the conversation is audible, the fault will have to
be found somewhere else. To locate faults it is necessary to proceed upwards on the cable conduit.

REDUCING ARCHITECTURAL BARRIERS


In buildings intended for social activities, such as schools, hospitals,
health care centres, cultural centres, etc., and in all other buildings
where technical precautions are needed to ensure accessibility by
disabled persons, the door phone and video door phone systems must
be installed so to be conveniently used by everyone.
Specifically, avoid installing apartment stations in difficult to reach
points. Install so that the distance between the floor and the upper part
of the microphone is 100cm.
The panel outside the building must be installed as close as possible
to the height of a wheelchair users face: the recommended height is
from 115 to 125cm from the floor.

100 cm 115 125 cm

1- OR 2-USER BASIC VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEM


TROUBLESHOOTING AND SOLUTIONS

INSTALLATION DIAGRAMS

1) No conversation can be established with the door unit: the call


tone is heard on the monitor but the monitor does not light up.
Short-circuit between output terminals: the power unit protection
has tripped; disconnect power (230 Vac) and carefully check the
system wiring again.
2) No conversation can be established with the door unit: no call tone
is heard on the monitor and the monitor does not light up. Check:
Connection between panel button and monitor CA terminal.
Connection between power unit terminal PS and panel button
common.
No short-circuit on power unit PS terminal.
3) A conversation can be established with the door unit: the call tone
is heard on the monitor but the monitor does not light up.
Check:
Presence of voltage (18-20 Vdc) between monitor terminals
R2 (+) and R1 (-).
4) A conversation can be established with the door unit: the call tone
is heard on the monitor, the monitor does not light up but the
screen is blank.
Check:
Presence of voltage (16-18Vdc) between camera terminals
+TC R1.
Possible coax interruption or short-circuit.
5) No conversation can be established with the door unit: the call
tone is heard on the video door phone and the camera picture
appears.
Check:
Presence of voltage (6Vdc) between door unit terminals +6
and -6.
6) The system works correctly but the door lock cannot be released.
Check:
Continuity between video door phone 9 and video power unit
AP terminals.
All diagrams in this volume can be downloaded from the web site at
www.urmetdomus.com, technical diagram area.

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1 5

INSTALLATION DIAGRAMS
SYSTEM TYPOLOGIES - CHOOSING THE RIGHT SYSTEM

SYSTEM TYPOLOGIES
DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS
Door phone systems functions include conversation, calling and door
opening in a normal electrical system.
The following devices are needed to make a basic door phone
system:
Panel with buttons and door unit.
Apartment station door phones.
Door phone system power unit.

KEY
A: Door phone
B: Power unit
C: Panel
D: Electrical lock

Door phone systems are split into two families according to the number
of wires needed to make the system.
C

VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS


Urmet Domus video door phone systems ensure a high level of user
safety; visitors can be recognised at the door (of a detached house,
a semi-detached house or a block of flats) thanks to the picture which
appears on the monitor located inside.
The following devices are needed to make a basic video door phone
system:
Panel with buttons, door unit and camera.
Apartment station video door phones.
Video door phone system power unit.
Either black and white or colour video door phone systems are
available using specific monitors and camera.
Video door phone installation is simple and quick thanks to the use
of specific brackets with terminal boards onto which the monitor is
fastened.
Two system types are available: coax and 5 wires.

B
D
Traditional call systems are suitable for making new systems with call
signal to a dedicated buzzer fitted inside the door phone.
This type of door phone is suitable for replacing 1030, 930 and
730 model door phone in existing systems and for making intercom
systems.
1+1 wire systems

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

1+1 wires systems are available with electronic call option only.
These systems are characterised by simple wiring with only 2 wires for
each user.
They are suitable for making new installations and are most appreciated
for use in old buildings to replace an existing call only system (button
and bell). The existing service can be transformed into a door phone
system without adding wires to the column or in the apartments.
In this systems, only the called door phone can pick up the conversation
with the visitor (no other users can cut into the call in progress) and
open the electrical door lock.

4+n wire systems

Existing call only system

CHOOSING THE RIGHT SYSTEM

This type of system employs 4 wires (2 for voice in and out, 1 for door
phone power ground and 1 for operating the electrical lock) plus one
call wire.
The system may implement either traditional or electronic call tone
options.

INSTALLATION DIAGRAMS

Door phones with different designs and colour are available for 4+n
wire electronic call systems.
The call tone is sent directly to the speaker used for normal
communication with the door unit. The tone is a modulated two-tone
note (1200 and 750Hz) in this case.
Door phones with special functions can be used (privacy indicator and
door monitoring LED, voice circuit on button, additional buttons directly
on the door phone top). Various accessories are also available (threetone gong, call volume adjustment kit, etc.).
Various doors phones can be connected one to the each other in
addition to the door unit for making intercom systems.

KEY
B: 12V transformer
C: Panel
D: Electrical lock
E: Lock release button
F: Apartment ringer
G: Floor call button

C
D

6 sec.1

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

INSTALLATION DIAGRAMS
CHOOSING THE RIGHT SYSTEM

1+1 wire door phone system

5 wire systems
KEY
A: Door phone
B: 12V transformer
C: Panel
D: Electrical lock
F: Apartment ringer
G: Floor call button

F
G
A
F
G
A

These systems are particularly suitable for new installations and


for transforming existing door phone systems into video door
phone systems without addition other wires in the column and the
apartments.
Urmet Domus 5 wire video door phone systems (without coax) can be
used to make video door phone systems with only 4 wires for powering
the monitor and the video signal plus 1 wire for the call signal.
The picture only appears on the called monitor. Conversation is private.
Users must have been called to connect to the door unit.
Simple 1+1 door phones can be connected to the 5 wire video door
phone system for offering voice service only.
Existing door phone system
KEY
A: Door phone system
power unit
B: Video power unit
C: Electrical lock
D: Camera unit
E: Door unit
F: Panel
G: Apartment station
H: Video door phone
distribution box
I: Conversation
privacy board
L: Door phone

C
L
D

VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS


Coax systems

The construction of a coax video door phone system is similar to that


of an electronic call 4+n door phone system with the addition of video
functions. The wires are the same as those shown for the door phone
system with the addition of those needed to power the camera and the
monitor, in addition to the coax cable for the video signal.
This system offers countless possible configurations for both black and
white and colour installations; it is particularly indicated when there is
a long distance between the camera and the monitors.
Apartment stations in coax systems can be connected one to another
to make intercom systems.
Apartment stations in coax systems can be complemented with a
wide range of accessories (three-tone gong, Scaitel picture memory
module, supplementary buzzer, etc.).
Simple 4+n door phones can be connected to the coax video door
phone system for offering voice service only.
A

KEY
A: Apartment station
B: Power unit
C: Video door unit
D: Video distribution
E: Electrical lock

A
D

E
A
C

5 wire video door phone system

G
H

D
G

INSTALLATION DIAGRAMS

H
TC

D
TC

B
E

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1 7

INSTALLATION DIAGRAMS
DIAGRAM NOTES

C4.003

C1.002 - MINIMUM WIRE


CROSS-SECTION AREAS
Distance m
Cross-section
area sq.mm

Door phone

50

100

200

0,35

0,75

Ref.1132/1
Ref.1133/1
Ref.1131/1

Terminal equivalence:
T1
T1
A

T2
T2
B

T3
T3
C

T4
D

C4.004 - Use auxiliary relay


Ref.788/21 or 788/52 for operating the
lock in systems with long lines to
avoid buzzing.

Provide two wires for switching


on the push-button panel light
bulbs. Use a power transformer
suitable to the number of light
bulbs. The system transformer is
sufficient for up to 2 bulbs
(max 6 W).

The connection variant is:


FROM 9 OF
DOOR PHONES

C1.004 - K-Steel models only:


Remove the jumper
a)... and ...

2
12~ S1 S3

Ref.788/52
DEVICE
RELAY

~12
~0
DOOR PHONE
POWER SUPPLY

C4.001 - MINIMUM WIRE


CROSS-SECTION AREAS
m

50

100

200

300

Voice and
sq.mm
call circuit

0,5

0,5

0,8

Door opening sq.mm


circuit

0,5

0,8

Distance

1,6

- The indicated distance is between


door unit and most distant door phone.
- Lay the wires at a suitable distance
from power lines (as far away as
possible).
Use two wires for lighting the panel
name tags if not included in the diagram.
Use a separate transformer of suitable
power.
Transformer Ref.9000/230 is recommended
for up to 15WThe system power unit is sufficient for
up to 6W.

ELECTRIC
LOCK

Door Lock
Release

C4.006 - Sinthesi models only:


- Connected jumper ... to ...
C4.007 - Sinthesi models only:
See instruction booklet provided with
product for connecting terminals G/T,
~0 and ~12 between modules.

C4.008 - K-Steel models only:


all connections are made with
terminal boards.
C4.009 - Important:
Use cord pairs.
C4.012 - MINIMUM WIRE
CROSS-SECTION AREAS
Distance

120

200

300

480

Diameter

mm

0,5

0,65

0,8

0,8

1,6

Cross-section
sq.mm 0,20
area

C4.014 - Check that the diode respects


the polarisation shown in the diagram.

INSTALLATION DIAGRAMS

C4.015 - Repeater door phone call input


connections.

Call repeater
Ref.1332/84

CA
6

8 sec.1

Mod.1131
Mod.Scaitel
Mod. Atlantico
4+n
1+1
wire
wire
systems systems
CA
6

2
1

Mod.1130
4+n
1+1
wire
wire
systems systems
7
6

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

INSTALLATION DIAGRAMS
DIAGRAM NOTES

C4.016 The call


light up
from any

Sinthesi models only:


forwarded LEDs on all panels
when a call is in progress
station.

C4.017 - Sinthesi models only:


The call forwarded LED of the secondary
station in the column to which the call
is directed lights up when a call from
the main panel is in progress.
C4.018 - K-Steel model door units only:
connect terminals ~0 and ~12 for name
tag lighting.
C4.023 - Set the (TIME) trimmer on the
device to minimum time.

CU.009 - Provide two wires for


switching on the push-button panel
light bulbs.
Use a power transformer suitable toe
the number of light bulbs.
Use of transformer Ref. 9000/230 is
recommended for up to five bulbs
(max 15 W).

V5.001 - Wire cross-section area


Maximum
distance

50

100

200

R1

Sq.mm 0,75

1,5

2,5

R2

Sq.mm 0,5

1,0

2,0

CA

Sq.mm 0,35

0,50 0,75

A,B

Sq.mm 0,35

0,35
0,35 Double

Wires

wires

The diagrams indicate the distance


between the camera and most distant
video door phone unit.
Normal wires can be used for
distances up to 100 metres. For
higher distances (up to 200 metres)
the wires A and B must be doubled.
V5.002 - Use two wires for lighting the
panel name tags if not included in the
diagram.
Use a separate transformer of suitable
power.
Transformer Ref.9000/230 is recommended
for up to 15WThe system power unit is sufficient for
up to 6W.
V5.004 - On the last distributor,
insert two 82 Ohm resistors (provided)
between terminals R1-A and R1-B.
V5.007 - MINIMUM WIRE
CROSS-SECTION AREAS
From camera to video door phones
Function

Wires

50

100 200

Video power

R1

mmq 0,5 0,75 1,5

Video power

R2

mmq 0,5 0,75 1,5

Video signal

mmq 0,35 0,35 0,35

Video signal

mmq 0,35 0,35 0,35

C1-C2

mmq 0,35 0,5 0,75

AI

mmq 0,35 0,35 0,35

Call
Auto power-on

double
wires

INSTALLATION DIAGRAMS

The diagrams indicate the distance


between the camera and the
video door phone unit.
Normal wires can be used for
distances up to 100 metres. For
higher distances (up to 200 metres)
the wires A and B must be doubled.
From power unit to camera
Function

VD.002 - See the chapter "Demister


power" in the chosen product manual
for K-Steel camera modules only.
VD.007 = Floor call button.

Wires

50

100

mmq 0,75 1,50 -

Power 12V~

~12

Power 12V~

~0

mmq 0,75 1,50 -

Power 18V=

+18

mmq 1,50 2,50 -

Power 18V=

R1

mmq 1,50 2,50 -

V5.011 - Connect the wire for switch-on


function. In this case, connect jumper
between terminals X2 and R3.

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1 9

INSTALLATION DIAGRAMS
DIAGRAM NOTES

VX.0 01
output
fitted
remove

- To use video distributor


U5, remove the 75 Ohm resistor
on the printed circuit or
jumper (if existing).

VX.002 - The power unit can power


up to 10 distributors. Use one
local power unit Ref. 789/2 for
each group of distributors (max.
20) after exceeding this limit.

VX.011 - Close the coaxial wire on


the last monitor in the riser with
a 75 Ohm resistance between
terminals V4 and V5.

VX.003 - MINIMUM WIRE


CROSS-SECTION AREAS
Distance

50

100

200

300

Sq.mm

0,5

0,8

1,6

Wires
R1,R2,+TC Sq.mm

0,8

1,6

2,5

Normal
Wires

COAXIAL
CABLE
75 Ohm

VX.010 - No more than 20 monitors


should be connected to each column;
add video distributors to the
camera output or other device if
there are more devices.

Use a normal coaxial wire


for distances up to 300 m
Add a video amplifier for
longer distances.

Provide two wires for switching on


the push-button panel light bulbs.
Use a separate transformer suitable
to the number of light bulbs.
(Transformer ref. 9000/230 is
recommended for up to 5 bulbs).
The system power unit is sufficient
for up to 2 bulbs.

VX.012 - Relay Ref.788/5 or Ref.788/52


is needed to prevent that a video door
phone can be switched on while another
device is working and interrupt vision.
Connect the PS wire directly to the
monitor X1 terminals if the relay is
not fitted.
VX.013 - Connect the switch-off
circuit Ref. 5330/60 in the
push-button panel and connect wire SN
(brown) to the button common. Cut and
isolate wire 1 (red).
VX.014 - Dusk switch or similar device
for switching lights on, where
relevant.
VX.015 - The power unit Ref.1090/850
can power up to 4 devices.
Use another power unit for each group
of 4 devices if the system exceed
this capacity.

VX.006 - See the instruction book


provided with the product for fitting
the accessory in the device.

VX.016 - MINIME WIRE CROSS SECTION AREAS

VX.007 - The cross-section area of the


wires indicated with
must be
double.

Voice and
call wires

Distance

COAXIAL
CABLE
75 Ohm

Ref.1332/85 Ref.1332/86
Protection Filter
Neutral
2 2
N
2 2
Earth
L

Phase

1
IN

1
OUT

1
IN

Line ~

Mains ~

VX.008 - Connect the devices to a


filter and power line protection
device.

1
OUT

INSTALLATION DIAGRAMS

300

400

700

1000

mmq

1,6

1,75

2,5

Use a normal coaxial wire


for distances up to 300 m
Add a video amplifier for
longer distances.

The video amplifier must be installed


near the monitor.
Two BNC connectors are required for
connecting the coax wire. Use a RG59
(75Ohm) coax for a maximum distance
of 300m.
Use video amplifier Ref.1840/250 with
RG11 wire for higher distances

Utility

10 sec.1

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

INSTALLATION DIAGRAMS
DIAGRAM NOTES

VX.018 - Connect the following


jumpers on the device:
a) ..... with .....
b) ..... with .....
c) ..... with .....
VX.021 - Cut or remove the jumpers on
the device(s):
- ...-...
- ...-...
-...-...

VX.023 - Terminal equivalence:


- RT (Sentry+)= RD (Atlantico).

VX.031 - On the device remove


the jumper P1 which short circuit
the diode 1N4700. In intercom system
there is not necessary connect the
diode.
VX.032 - MINIME WIRE CROSS
SECTION AREAS
The section area and the voltage cable
(12Vcc 12Vdc)lenght are in function
of the camera intake.
See the following table:
Camera
intake

Cross section
area(mmq)

Distance
(m)

0,75

50

1,5

100

2,5

150

240

max 300mA
VX.025

EXAMPLE OF POWER CONNECTION WITH


ATLANTICO VIDEO DOOR PHONES

R1
RD
R2
R
75

V4
V5
V3

RD
R1
R2

VX.033 - MINIME WIRE CROSS


SECTION AREAS
The section area and the voltage cable
(12Vcc 12Vdc)lenght are in function
of the camera intake.
See the following table:
Camera
intake

Cross section
area(mmq)

Distance
(m)

50

max 500mA

2,5

125

200

VX.034 - MINIME WIRE CROSS SECTION AREAS


1

V4
V5
V3

R1 R2

VX.028 - For Ref. 5330/60 only: cut


and isolate wire 1 (red)

Distance

50

100

200

300

Normal
wires

mmq

0,5

0,5

0,8

Call and
button
common
wires

mmq

0,5

0,8

1,6

Wires
R1, R2, +TC

mmq

0,5

0,5

0,8

COAXIAL
CABLE
75 Ohm

Use a normal coaxial wire


for distances up to 300 m
Add a video amplifier for
longer distances.

INSTALLATION DIAGRAMS

Use two wires for lighting the panel


name tags if not included in the diagram.
Use a separate transformer of suitable
power.
Transformer ref. 9000/230 is recommended
for up to 15WThe system power unit is sufficient for
up to 6W.
VU.002 - Follow the instructions
provided with the product for
fitting the camera.

NOTE 1: The electrical lock is shown in the diagrams and


must have the following features:
12Vac - 15VA
NOTE 2: The number of devices shown by an X must be
evaluated according to the system type to be made.

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1 11

INSTALLATION DIAGRAMS
12 sec.1

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

SECTION 1A
(REV.D)

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

BASIC DIAGRAMS FOR 4+N WIRE


DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

Download from:
www.urmetdomus.com
Technical Manuals area
DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1a 1

DOOR PHONE AND VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEM - DIAGRAM - Section 1A

SECTION 1A CONTENTS
DOOR PHONE AND VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEM - DIAGRAM

Diagram

Sec.

Pag.

BASIC DIAGRAMS FOR 4+N WIRE DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS


CONNECTION OF UP TO 2 DOOR PHONES TO 1 DOOR UNIT ................................................................ SC101-0858C ..............1a ................ 2
CONNECTION OF UP TO 2 DOOR PHONES TO 1 DOOR UNIT ................................................................ SC101-1259B ..............1a ................ 3
CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 1 DOOR UNIT
Door phone with or without insertion key........................................................................................................ SC101-1133C ..............1a ................ 4
CONNECTION OF 6 DOOR PHONES TO 1 DOOR UNIT
Door phones A and B are called individually while door phones C-D-E-F are called in parallel .................... SC101-1273A ..............1a ................ 6
CONNECTION OF 6 DOOR PHONES TO 1 DOOR UNIT
Door phones A and B are called individually while door phones C-D-E-F are called in parallel.
Floor call service with differentiated tone.
Possibility of timing the door open.................................................................................................................. SC101-1284A ..............1a ................ 8
CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 2 OUTDOOR STATIONS
Use the relay box Ref. 788/51 and the power supply Ref. 786/11 ................................................................. SC101-1217C ..............1a ............. 10
CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONE TO 2 DOOR UNITS
Differentiated calls from door units. Use the power supply wiht relay Ref. 786/15......................................... SC101-1280A ..............1a ............. 12
CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 4 OUTDOOR STATIONS ............................................ SC101-1209C ..............1a ............. 14
CONNECTION OF SEVERAL COLUMNS OF DOOR PHONES TO 1 MAIN OUTDOOR STATION
Each column is also connected to its own secondary outdoor station.
Use the relay box Ref. 788/51 and the power supply Ref. 786/11 ................................................................. SC101-1240A ..............1a ............. 16
CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONE COLUMNS TO 1 MAIN DOOR UNIT
Each column is connected to a secondary door unit. Differentiated calls from door units.
Use the power supply wiht relay Ref. 786/15 ................................................................................................. SC101-1282A ..............1a ............. 18
CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES MODEL ATLANTICO TO 1 OUTDOOR STATIONS
Floor calls on the supplementary loudspeaker ............................................................................................... SC101-1248A ..............1a ............. 20
CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 1 OUTDOOR STATION
Connection of the sound generator to call door phones from the floor using the same loudspeaker ............ SC101-0252D ..............1a ............. 22
CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 1 OUTDOOR STATION
Solution using the three-tone gong kit for differentiated call to the floor
The calls from the push button panel are sent with sound generator
Those to the floor with add-on device for call Ref. 1132/54 ........................................................................... SC101-0791E ..............1a ............. 24
CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 1 DOOR UNIT
Solution using additional differential floor call device Ref. 9854/53................................................................ SC101-1070C ..............1a ............. 26
CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 1 OUTDOOR STATION
Door phone A can open door during call from panel................................................................................... SC101-0289 II ..............1a ............. 28
CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 1 OUTDOOR STATION
Door open light indicator. Possibility of cutting out calls and respective indications ...................................... SC101-1226B ..............1a ............. 30
INTERCOMMUNICATING CONNECTION OF 2 DOOR PHONES ............................................................... SC101-0249E ..............1a ............. 32
INTERCOMMUNICATING CONNECTION OF 4 DOOR PHONES ............................................................... SC101-1272A ..............1a ............. 34
INTERCOMMUNICATING CONNECTION OF MAXIMUM 13 DOOR PHONES ........................................... SC101-0861D ..............1a ............. 36
CONNECTION OF 1 MAIN DOOR PHONE TO 12 SHUNT DOOR PHONES MAXIMUM ............................ SC101-0863E ..............1a ............. 38
INTERCOMMUNICATING CONNECTION OF 2 DOOR PHONES
WITH THE POSSIBILITY OF REPLY TO 1 OUTDOOR STATION
Single calls from outdoor station ................................................................................................................... SC101-1243B ..............1a ............. 40
INTERCOMMUNICATING CONNECTION OF 2 DOOR PHONES
WITH THE POSSIBILITY OF REPLY TO 1 OUTDOOR STATION
Parallel calls from outdoor station. Differentiated calls...................................................................................SC101-0578G ..............1a ............. 42
INTERCOMMUNICATING CONNECTION OF MAXIMUM 13 DOOR PHONES
WITH THE POSSIBILITY OF REPLY TO 1 OUTDOOR STATION
Single calls from outdoor station. Differentiated calls..................................................................................... SC101-0839D ..............1a ............. 44
INTERCOMMUNICATING CONNECTION OF 2 DOOR PHONES
WITH THE POSSIBILITY OF REPLY TO 2 OUTDOOR STATION
Single calls from outdoor station .................................................................................................................... SC101-1249A ..............1a ............. 46

I sec.1a

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

DOOR PHONE AND VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEM - DIAGRAM

INTERCOMMUNICATING CONNECTION OF 2 DOOR PHONES


WITH THE POSSIBILITY OF REPLY TO 2 OUTDOOR STATION
Parallel calls from outdoor station .................................................................................................................. SC101-1244A ..............1a ............. 48
INTERCOMMUNICATING CONNECTION OF MAXIMUM 13 DOOR PHONES
WITH THE POSSIBILITY OF REPLY TO 2 OUTDOOR STATIONS
Single calls from the push button panels........................................................................................................ SC101-0844E ..............1a ............. 50
INTERCOMMUNICATING CONNECTION OF MAXIMUM 13 DOOR PHONES
WITH THE POSSIBILITY OF REPLY TO 2 OUTDOOR STATIONS
Parallel calls from the push button panels......................................................................................................SC101-0866G ..............1a ............. 52
CONNECTION OF TWO INTERCOMMUNICATING DOOR PHONE EXTENSIONS
TO A SYSTEM WITH DOOR UNIT
Parallel calls from door unit. Differentiated calls............................................................................................. SC101-0567E ..............1a ............. 54
CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 1 OUTDOOR STATION
Secrecy of conversation ................................................................................................................................. SC101-1134E ..............1a ............. 56
CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 1 DOOR UNIT
Simultaneous opening of two electrical locks ................................................................................................. SC101-0482D ..............1a ............. 58
CONNECTION OF TWO INTERCOM DOOR PHONES WITH POSSIBILITY OF ANSWERING CALLS
FROM ONE SECONDARY DOOR UNIT EXTENSION OF AN ELECTRICAL DOOR UNIT SYSTEM
Parallel calls from outdoor station
Differentiated calls .......................................................................................................................................... SC101-0735D ..............1a ............. 60

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1a II

DOOR PHONE AND VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEM - DIAGRAM - Section 1A

SECTION 1A CONTENTS

DOOR PHONE AND VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEM - DIAGRAM - Section 1A

SECTION 1A CONTENTS
DOOR PHONE AND VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEM - DIAGRAM

4+N DOOR PHONE SYSTEM DIAGRAM CROSS-REFERENCE TABLE


LIST OF AVAILABLE FUNCTIONS
Number of main panels to be installed
Number of secondary panels to be installed
Single calls from panel: each user has its own call button
Calls from panel in parallel: each user has several door phones in the apartmen
Intercom function: users can communicate with each other
Floor calls: users can be called from the outside of the apartment
Differentiated call: the source of the call can be identified
Timed electrical lock: the energising time of the lock can be controlled
Use of devices with low number of DIN modules
MUTE function: possibility of excluding the call tone
Door open control: open door indicated by means of LED
Conversation privacy: users can only talk and listen if called
Operation of two locks at the same time
Use of kits

DIAGRAM

PAG

CONNECTION OF UP TO 2 DOOR PHONES TO 1 DOOR UNIT

DIAGRAM DESCRIPTION

SC101-0858C

CONNECTION OF UP TO 2 DOOR PHONES TO 1 DOOR UNIT

SC101-1259B

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 1 DOOR UNIT


Door phone with or without insertion key

SC101-1133C

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 1 OUTDOOR STATION


Connection of the sound generator to call door phones from the floor using the same loudspeaker SC101-0252D

22

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 1 OUTDOOR STATION


Solution using the three-tone gong kit for differentiated call to the floor.
The calls from the push button panel are sent with sound generator.
Those to the floor with add-on device for call Ref. 1132/54

SC101-0791E

24

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 1 DOOR UNIT


Solution using additional differential floor call device Ref. 9854/53

SC101-1070C

26

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES MODEL ATLANTICO TO 1 OUTDOOR STATIONS


SC101-1248A
Floor calls on the supplementary loudspeaker

20

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 1 OUTDOOR STATION


Door phone A can open door during call from panel

SC101-0289 I

28

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 1 OUTDOOR STATION


Door open light indicator. Possibility of cutting out calls and respective indications

SC101-1226B

30

SC101-1134E

56

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 1 OUTDOOR STATION


Secrecy of conversation
CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 1 DOOR UNIT
Simultaneous opening of two electrical locks

SC101-0482D

58

CONNECTION OF 6 DOOR PHONES TO 1 DOOR UNIT


Door phones A and B are called individually while door phones C-D-E-F are called in parallel SC101-1273A

CONNECTION OF 6 DOOR PHONES TO 1 DOOR UNIT


Door phones A and B are called individually while door phones C-D-E-F are called in parallel.
SC101-1284A
Floor call service with differentiated tone. Possibility of timing the door open

INTERCOMMUNICATING CONNECTION OF 2 DOOR PHONES WITH THE POSSIBILITY


OF REPLY TO 1 OUTDOOR STATION
Single calls from outdoor station
SC101-1243B

40

INTERCOMMUNICATING CONNECTION OF MAXIMUM 8/13 DOOR PHONES


WITH THE POSSIBILITY OF REPLY TO 1 OUTDOOR STATION
Single calls from outdoor station. Differentiated calls

SC101-0839D

44

INTERCOMMUNICATING CONNECTION OF 2 DOOR PHONES


WITH THE POSSIBILITY OF REPLY TO 1 OUTDOOR STATION
Parallel calls from outdoor station. Differentiated calls

SC101-0578G

42

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL COLUMNS OF DOOR PHONES TO 1 MAIN OUTDOOR STATION


Each column is also connected to its own secondary outdoor station.
SC101-1240A
Use the relay box Ref. 788/51 and the power supply Ref. 786/11

16

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONE COLUMNS TO 1 MAIN DOOR UNIT


Each column is connected to a secondary door unit. Differentiated calls from door units.
Use the power supply wiht relay Ref. 786/15

18

SC101-1282A

K = number of columns with panel

III sec.1a

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

DOOR PHONE AND VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEM - DIAGRAM

LIST OF AVAILABLE FUNCTIONS


Number of main panels to be installed
Number of secondary panels to be installed
Single calls from panel: each user has its own call button
Calls from panel in parallel: each user has several door phones in the apartment
Intercom function: users can communicate with each other
Floor calls: users can be called from the outside of the apartment
Differentiated call: the source of the call can be identified
Timed electrical lock: the energising time of the lock can be controlled
Use of devices with low number of DIN modules
MUTE function: possibility of excluding the call tone
Door open control: open door indicated by means of LED
Conversation privacy: users can only talk and listen if called
Operation of two locks at the same time
DIAGRAM DESCRIPTION
CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 2 OUTDOOR STATIONS
Use the relay box Ref. 788/51 and the power supply Ref. 786/11

SC101-1217C

10

INTERCOMMUNICATING CONNECTION OF 2 DOOR PHONES WITH THE POSSIBILITY


OF REPLY TO 2 OUTDOOR STATION. Single calls from outdoor station

SC101-1249A

46

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONE TO 2 DOOR UNITS


Differentiated calls from door units. Use the power supply wiht relay Ref. 786/15

SC101-1280A

12

INTERCOMMUNICATING CONNECTION OF MAXIMUM 8/13 DOOR PHONES


WITH THE POSSIBILITY OF REPLY TO 2 OUTDOOR STATIONS
Single calls from the push button panels

SC101-0844E

50

INTERCOMMUNICATING CONNECTION OF MAXIMUM 13 DOOR PHONES


WITH THE POSSIBILITY OF REPLY TO 2 OUTDOOR STATIONS
Parallel calls from the push button panels

SC101-0866G

52

INTERCOMMUNICATING CONNECTION OF 2 DOOR PHONES WITH THE POSSIBILITY


OF REPLY TO 2 OUTDOOR STATION. Parallel calls from outdoor station

SC101-1244A

48

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 4 OUTDOOR STATIONS

SC101-1209C

14

INTERCOMMUNICATING CONNECTION OF 2 DOOR PHONES

SC101-0249E

32

INTERCOMMUNICATING CONNECTION OF 4 DOOR PHONES

SC101-1272A

34

INTERCOMMUNICATING CONNECTION OF MAXIMUM 8/13 DOOR PHONES

SC101-0861D

36


4 0

0 0

N N

N 1

PAG

2 0

DIAGRAM

CONNECTION OF 1 MAIN DOOR PHONE TO 7/12 SHUNT DOOR PHONES MAXIMUM

SC101-0863E

38

CONNECTION OF TWO INTERCOMMUNICATING DOOR PHONE EXTENSIONS


TO A SYSTEM WITH DOOR UNIT
Parallel calls from door unit. Differentiated calls

SC101-0567E

54

CONNECTION OF TWO INTERCOM DOOR PHONES WITH POSSIBILITY OF


ANSWERING CALLS FROM ONE SECONDARY DOOR UNIT EXTENSION OF AN
ELECTRICAL DOOR UNIT SYSTEM
Parallel calls from outdoor station. Differentiated calls

SC101-0735D

60

NOTE: The diagrams shown in this table can be made using Sinthesi, K-Steel, 725 panel models.

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1a IV

DOOR PHONE AND VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEM - DIAGRAM - Section 1A

SECTION 1A CONTENTS

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF UP TO 2 DOOR PHONES TO 1 DOOR UNIT

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

Pressing one of the external panel buttons, the bitonal electronic


call is sent to the correspondent door phone loudspeaker. When the
called door phone handset is unhooked, contact is established and
conversation may take place. To operate the electric lock it is sufficient
to press the proper push button.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SC101-0858C:
4+N DOOR PHONE KIT DIAGRAMS
N. X

(*)
N. 1
5

One-family kit (1 button)


Ref. 1129/501
consisting of:
Smyle panel 1 button with built-in door unit.
1 Atlantico door phone (with door opener button and 1
additional button).
Power transformer: Ref. 9000/230 (230Vac-18VA, 3 DIN
modules).
or
Two-family kit (2 buttons)
Ref. 1129/502
consisting of:
Smyle panel 2 buttons with built-in door unit.
2 Atlantico door phones (with door opener button and 1
additional button).
Power transformer: Ref. 9000/230 (230Vac-18VA, 3 DIN
modules).

DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)

C4.001
(*) door phone included in two-family kit only
8
2

SC101-0858C

(*)
CA
1
2
6
9
10

CA

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

1
2
6
9
10

POWER SUPPLY
MAIN ~

PS
1A
2
1
-/~
~

~
~
~0
~12

Lock Release

~12
~0

ELECTRIC
LOCK

2 sec.1a

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

Pressing one of the external panel buttons, the bitonal electronic


call is sent to the correspondent door phone loudspeaker. When the
called door phone handset is unhooked, contact is established and
conversation may take place. To operate the electric lock it is sufficient
to press the proper push button.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SC101-1259B:
4+N DOOR PHONE KIT DIAGRAMS
N. 1

(*)

5
N. 1
5

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF UP TO 2 DOOR PHONES TO 1 DOOR UNIT

One-family kit (1 button)


Ref. 1133/301
consisting of:
Sinthesi door unit module with 1 call button Ref. 1145/21
Door unit Ref. 1145/500
1 Atlantico door phone Ref. 1133/1
1 flush mounting box for 1 module Ref 1145/51
Module holder with frame for 1 module Ref. 1145/61
Power unit 230Vac-28VA, 3 DIN modules Ref. 786/11
or
Two-family kit (2 buttons)
Ref. 1133/302
consisting of:
Sinthesi door unit module with 2 call buttons Ref. 1145/22
Door unit Ref. 1145/500
2 Atlantico door phones Ref. 1133/1
1 flush mounting box for 1 module Ref 1145/51
Module holder with frame for 1 module Ref. 1145/61
Power unit 230Vac-28VA, 3 DIN modules Ref. 786/11

DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)

C4.001
(*) door phone included in two-family kit only

(*)
CA

SC101-1259B

1
2
6
10
9
T1
G/T

T1

CA
1
2
6
10
9
T1
G/T

T1

PS

U2
U1
G/T

-J
-6
+6
~0

L
1A
2
+
1

POWER SUPPLY

Lock Release
MAIN ~

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

MODULE FOR DOOR UNIT


G/T
~0
~12
Posto
Esterno

~0
~12

~12

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

ELECTRIC
LOCK

sec. 1a 3

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 1 DOOR UNIT


Door phone with or without insertion key

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

Pressing one of the external panel buttons, the bitonal electronic


call is sent to the correspondent door phone loudspeaker. When the
called door phone handset is unhooked, contact is established and
conversation may take place. To operate the electric lock it is sufficient
to press the proper push button.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SC101-1133C:
DOOR PHONE REFERENCES
N. X
N. X
N. X

4+(n-2)
5

Door phone Mod. Utopia


or
Door phone Mod. Atlantico
or
Door phone Mod. Atlantico
wiht insertion key

Grey colour

Ref. 1134/1

White colour

Ref. 1133

White colour

Ref. 1133/10

POWER SUPPLY FOR DOOR PHONE SYSTEM REFERENCES


N. 1

Power supply for


door phone system

28VA

Ref. 786/11

4+(n-1)
OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES
Sinthesi model
N. X
Button modules
N. 1
Module with door unit set-up
N. 1
Amplified door unit

Ref. 1145/11-/12-/13-/14
Ref. 1145/20-/21-/22
Ref. 1145/500

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.

4+n

or
K-Steel model
N. X
Button modules
N. 1
Module with door unit

9+n

Ref. 1155/11-/12A-/13A-/14A
Ref. 1155/20-/21-/22A

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

or
725 model
N. 1
Panel with N buttons
N. 1
Amplified door unit

Mod. 725
Ref. 1128/500

For the panels references and the accessories refer to Panels


with anodized Aluminium front plate Mod. 725 section of
Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.
or

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

1128 model
N. 1
Front case for door unit
N. 1
Door unit
N. X
Front case
N. X
Button

Ref. 1128/20-/21
Ref. 1128/500
Ref. 1128/10-/11
Ref. 1128/1-/2

For boards of accessories refer to Wall Mounted Panel


Mod. 1128 section of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system product technical manual.

4 sec.1a

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SC101-1133C
TO THE FOLLOWING
DOOR PHONES

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 1 DOOR UNIT


Door phone with or without insertion key

CA
1
2
6
9
10

CA
1
2
6
9
10
TO THE FOLLOWING
MODULE

(C4.007)
(C4.008)
U4
U3
U2
U1

U2
U1
G/T

PS
(C4.006)
-J
~0

Lock Release

MAIN ~

~
(C4.004)
~12

ELECTRIC
LOCK

Name tag
lighting

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0

L
1A
2
+
1

-6
+6

POWER SUPPLY
FOR DOOR
PHONE SYSTEM

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0
G/T

DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)
C4.001
C4.004
C4.006
Sinthesi models only:
Connect jumper L with G/T.
C4.007

C4.008

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1a 5

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF 6 DOOR PHONES TO 1 DOOR UNIT


Door phones A and B are called individually
while door phones C-D-E-F are called in parallel

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

By pressing U1 or U2 on the panel inside the building, a two-tone


electronic call is sent to the speaker or door phone A or door phone B,
respectively.
By pressing U3 on the panel, door phones C-D-E-F are all called at the
same time.
Lift the handset of the called door phones to establish a conversation
with the door unit. Simply press the corresponding button to release
the electrical door lock.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SC101-1273A:
DOOR PHONE REFERENCES
N. 6
N. 6

Door phone Mod. Utopia


or
Door phone Mod. Atlantico

Grey colour
White colour

Ref. 1134/1
Ref. 1133

POWER SUPPLY FOR DOOR PHONE SYSTEM REFERENCES

5
F

N. 1

Power supply for


door phone system

28VA

Ref. 786/11

OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES

5
E
PARALLEL CALLS

Sinthesi model
N. 1
Button modules
N. 1
Module with door unit set-up
N. 1
Amplified door unit

Ref. 1145/13
Ref. 1145/20
Ref. 1145/500

5
The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with
module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.

D
5
or

5
C

K-Steel model
N. 1
Button modules
N. 1
Module with door unit

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

5
B
6

Ref. 1155/13A
Ref. 1155/20

SINGLE CALLS
or

5
A

725 model
N. 1
Panel with 3 buttons
N. 1
Amplified door unit

Ref. 1155/13A
Ref. 1128/500

or

1128 model
N. 1
Front case for door unit
N. 1
Door unit
N. 3
Button
N. 3
Blank module (*)

12

Ref. 1128/20-/21
Ref. 1128/500
Ref. 1128/1-/2
Ref. 1128/30-/31

(*) for small button installation only


For boards of accessories refer to Wall Mounted Panel
Mod. 1128 section of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system product technical manual.

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)
C4.001
C4.004
C4.006
Sinthesi models only:
Connect jumper L with G/T.
C4.008

6 sec.1a

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SC101-1273A

CA

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF 6 DOOR PHONES TO 1 DOOR UNIT


Door phones A and B are called individually
while door phones C-D-E-F are called in parallel

1
2
6
9
10

CA
1
2
6
9
10

PARALLEL CALLS
CA
1
2
6
9
10

CA
1
2
6
9
10

CA
1
2
6
9
10

SINGLE CALLS
CA
1
2
6
9
10

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0

U3
U2
U1
G/T

MAIN~
~
PS

L
1A
2
+
1

~0
-J
-6
+6

(C4.008)
POWER SUPPLY
FOR HOUSE
PHONE SYSTEM

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

(C4.006)

Lock Release

Name tag
lighting

ELECTRIC
LOCK

~12
(C4.004)

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1a 7

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF 6 DOOR PHONES TO 1 DOOR UNIT


Door phones A and B are called individually while door phones C-D-E-F are called
in parallel. Floor call service with differentiated tone.
Possibility of timing the door open

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

By pressing U1 or U2 on the panel inside the building, a two-tone


electronic call is sent to the speaker or door phone A or door phone B,
respectively.
By pressing U3 on the panel, door phones C-D-E-F are all called at the
same time.
Lift the handset of the called door phones to establish a conversation
with the door unit.
Each apartment is equipped with a floor call button which will operate
the ringer with a differentiated call tone with respect to that of the door
unit.
Simply press the corresponding button to release the electrical door
lock (operation can be timed).

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SC101-1284A:
DOOR PHONE REFERENCES
N. 6
N. 6

Door phone Mod. Utopia


or
Door phone Mod. Atlantico

Grey colour
White colour

Ref. 1134/1
Ref. 1133

POWER SUPPLY FOR DOOR PHONE SYSTEM REFERENCES


N. 1

Power supply for


door phone system

28VA

Ref. 786/13

5
F

OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES

Sinthesi model
N. 1
Button modules
N. 1
Module with door unit set-up
N. 1
Amplified door unit

5
E

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.

PARALLEL CALL

6
5
D

Ref. 1145/13
Ref. 1145/20
Ref. 1145/500

or
K-Steel model
N. 1
Button modules
N. 1
Module with door unit

6
5
C

Ref. 1155/13A
Ref. 1155/20

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

6
5
B

or

SINGLE CALLS

5
A

725 model
N. 1
Panel with 3 buttons
N. 1
Amplified door unit

Ref. 1155/13A
Ref. 1128/500

or
1128 model
N. 1
Front case for door unit
N. 1
Door unit
N. 3
Button
N. 3
Blank module (*)

Ref. 1128/20-/21
Ref. 1128/500
Ref. 1128/1-/2
Ref. 1128/30-/31

(*) for small button installation only

12

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

For boards of accessories refer to Wall Mounted Panel


Mod. 1128 section of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system product technical manual.

DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)
C4.001
C4.006
Sinthesi models only:
Connect jumper L with G/T.
C4.008
VD.007

8 sec.1a

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SC101-1284A
(VD.007)

CA

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF 6 DOOR PHONES TO 1 DOOR UNIT


Door phones A and B are called individually while door phones C-D-E-F are called
in parallel. Floor call service with differentiated tone.
Possibility of timing the door open

1
2
6
9
10
(VD.007)

CA
1
2
6
9
10

PARALLEL CALLS

(VD.007)

CA
1
2
6
9
10
(VD.007)

CA
1
2
6
9
10
(VD.007)

CA
1
2
6
9
10

SINGLE CALLS

(VD.007)

CA
1
2
6
9
10

Name tag
lighting

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12

U3
U2
U1
G/T

PS2
AP
PS
(C4.006)
SE2

POWER SUPPLY
FOR HOUSE
PHONE SYSTEM

L
1A
2
+
1

~0
-J
-6
+6
~

MAIN~

Lock Release

(C4.008)

~
SE1
~12

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

ELECTRIC
LOCK

sec.1a 9

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 2 OUTDOOR STATIONS


Use the relay box Ref. 788/51 and the power supply Ref. 786/11

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

This type of installation solves the problem to connect a series of


house phones of a building with 2 entrances each one equipped with
a push button panel.
This solution permits, by simply pushing a button from one of the 2
push button panels, to connect automatically the user to the calling
push button panels unhooking the handset. This type of installation
does not allow to talk from both outdoor stations simultaneously, since
they work alternatively.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SC101-1217C:
DOOR PHONE REFERENCES
N. X
N. X

Door phone Mod. Utopia


or
Door phone Mod. Atlantico

Grey colour
White colour

Ref. 1134/1
Ref. 1133

4+(n-2)
POWER SUPPLY AND RELAY REFERENCES
N. 1

N. 1

Power supply for


door phone system
Relay box

28VA

Ref. 786/11
Ref. 788/51

OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES

4+(n-1)
Sinthesi model
N. X
Button modules
N. 2
Module with door unit set-up
N. 2
Amplified door unit

Ref. 1145/11-/12-/13-/14
Ref. 1145/20-/21-/22
Ref. 1145/500

5
The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with
module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.
or
K-Steel model
N. X
Button modules
N. 2
Module with door unit

4+n

7+n

7+n

Ref. 1155/11-/12A-/13A-/14A
Ref. 1155/20-/21-/22A

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.
or
725 model
N. 2
Panel with N buttons
N. 2
Amplified door unit

Mod. 725
Ref. 1128/500

For the panels references and the accessories refer to Panels


with anodized Aluminium front plate Mod. 725 section of
Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.
or

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

1128 model
N. 2
Front case for door unit
N. 2
Door unit
N. X
Front case
N. X
Button

Ref. 1128/20-/21
Ref. 1128/500
Ref. 1128/10-/11
Ref. 1128/1-/2

For boards of accessories refer to Wall Mounted Panel


Mod. 1128 section of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system product technical manual.

DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)
C4.001
C4.006
Sinthesi models only:
Connect jumper L with G/T.
C4.007
VX.014

10 sec.1a

C4.008

C4.016

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SC101-1217C
TO THE FOLLOWING DOOR PHONES

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 2 OUTDOOR STATIONS


Use the relay box Ref. 788/51 and the power supply Ref. 786/11

CA
1
2
6
9
10

CA
1
2
6
9
10

TO THE FOLLOWING
MODULE

TO THE FOLLOWING
MODULE
(C4.007)
(C4.008)

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0
G/T

(C4.007)
(C4.008)

U4
U3
U2
U1
8

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0

U2
U1
G/T

SN2

52
U2
U1
G/T

SN1

(C4.006)
L
1A
2
+
1

Name tag
lighting

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0
G/T

U4
U3
U2
U1

(C4.006)
3
6

L
1A
2
+
1

1
4

12
14

10
15

Lock
Release

RELAY

ELECTRIC
LOCK

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0

Lock
Release

13
7

9
C1 C2 11

ELECTRIC
LOCK

Name tag
lighting

~0 ~12

Name tag
lighting

~0
~12

MAIN ~

~
MAIN ~
~

~
(VX.014)

~ PS

+6 -6 ~0 ~12

(C4.007)

POWER SUPPLY
FOR DOOR
PHONE SYSTEM

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

LIGHT BULB
TRANSFORMER

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1a 11

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONE TO 2 DOOR UNITS


Differentiated calls from door units.
Use the power supply wiht relay Ref. 786/15

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

This type of system solves the problem of connecting a door phone


column in a building with two entrances, each of which equipped with
one panel and respective door unit.
In this solution, a visitor can simply press a button on either of the
two panels. The called door phone user can pick up the call and
automatically connect to the calling panel. The other panel will be cut
off.
As a consequence, it is not possible in such as system to speak to two
door units at the same time because either one or the other will be cut
off.
The user can recognise which door unit generated the call thanks to
two different call tones.
Simply press the corresponding button to release the electrical door
lock of the door unit from where the call was generated.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SC101-1280A:
DOOR PHONE REFERENCES
N. X
N. X

Door phone Mod. Utopia


or
Door phone Mod. Atlantico

Grey colour
White colour

Ref. 1134/1
Ref. 1133

POWER SUPPLY AND RELAY REFERENCES


N. 1

Power supply for door phone system

Ref. 786/15

OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES


Sinthesi model
N. X
Button modules
N. 2
Module with door unit set-up
N. 2
Amplified door unit

Ref. 1145/11-/12-/13-/14
Ref. 1145/20-/21-/22
Ref. 1145/500

4+(n-2)
The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with
module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.

5
or

4+(n-1)
5

K-Steel model
N. X
Button modules
N. 2
Module with door unit

Ref. 1155/11-/12A-/13A-/14A
Ref. 1155/20-/21-/22A

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

4+n
or

7+n

7+n

725 model
N. 2
Panel with N buttons
N. 2
Amplified door unit

Mod. 725
Ref. 1128/500

For the panels references and the accessories refer to Panels


with anodized Aluminium front plate Mod. 725 section of
Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

2
or

1128 model
N. 2
Front case for door unit
N. 2
Door unit
N. X
Front case
N. X
Button

Ref. 1128/20-/21
Ref. 1128/500
Ref. 1128/10-/11
Ref. 1128/1-/2

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

For boards of accessories refer to Wall Mounted Panel


Mod. 1128 section of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system product technical manual.

DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)
C4.001
C4.006
Sinthesi models only:
Connect jumper L with G/T.
C4.007

12 sec.1a

C4.008

C4.016

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SC101-1280A
TO THE FOLLOWING DOOR PHONES

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONE TO 2 DOOR UNITS


Differentiated calls from door units.
Use the power supply wiht relay Ref. 786/15

CA
1
2
6
9
10

CA
1
2
6
9
10

TO THE FOLLOWING
MODULE

(C4.007)
(C4.008)
(C4.016)

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0
G/T

U4
U3
U2
U1

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0

Name tag
lighting

U4
U3
U2
U1

U2
U1
G/T

U2
U1
G/T
(C4.006)

L
+
1A
2
1

TO THE FOLLOWING
MODULE

(C4.007)
(C4.008)
(C4.016)

(C4.006)

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0
G/T
G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0

L
+
1A
2
1

ELECTRIC
LOCK

ELECTRIC
LOCK

Lock
Release

Name tag
lighting

Lock
Release
MAIN ~

C1 PS2 C2 PS 7

~12 1 4 SN1 8 - ~0 2 5 SN2 + 6 3 9 -J ~

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

POWER SUPPLY
FOR DOOR
PHONE SYSTEM

sec.1a 13

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 4 OUTDOOR STATIONS

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

This installation allows connection of a series of door phone to 4 push


button panels.
By simply pushing a button on one of the 4 panels, the called door
phone, picking up the handset, is automatically connected with the
calling push button panel.
It is not possible to talk from the outdoor stations simultaneously, since
they work alternatively.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SC101-1209C:
DOOR PHONE REFERENCES
N. X
N. X

Door phone Mod. Utopia


or
Door phone Mod. Atlantico

Grey colour
White colour

Ref. 1134/1
Ref. 1133

4+(n-2)
POWER SUPPLY AND RELAY REFERENCES

N. 1
N. 1

4+(n-1)
5

28VA

Ref. 786/11
Ref. 788/58

OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES


Sinthesi model
N. X
Button modules
N. 4
Module with door unit set-up
N. 4
Amplified door unit

Ref. 1145/11-/12-/13-/14
Ref. 1145/20-/21-/22
Ref. 1145/500

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.

4+n
7+n

Power supply for


door phone system
Relay box

7+n
or

7+n

K-Steel model
N. X
Button modules
N. 4
Module with door unit

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

7+n

Ref. 1155/11-/12A-/13A-/14A
Ref. 1155/20-/21-/22A

or
725 model
N. 4
Panel with N buttons
N. 4
Amplified door unit

Mod. 725
Ref. 1128/500

For the panels references and the accessories refer to Panels


with anodized Aluminium front plate Mod. 725 section of
Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.
or

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

1128 model
N. 4
Front case for door unit
N. 4
Door unit
N. X
Front case
N. X
Button

Ref. 1128/20-/21
Ref. 1128/500
Ref. 1128/10-/11
Ref. 1128/1-/2

For boards of accessories refer to Wall Mounted Panel


Mod. 1128 section of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system product technical manual.

DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)
C4.001
C4.006
Sinthesi models only:
Connect jumper L with G/T.
C4.007

14 sec.1a

C4.008

C4.016

VX.014

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SC101-1209C
TO THE FOLLOWING DOOR PHONES

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 4 OUTDOOR STATIONS

CA
1
2
6
9
10

Name tag
lighting

~0
~12
CA
~
MAIN ~

1
2
6
9
10

~
(VX.014)
LIGHT BULB
TRANSFORMER

TO THE FOLLOWING
MODULE

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0
G/T

TO THE FOLLOWING
MODULE

(C4.007)
(C4.008)
(C4.016)

(C4.007)
(C4.008)
(C4.016)
U4
U3
U2
U1

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0
G/T

U4
U3
U2
U1
AP 2 1

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0

U2
U1
G/T

SN4

SN3

1 IV
2 IV
- IV

1 III
2 III
- III

U2
U1
G/T

(C4.006)

(C4.006)

L
1A
2
+
1

L
1A
2
+
1
Lock Release

Lock Release
Name tag
lighting

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0

AP IV

ELECTRIC
LOCK

AP III

TO THE FOLLOWING
MODULE

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0

U4
U3
U2
U1

U4
U3
U2
U1

U2
U1
G/T

SN1

SN2

1I
2I
-I

1 II
2 II
- II

U2
U1
G/T

(C4.006)

(C4.006)

L
1A
2
+
1

RELAY
BOX

Lock Release
Name tag
lighting

TO THE FOLLOWING
MODULE

(C4.007)
(C4.008)
(C4.016)

(C4.007)
(C4.008)
(C4.016)
G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0
G/T

AP I

ELECTRIC
LOCK

AP II

Name tag
lighting

ELECTRIC
LOCK

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0
G/T
G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0

L
1A
2
+
1
Lock Release

ELECTRIC
LOCK

Name tag
lighting

~ ~
0 12 C1 C2

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

MAIN ~
POWER SUPPLY FOR
DOOR PHONE SYSTEM
+6 ~0 ~12 -6

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

PS

sec.1a 15

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL COLUMNS OF DOOR PHONES


TO 1 MAIN OUTDOOR STATION
Each column is also connected to its own secondary outdoor station.
Use the relay box Ref. 788/51 and the power supply Ref. 786/11

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

It is the ideal solution for residential centers where the single villas
have to be connected to both their own outdoor stations and a common
one at the main entrance.
During the call the concerned door phone is automatically switched to
the common outdoor station or to the one of the group it belongs to, by
means of a switching relay.
Services towards secondary outdoor stations are independent and can
therefore take place at the same time.
When the call comes from the common outdoor station, only the group
the called door phone belongs to is switched to it, the others being
able to carry on the normal service with their own secondary outdoor
stations.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SC101-1240A:
DOOR PHONE REFERENCES
N. X
N. X

4+(n-2)

Grey colour
White colour

Ref. 1134/1
Ref. 1133

POWER SUPPLY AND RELAY REFERENCES


N. 1

4+(n-2)

Door phone Mod. Utopia


or
Door phone Mod. Atlantico

N. K
N. 1

Power supply for


door phone system
Relay box
Call repeater relay

28VA

Ref. 786/11
Ref. 788/51
Ref. 788/52

5
OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES

4+(n-1)

4+(n-1)

4+n

4+n

Sinthesi model
N. X
Button modules
N. K+1 Module with door unit set-up
N. K+1 Amplified door unit

Ref. 1145/11-/12-/13-/14
Ref. 1145/20-/21-/22
Ref. 1145/500

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.
or

9+n

5+n

5+n

K-Steel model
N. X
Button modules
N. K+1 Module with door unit

Ref. 1155/11-/12A-/13A-/14A
Ref. 1155/20-/21-/22A

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

9+n
5+K+n
or

725 model
N. K+1 Panel with N buttons
N. K+1 Amplified door unit

8+K+
n+n...

For the panels references and the accessories refer to Panels


with anodized Aluminium front plate Mod. 725 section of
Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

2
or

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

1128 model
N. K+1 Front case for door unit
N. K+1 Door unit
N. X
Front case
N. X
Button

2
K= quantity of columns

Mod. 725
Ref. 1128/500

Ref. 1128/20-/21
Ref. 1128/500
Ref. 1128/10-/11
Ref. 1128/1-/2

For boards of accessories refer to Wall Mounted Panel


Mod. 1128 section of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system product technical manual.
(K= quantity of columns)

16 sec.1a

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SC101-1240A
1ST COLUMN

2ND COLUMN

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL COLUMNS OF DOOR PHONES


TO 1 MAIN OUTDOOR STATION
Each column is also connected to its own secondary outdoor station.
Use the relay box Ref. 788/51 and the power supply Ref. 786/11

CA
1
2
6
9
10

CA
1
2
6
9
10

TO THE FOLLOWING
MODULE
RELAY
BOX

(C4.007)
(C4.008)
(C4.017)
8

52

10
11
12

SN2

SN1

G/T
U4
U3
U2
U1

~12
~0
~0
~12
G/T

U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12

CONNECTION
AS 1ST GROUP

(C4.006)
L
1A
2
+
1

3
6

1
4

Lock
Release
14
7
C1

13
9
15
~
12

ELECTRIC LOCK

SN1

(C4.007)
(C4.008)
(C4.017)

1
4
-6

MAIN ~
~12
~0
~0
~12
G/T

G/T
U4
U3
U2
U1

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12

U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T

~12
~0
~0
~12
G/T

G/T
U4
U3
U2
U1

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12

U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T

~12
~0
~0
~12
G/T

G/T
U4
U3
U2
U1

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12

U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T

7
C1
POWER SUPPLY FOR
DOOR PHONE SYSTEM

PS ~ - + ~
0 6 6 12

Calls

SN1

Name tag
lighting
L
1A
2
+
1

1
4
-6

ELECTRIC
LOCK

RELAY
BOX

Common

7
C1
CA
2
S1
S3
~12
~0
6
C
S2

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

Lock
Release

TO THE FOLLOWING
GROUP

TO THE FOLLOWING
MODULE

~
C2 0

Name tag
lighting

MAIN ~

~ + - ~
12 6 6 0 PS

POWER SUPPLY FOR


DOOR PHONE SYSTEM
~

DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)
C4.001
C4.006
Sinthesi models only:
Connect jumper L with G/T.
C4.007

C4.008

C4.017

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1a 17

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONE COLUMNS TO 1 MAIN DOOR UNIT


Each column is connected to a secondary door unit. Differentiated calls from door
units. Use the power supply wiht relay Ref. 786/15

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

The system is useful in residential centres where individual houses or


blocks need to be connected to their own door units and to a common
door unit located at the main entrance.
The concerned door phone is automatically switched onto the common
door unit or onto the secondary door unit of the concerned group when
called by means of a switching relay.
Services to secondary door units are mutually interdependent and
therefore may occur at the same time.
When a call is made from the common door unit, only the group
to which the called door phone belongs is switched. The other door
phones can be continue to work with their own secondary units.
The user can recognise calls from the main door unit or the secondary
door unit thanks to two different call tones.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SC101-1282A:
DOOR PHONE REFERENCES
N. X
N. X

4+(n-2)

Grey colour
White colour

Ref. 1134/1
Ref. 1133

POWER SUPPLY AND RELAY REFERENCES


N. K
N. 1

4+(n-2)

Door phone Mod. Utopia


or
Door phone Mod. Atlantico

N. 1

Column power supply


Power supply for
door phone system
Call repeater relay

Ref. 786/15
28VA

Ref. 786/11
Ref. 788/52

5
OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES

4+(n-1)

4+(n-1)

4+n

4+n

Sinthesi model
N. X
Button modules
N. K+1 Module with door unit set-up
N. K+1 Amplified door unit

Ref. 1145/11-/12-/13-/14
Ref. 1145/20-/21-/22
Ref. 1145/500

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.
or:

9+n

5+n

5+n

K-Steel model
N. X
Button modules
N. K+1 Module with door unit

Ref. 1155/11-/12A-/13A-/14A
Ref. 1155/20-/21-/22A

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

9+n
5+K+n
or

725 model
N. K+1 Panel with N buttons
N. K+1 Amplified door unit

8+K+
n+n...

For the panels references and the accessories refer to Panels


with anodized Aluminium front plate Mod. 725 section of
Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

2
or

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

1128 model
N. K+1 Front case for door unit
N. K+1 Door unit
N. X
Front case
N. X
Button

2
K= quantity of columns

18 sec.1a

Mod. 725
Ref. 1128/500

Ref. 1128/20-/21
Ref. 1128/500
Ref. 1128/10-/11
Ref. 1128/1-/2

For boards of accessories refer to Wall Mounted Panel


Mod. 1128 section of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system
product technical manual.

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SC101-1282A
1ST COLUMN

2ND COLUMN

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONE COLUMNS TO ONE MAIN DOOR UNIT


Each column is connected to a secondary door unit. Differentiated calls from door
units. Use the power supply wiht relay Ref. 786/15

CA
1
2
6
9
10

CA
1
2
6
9
10

TO THE FOLLOWING
MODULE
COLUMN
POWER SUPPLY

CONNECTION
AS 1ST GROUP

(C4.007)
(C4.008)
(C4.017)
8

52

SN2

SN1

G/T
U4
U3
U2
U1

~12
~0
~0
~12
G/T

U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12

(C4.006)

TO THE FOLLOWING
MODULE

L
1A
2
- Loudspeaking
unit
+
1

3
6

1
4
-

+
~0
PS

(C4.007)
(C4.008)
(C4.017)

~12
~0
~0
~12
G/T

G/T
U4
U3
U2
U1

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12

U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T

~12
~0
~0
~12
G/T

G/T
U4
U3
U2
U1

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12

U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T

~12
~0
~0
~12
G/T

G/T
U4
U3
U2
U1

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12

U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T

Name tag
lighting

Lock
Release

C2
9
~12

7
C1

ELECTRIC
LOCK

SN1
1
4

PS2

0 230

MAIN ~

TO THE FOLLOWING
GROUP

Calls

SN1

Name tag
lighting

L
1A
2
+
1

1
4
-

Common

7
Lock
Release

ELECTRIC
LOCK
CALL
REPEATER
RELAY

CA
2
S1
S3
~12
~0
6
C
S2

MAIN ~

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

Loudspeaking
unit

POWER SUPPLY
FOR DOOR PHONE SYSTEM
~12 +6 -6 ~0

DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)
C4.001
C4.006
Sinthesi models only:
Connect jumper L with G/T.
C4.007

C4.008

C4.017

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1a 19

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES MODEL ATLANTICO


TO 1 OUTDOOR STATIONS
Floor calls on the supplementary loudspeaker

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

Pressing one of the external panel buttons, the bitonal electronic


call is sent to the correspondent door phone loudspeaker. When the
called door phone handset is unhooked, contact is established and
conversation may take place. To operate the electric lock it is sufficient
to press the proper push button.
Floor calls can be differentiated from door unit calls by adding devices
Ref. 787/1.
The additional loudspeaker Ref. 9854/54 has more high call tone.
This type of system can be made with Atlantico door phones only.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SC101-1248A:
DOOR PHONE REFERENCES
N. X
N. X

Door phone Mod. Atlantico


Additional speaker

Ref. 1133
Ref. 9854/54

POWER SUPPLY FOR DOOR PHONE SYSTEM REFERENCES

6+(n-2)

N. 1
N. 1

Power supply for


door phone system
Tone generator

28VA

Ref. 786/11
Ref. 787/1

TC
OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES
Sinthesi model
N. X
Button modules
N. 1
Module with door unit set-up
N. 1
Amplified door unit

6+(n-1)

Ref. 1145/11-/12-/13-/14
Ref. 1145/20-/21-/22
Ref. 1145/500

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.

TC
or

K-Steel model
N. X
Button modules
N. 1
Module with door unit

6+n

Ref. 1155/11-/12A-/13A-/14A
Ref. 1155/20-/21-/22A

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

9+n
2

or
725 model
N. 1
Panel with N buttons
N. 1
Amplified door unit

Mod. 725
Ref. 1128/500

For the panels references and the accessories refer to Panels


with anodized Aluminium front plate Mod. 725 section of
Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.
or
1128 model
N. 1
Front case for door unit
N. 1
Door unit
N. X
Front case
N. X
Button

Ref. 1128/20-/21
Ref. 1128/500
Ref. 1128/10-/11
Ref. 1128/1-/2

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

For boards of accessories refer to Wall Mounted Panel


Mod. 1128 section of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system product technical manual.

DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)
C4.001
C4.004
C4.006
Sinthesi models only:
Connect jumper L with G/T.
C4.007

20 sec.1a

C4.008

VD.007

VX.006

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SC101-1248A

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES MODEL ATLANTICO


TO 1 OUTDOOR STATIONS
Floor calls on the supplementary loudspeaker

CA
1
2
6
9
10
(VX.006)
(VD.007)

CA
1
2
6
9
10
(VX.006)
(VD.007)

TO THE FOLLOWING
MODULE
(C4.007)
(C4.008)
U4
U3
U2
U1

SN
PS
TONE
GENERATOR

~12
~0
U2
U1
G/T

PS
(C4.006)

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0
G/T
G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0

L
1A
2
+
1

~0
-6
+6
POWER SUPPLY FOR
DOOR PHONE SYSTEM
Lock Release

~12

Name tag
lighting
ELECTRIC LOCK

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

(C4.004)

~
MAIN ~
~

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1a 21

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 1 OUTDOOR STATION


Connection of the sound generator to call door phones
from the floor using the same loudspeaker

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

When one of the keys of the push button panel located outside
the building is pressed, the two-tone electronic call is sent to the
loudspeaker of the matching door phone. When the handset of the
door phone called is lifted, the contact between the outside and inside
is established and the conversant can start.
To activate the electric lock, press the matching key.
Adding the Ref. 787/1 tone generator, it is possible to use the
loudspeaker of the door phone for the call from the floor without having
to add other buzzers. The call tone differs from that sent to the push
button panel making it possible to identify the source.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SC101-0252D:
DOOR PHONE REFERENCES
N. X
N. X

Door phone Mod. Utopia


or
Door phone Mod. Atlantico

Grey colour
White colour

Ref. 1134/1
Ref. 1133

POWER SUPPLY FOR DOOR PHONE SYSTEM REFERENCES

5+(n-2)

N. 1
N. 1

Power supply for


door phone system
Tone generator

28VA

Ref. 786/11
Ref. 787/1

TC
OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES
Sinthesi model
N. X
Button modules
N. 1
Module with door unit set-up
N. 1
Amplified door unit

5+(n-1)

Ref. 1145/11-/12-/13-/14
Ref. 1145/20-/21-/22
Ref. 1145/500

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.

TC
or

K-Steel model
N. X
Button modules
N. 1
Module with door unit

5+n

Ref. 1155/11-/12A-/13A-/14A
Ref. 1155/20-/21-/22A

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

9+n
2

or
725 model
N. 1
Panel with N buttons
N. 1
Amplified door unit

Mod. 725
Ref. 1128/500

For the panels references and the accessories refer to Panels


with anodized Aluminium front plate Mod. 725 section of
Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.
or

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

1128 model
N. 1
Front case for door unit
N. 1
Door unit
N. X
Front case
N. X
Button

Ref. 1128/20-/21
Ref. 1128/500
Ref. 1128/10-/11
Ref. 1128/1-/2

For boards of accessories refer to Wall Mounted Panel


Mod. 1128 section of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system
product technical manual.

DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)
C4.001
VD.007

22 sec.1a

C4.004

C4.006

C4.007

C4.008

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SC101-0252D
TO THE FOLLOWING
DOOR PHONES

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 1 OUTDOOR STATION


Connection of the sound generator to call door phones
from the floor using the same loudspeaker

(VD.007)
CA
1
2
6
9
10

(VD.007)
CA
1
2
6
9
10

MAIN ~

~ + -~
12 6 6 0 PS J

~ ~ PS SN
0 12

TONE
GENERATOR

POWER SUPPLY FOR


DOOR PHONE SYSTEM

TO THE FOLLOWING
MODULE
(C4.007)
(C4.008)

U2
U1
G/T
(C4.006)

Lock Release
(C4.004)

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0
G/T
G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0

L
1A
2
+
1

ELECTRIC LOCK

Name tag
lighting

sec.1a 23

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

U4
U3
U2
U1

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 1 OUTDOOR STATION


Solution using the three-tone gong kit for differentiated call to the floor
The calls from the push button panel are sent with sound generator
Those to the floor with add-on device for call Ref. 1132/54

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

When one of the keys of the push button panel located outside
the building is pressed, the two-tone electronic call is sent to the
Loudspeaker of the matching door phone. When the handset of the
door phone called is lifted, the contact between the outside and inside
is established and the conversation can start. To activate the electric
lock, press the matching key.
Adding the three-tone Gong kit inside each door phone and an extra
power supply, the call can be made to the floor differentiating this from
those sent by the external push button panel. The Ref. 1132/54 makes
it possible to transform the normal call signal into a three-toner Gong
to be sent to the loudspeaker of the door phone.
This device must be powered at 12Vdc; additional power unit
Ref. 1090/850 may be used. For this purpose, include one additional
wire in the system for the + terminal and another additional wire to
connect to the PS terminal of the door phone power unit cut by the
floor call button.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SC101-0791E:
DOOR PHONE REFERENCES
N. X
N. X

Door phone Mod. Utopia


or
Door phone Mod. Atlantico

N. X

Add-on device for call

White colour

Ref. 1134/1
Ref. 1133
Ref. 1132/54

POWER SUPPLY FOR DOOR PHONE SYSTEM REFERENCES


N. 1
N. 1

6+(n-2)

Grey colour

Power supply for


door phone system
Additional power unit

28VA

Ref. 786/11
Ref. 1090/850

OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES


Sinthesi model
N. X
Button modules
N. 1
Module with door unit set-up
N. 1
Amplified door unit

TC

Ref. 1145/11-/12-/13-/14
Ref. 1145/20-/21-/22
Ref. 1145/500

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.

6+(n-1)

or

TC

K-Steel model
N. X
Button modules
N. 1
Module with door unit

Ref. 1155/11-/12A-/13A-/14A
Ref. 1155/20-/21-/22A

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

6+n

or

9+n
2

725 model
N. 1
Panel with N buttons
N. 1
Amplified door unit

Mod. 725
Ref. 1128/500

For the panels references and the accessories refer to Panels


with anodized aluminium front plate Mod. 725 section of
Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.
or

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

1128 model
N. 1
Front case for door unit
N. 1
Door unit
N. X
Front case
N. X
Button

Ref. 1128/20-/21
Ref. 1128/500
Ref. 1128/10-/11
Ref. 1128/1-/2

For boards of accessories refer to Wall Mounted Panel


Mod. 1128 section of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system
product technical manual.

DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)
C4.001
C4.006
C4.008
VD.007

24 sec.1a

C4.004
C4.007
VX.006

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SC101-0791E
TO THE FOLLOWING
DOOR PHONES

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 1 OUTDOOR STATION


Solution using the three-tone gong kit for differentiated call to the floor
The calls from the push button panel are sent with sound generator
Those to the floor with add-on device for call Ref. 1132/54

1
2
6
9
10
CA

CA
6
CH2
+
CH1
(VX.006)
(VD.007)

1
2
6
9
10
CA

CA
6
CH2
+
CH1
(VX.006)

(VD.007)

TO THE FOLLOWING
MODULE
P1
P2
0
MAIN ~

U4
U3
U2
U1

230
Vout
GND

U2
U1
G/T

PS
(C4.006)
POWER SUPPLY FOR
DOOR PHONE SYSTEM

-J
~0

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0

L
1A
2
+
1

-6
+6
Lock Release

~
MAIN ~
~

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0
G/T

(C4.004)

~12

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

ELECTRIC
LOCK

Name tag
lighting

sec.1a 25

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

ADDITIONAL
POWER UNIT

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 1 DOOR UNIT


Solution using additional differential floor call device Ref. 9854/53

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

When one of the keys of the push button panel located outside
the building is pressed, the two-tone electronic call is sent to the
Loudspeaker of the matching door phone. When the handset of the
door phone called is lifted, the contact between the outside and inside
is established and the conversation can start. To activate the electric
lock, press the matching key.
Floor calls can be differentiated from door unit calls by fitting an
additional device inside each door phone.
The device must be powered either at 12Vdc or 12Vac. For powering
the device at 12Vac, simply include one extra wire in the column
connected to the door phone power unit terminal ~12. Use an additional
dc power unit Ref. 1090/850 to power the device is powered at
12Vdc.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SC101-1070C:
DOOR PHONE REFERENCES
N. X
N. X

Door phone Mod. Utopia


or
Door phone Mod. Atlantico

N. X

Add-on device for call

Grey colour
White colour

Ref. 1134/1
Ref. 1133
Ref. 9854/53

POWER SUPPLY FOR DOOR PHONE SYSTEM REFERENCES


N. 1

6+(n-2)
7

N. 1

28VA

Ref. 786/11
Ref. 1090/850

OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES

TC

Sinthesi model
N. X
Button modules
N. 1
Module with door unit set-up
N. 1
Amplified door unit

6+(n-1)

Power supply for


door phone system
Additional power unit

Ref. 1145/11-/12-/13-/14
Ref. 1145/20-/21-/22
Ref. 1145/500

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.

TC
or

K-Steel model
N. X
Button modules
N. 1
Module with door unit

Ref. 1155/11-/12A-/13A-/14A
Ref. 1155/20-/21-/22A

6+n
The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with
module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.
or

9+n
2

725 model
N. 1
Panel with N buttons
N. 1
Amplified door unit

Mod. 725
Ref. 1128/500

For the panels references and the accessories refer to Panels


with anodized aluminium front plate Mod. 725 section of
Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.
or

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

1128 model
N. 1
Front case for door unit
N. 1
Door unit
N. X
Front case
N. X
Button

Ref. 1128/20-/21
Ref. 1128/500
Ref. 1128/10-/11
Ref. 1128/1-/2

For boards of accessories refer to Wall Mounted Panel


Mod. 1128 section of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system
product technical manual.

DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)
C4.001
C4.006
C4.008
VX.006

26 sec.1a

C4.004
C4.007
VD.007

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SC101-1070C
TO THE FOLLOWING
DOOR PHONES

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 1 DOOR UNIT


Solution using additional differential floor call device Ref. 9854/53

CA
1
2
6
9
10

CA
1
2
6
9
10

CH
CP+
CP(VD.007)

(VX.006)

TO THE FOLLOWING
MODULE

P1
P2
U4
U3
U2
U1

MAIN ~

230
Vout
GND

U2
U1
G/T

PS
(C4.006)
-J
~0
POWER SUPPLY FOR
DOOR PHONE SYSTEM

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0

L
1A
2
+
1

-6
+6
Lock Release

~
MAIN ~

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0
G/T

(C4.004)

~12

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

ELECTRIC
LOCK

Name tag
lighting

sec.1a 27

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

0
ADDITIONAL
POWER UNIT

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 1 OUTDOOR STATION


Door phone A can open door during call from panel

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

This service is particularly required by professional offices, where a lot


of people coming in and out obliges to often open the door without the
use of the door phone to talk with the outside.
Scheme SC101-0289 I shows the connection of one or more house
phones suitable for this service in a normal outdoor system. The relay
box Ref. 788/52 and the power supply Ref. 1090/850 have to be
foreseen.
With the switch in ON position, when the visitors calls the door phone
buzzer doesnt ring, but the relay starts and automatically opens the
electric lock.
The switch ON position is signaled on the door phone by GREEN LED
lighting.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SC101-0289 I:
DOOR PHONE REFERENCES
N. X

Door phone Mod. Atlantico

White colour

Ref. 1133

DOOR PHONE A REFERENCES


N. 1

Door phone Mod. Atlantico with 1 key


+ mute kit

Ref. 1133/1
Ref. 1133/56

POWER SUPPLY FOR DOOR PHONE SYSTEM REFERENCES

4+(n-1)

N. 1
N. 1
N. 1
N. 1

Power supply for


door phone system
Additional power unit
Transformer
Relay box

28VA

Ref. 786/11
Ref. 1090/850
Ref. 9000/230
Ref. 788/52

OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES

4+n

Sinthesi model
N. X
Button modules
N. 1
Module with door unit set-up
N. 1
Amplified door unit

Ref. 1145/11-/12-/13-/14
Ref. 1145/20-/21-/22
Ref. 1145/500

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.
or

8+n

K-Steel model
N. X
Button modules
N. 1
Module with door unit

Ref. 1155/11-/12A-/13A-/14A
Ref. 1155/20-/21-/22A

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

9+n
2
or

725 model
N. 1
Panel with N buttons
N. 1
Amplified door unit

Mod. 725
Ref. 1128/500

For the panels references and the accessories refer to Panels


with anodized aluminium front plate Mod. 725 section of
Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.
or

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

1128 model
N. 1
Front case for door unit
N. 1
Door unit
N. X
Front case
N. X
Button

Ref. 1128/20-/21
Ref. 1128/500
Ref. 1128/10-/11
Ref. 1128/1-/2

For boards of accessories refer to Wall Mounted Panel


Mod. 1128 section of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system
product technical manual.

DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)
C4.001
C4.006
C4.008

28 sec.1a

C4.004
C4.007
VX.006

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SC101-0289 I
TO THE FOLLOWING
DOOR PHONES

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 1 OUTDOOR STATION


Door phone A can open door during call from panel

CA
1
2
6
9
10

CA
1
2
6
9
10

10
CA
Rz
R
+
AP

MAIN ~

MAIN ~

~ ~
~ ~
12 0

0 230

TRANSFORMER

P1 P2 Vout GND

6 S1 CA S3
~ ~
0 12

TO THE FOLLOWING
MODULE

RELAY
BOX

ADDITIONAL
POWER UNIT

(C4.007)
(C4.008)
U4
U3
U2
U1

U2
U1
G/T

PS
(C4.006)
-J
~0
POWER SUPPLY FOR
DOOR PHONE SYSTEM

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0
G/T
G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0

L
1A
2
+
1

-6
+6
Lock
Release

~
MAIN ~
~
(C4.004)
~12

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

ELECTRIC
LOCK

Name tag
lighting

sec.1a 29

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

(VX.006)

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 1 OUTDOOR STATION

Door open light indicator.


Possibility of cutting out calls and respective indications

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

Possibility of cut-off. (privacy on)


With an installation as per Scheme SC101-1226B, operation will be
the following:
With the switch in OFF position the call sent from push button panel will
reach the proper door phone loudspeaker; the GREEN LED is off.
With the switch in ON position the door phone is cut-off and the
GREEN LED is on (the circuit between RZ and R is closed).

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SC101-1226B:

Possibility of main door gate check


Connect as shown in diagram for providing open door signalling
function. and to equip the door with the proper contact.
With said installation the RED LED of all house phones will be on when
the main door gate is open.

DOOR PHONE REFERENCES


DOOR PHONE A REFERENCES
Max. 7 Door phone Mod. Atlantico with 2 LEDs
1 switch

Ref. 1133/20

DOOR PHONE B REFERENCES


Max. 7 Door phone Mod. Atlantico with 1 key
Max. 7 Mute kit + led

Ref. 1133/1
Ref. 1133/56

POWER SUPPLY FOR DOOR PHONE SYSTEM REFERENCES


N. 1
N. 1

Power supply for


door phone system
Additional power unit A

28VA

Ref. 786/11
Ref. 1090/850

OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES

Sinthesi model
N. X
Button modules
N. 4
Module with door unit set-up
N. 4
Amplified door unit

6+(n-1)

Ref. 1145/11-/12-/13-/14
Ref. 1145/20-/21-/22
Ref. 1145/500

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.

7
or
K-Steel model
N. X
Button modules
N. 4
Module with door unit

6+n

Ref. 1155/11-/12A-/13A-/14A
Ref. 1155/20-/21-/22A

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

11+n
or

725 model
N. 1
Panel with N buttons
N. 1
Amplified door unit

Mod. 725
Ref. 1128/500

For the panels references and the accessories refer to Panels


with anodized aluminium front plate Mod. 725 section of
Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.
or

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

1128 model
N. 1
Front case for door unit
N. 1
Door unit
N. X
Front case
N. X
Button

Ref. 1128/20-/21
Ref. 1128/500
Ref. 1128/10-/11
Ref. 1128/1-/2

For boards of accessories refer to Wall Mounted Panel


Mod. 1128 section of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system
product technical manual.

DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)
C4.001
C4.007
VX.006

30 sec.1a

C4.004
C4.008
VX.014

C4.006

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

Door open light indicator.


Possibility of cutting out calls and respective indications

SC101-1226B
TO THE FOLLOWING
DOOR PHONES

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 1 OUTDOOR STATION

MAIN~
CA
1
2
6
9
10
Rz
R
AP
+

~
~

(VX.014)

Name tag
lighting

12 ~
~

LIGHT BULB
TRANSFORMER

CA
1
2
6
9
10

B
(VX.006)

10
CA
Rz
R
AP
+

TO THE FOLLOWING
MODULE
P1

(C4.007) (C4.008)

P2
0

U4
U3
U2
U1

MAIN~

230
Vout
GND

U2
U1
G/T

PS
(C4.006)
-J
~0

POWER SUPPLY FOR


DOOR PHONE SYSTEM

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0
G/T

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0

L
1
2
+
1A

-6
+6

Lock Release

MAIN~
~

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

ADDITIONAL
POWER UNIT

(C4.004)

~12

ELECTRIC
LOCK

Name tag
lighting

DOOR OPEN CONTACT

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1a 31

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

INTERCOMMUNICATING CONNECTION OF 2 DOOR PHONES

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

This installation allows communication between two separate places,


such as: shop-warehouse, directors office - secretarys office, etc.
The calling house phones handset must be unhooked and the hook
lever pressed to the bottom in order to establish the connection with
the called door phone. As soon as the called door phone handset is
picked up, connection is made.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SC101-0249E:
DOOR PHONE REFERENCES
N. 2
N. 2

Door phone Mod. Utopia


or
Door phone Mod. Atlantico

Grey colour
White colour

Ref. 1134/1
Ref. 1133

2
POWER SUPPLY FOR DOOR PHONE SYSTEM REFERENCES
N. 1

Power supply for


door phone system

28VA

Ref. 786/11

DIAGRAM NOTES
6
4

(see section 1)
C4.001

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

VX.021
Cut or remove the jumpers on the device(s) 6 - 10.

32 sec.1a

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SC101-0249E
CA
1

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

INTERCOMMUNICATING CONNECTION OF 2 DOOR PHONES

2
6
10
9
(VX.021)

CA
1
2
6
10
9
(VX.021)

MAIN~

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

POWER SUPPLY FOR


DOOR PHONE SYSTEM

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1a 33

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

INTERCOMMUNICATING CONNECTION OF 4 DOOR PHONES

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

To communicate with any of the other house phones, the user must
press the call key corresponding to the door phone required. On lifting
the handset, the user called is automatically connected to the calling
door phone.
The service is not secret, i.e. if the user of a third door phone lifts the
handset while other two are talking, the conversation can be heard.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SC101-1272A:
DOOR PHONE REFERENCES
N. 4
N. 8
N. 4
N. 8

Door phone Mod. Utopia


Grey colour
Additional buttons (packing of 8)
or
Door phone Mod. Atlantico with 1 key
Additional buttons (packing of 10)

Ref. 1134/1
Ref. 1134/55
Ref. 1133/1
Ref. 1133/55

POWER SUPPLY FOR DOOR PHONE SYSTEM REFERENCES


N. 1

Power supply for


door phone system

28VA

Ref. 786/11

4+n
DIAGRAM NOTES

4+n

(see section 1)

4+n

C4.001
VX.006

4+n

4+n

4+n

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

34 sec.1a

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SC101-1272A

CA
1

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

INTERCOMMUNICATING CONNECTION OF 4 DOOR PHONES

2
6
10
9

(C4.003)
(VX.006)

T1
G/T
T2
G/T
T3
G/T

CA
1
2
6
10
9

(C4.003)
(VX.006)

T1
G/T
T2
G/T
T3
G/T

CA
1
2
6
10
9

(C4.003)
(VX.006)

T1
G/T
T2
G/T
T3
G/T

CA
1
2
6
10
9

(C4.003)
(VX.006)

T1
G/T
T2
G/T
T3
G/T

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

MAIN~
POWER SUPPLY FOR
DOOR PHONE SYSTEM
~ + - PS - ~
06 J
6 12

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1a 35

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

INTERCOMMUNICATING CONNECTION OF MAXIMUM 13 DOOR PHONES

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

This system is made of a main centralized door phone and of shunt


phones. The main door phone can call and be called by the shunt
phones.
The shunt phones can only call the main phone but cannot call one
another.
In order to call a shunt phone, the main one must push the
corresponding key; in order to call the main phone, the shunts must
press the proper key.
Using the Mod. Atlantico with 12 additional key, it is possible to call up
to 13 shunt phones
.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SC101-0861D:
DOOR PHONE REFERENCES
N. 13

5+n

Ref. 1133/12

POWER SUPPLY FOR DOOR PHONE SYSTEM REFERENCES


N. 1

5+n

Door phone Mod. Atlantico with


12 additional key

Power supply for


door phone system

28VA

Ref. 786/11

DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)
C4.001
VX.006

5+n
5+n

5+n
5+n

5+n

10+n

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

36 sec.1a

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SC101-0861D

TO THE FOLLOWING DOOR PHONES

U12
U11
U10
U9
U8
U7

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

INTERCOMMUNICATING CONNECTION OF MAXIMUM 13 DOOR PHONES

U6
U5
U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T
CA
1
2
6
10
9
-/~
+/~
U12
U11
U10
U9
U8
U7
U6
U5
U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T
CA
1
2
6
10
9
-/~
+/~
U12
U11
U10
U9
U8
U7
U6
U5
U4
U3
U2

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

U1
G/T
CA
1
2
6
10
9
-/~
+/~
MAIN~
POWER SUPPLY FOR
DOOR PHONE SYSTEM
~ - +PS
0J6

- ~ ~ ~
6 18 12

(VX.008)

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1a 37

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF 1 MAIN DOOR PHONE TO 12 SHUNT DOOR PHONES MAXIMUM

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

This system is made of a main centralized door phone and of shunt


phones. The main door phone can call and be called by the shunt
phones.
The shunt phones can only call the main phone but cannot call one
another.
In order to call a shunt phone, the main one must push the
corresponding key; in order to call the main phone, the shunts must
press the proper key.
Using the Mod. Atlantico Atlantico with 12 additional key, it is possible
to call up to 12 shunt phones
.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SC101-0863E:

5+(n-2)
6

DOOR PHONE REFERENCES


MAIN DOOR PHONE REFERENCES
N. 1
Door phone Mod. Atlantico with
12 additional key

Ref. 1133/12

SHUNT DOOR PHONES REFERENCES


N. 7
Door phone Mod. Atlantico

Ref. 1133

POWER SUPPLY FOR DOOR PHONE SYSTEM REFERENCES


N. 1

Power supply for


door phone system

28VA

Ref. 786/11

DIAGRAM NOTES
5+(n-1)
(see section 1)
C4.001
VX.006

VX.021
Cut or remove the jumpers on the device(s) 6 - 10.

5+n

5+n

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

38 sec.1a

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SC101-0863E

SHUNT DOOR PHONES

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF 1 MAIN DOOR PHONE TO 12 SHUNT DOOR PHONES MAXIMUM

CA
1
2
6
10
9
(VX.021)
CA
1
2
6
10
9
(VX.021)

MAIN DOOR PHONE


Mod. Atlantico
U12
U11
U10
U9
U8
U7
U6
U5
U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T
CA
1
2
6
10
9
-/~
+/~

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

MAIN~

POWER SUPPLY FOR


DOOR PHONE SYSTEM
~ ~ ~ - + PS
18 12 0 J 6

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1a 39

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

INTERCOMMUNICATING CONNECTION OF 2 DOOR PHONES


WITH THE POSSIBILITY OF REPLY TO 1 OUTDOOR STATION
Single calls from outdoor station

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

The house phones carry out the intercom service and can, at the same
times, reply to external calls.
Switching from one service to another is automatic and takes place
during the call by means of a reply incorporated in the power supply.
When the intercom service is active, nothing can be heard on the
outdoor station and vice versa.
Calls from the door unit are sent to the door phone speaker while calls
from the other door phone are sent to the additional electronic buzzer.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SC101-1243B:
DOOR PHONE REFERENCES
N. 2

Ref. 1134/1

N. 2

Door phone Mod. Utopia with 1 key


or
Door phone Mod. Atlantico with 1 key

N. 2

Diodes (packing of 10)

Ref. 1131/4

Ref. 1133/1

POWER SUPPLY FOR DOOR PHONE SYSTEM REFERENCES

N. 1

Power supply for door phone system

Ref. 786/15

OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES

8
Sinthesi model
N. 1
Module with door unit set-up
N. 1
Amplified door unit

Ref. 1145/22
Ref. 1145/500

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.

or
K-Steel model
N. 1
Module with door unit

12

Ref. 1155/22A

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

2
or

725 model
N. 1
Panel with 2 buttons
N. 1
Amplified door unit

Ref. 725/102
Ref. 1128/500

For the accessories refer to Panels with anodized aluminium


front plate Mod. 725 section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.
or
1128 model
N. 1
Front case for door unit
N. 1
Door unit
N. 2
Button
N. X
Blank module

Ref. 1128/20-/21
Ref. 1128/500
Ref. 1128/1-/2
Ref. 1128/30-/31

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

For boards of accessories refer to Wall Mounted Panel


Mod. 1128 section of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system
product technical manual.

DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)
C4.001

C4.004

C4.006
Sinthesi models only:
Connect jumper L with G/T.
C4.014

VX.006

VX.021
Cut or remove the jumpers on the device(s): 6 - 10.

40 sec.1a

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SC101-1243B

T1
G/T
CA

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

INTERCOMMUNICATING CONNECTION OF 2 DOOR PHONES


WITH THE POSSIBILITY OF REPLY TO 1 OUTDOOR STATION
Single calls from outdoor station

1
2
6
10
9
(C4.003)
(VX.006)
(VX.021)
(C4.014)
T1
G/T
CA
1
2
6
10
9

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0

U2
U1
G/T
(C4.006)
L
1A
2
+
1
(C4.004)

Name tag
lighting

ELECTRIC
LOCK

MAIN~

7 ~12 PS2 C1 PS C2 - 4 1 + - 9 3 6 SN2 ~ 8 2 5 SN1


0
J

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

POWER SUPPLY FOR


DOOR PHONE SYSTEM

Lock Release

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1a 41

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

INTERCOMMUNICATING CONNECTION OF 2 DOOR PHONES


WITH THE POSSIBILITY OF REPLY TO 1 OUTDOOR STATION
Parallel calls from outdoor station
Differentiated calls

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

The house phones carry out the intercom service and can, at the same
times, reply to calls external calls.
Switching from one service to another is automatic and takes place
during the call by means of a reply incorporated in the power supply.
When the intercom service is active, nothing can be heard on the
outdoor station and vice versa.
From the push button panel, all the house phones are called in parallel
with a single call key.
Door phone calls ring the supplementary buzzer.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SC101-0578G:
DOOR PHONE REFERENCES
N. 2
N. 2

Door phone Mod. Utopia with 1 key


or
Door phone Mod. Atlantico with 1 key

N. 2
N. 2

Diodes (packing of 10)


Extra electronic buzzers

Ref. 1134/1
Ref. 1133/1
Ref. 1131/4
Ref. 9854/52

POWER SUPPLY FOR DOOR PHONE SYSTEM REFERENCES

8
8

N. 1

Power supply for door phone system with relay

Ref. 786/15

OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES


Sinthesi model
N. 1
Module with door unit set-up
N. 1
Amplified door unit

Ref. 1145/21
Ref. 1145/500

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.

6
or

11

K-Steel model
N. 1
Module with door unit

Ref. 1155/21

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

or
725 model
N. 1
Panel with 1 button
N. 1
Amplified door unit

Ref. 725/101
Ref. 1128/500

For the accessories refer to Panels with anodized aluminium


front plate Mod. 725 section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.
or
1128 model
N. 1
Front case for door unit
N. 1
Door unit
N. 1
Button
N. X
Blank module

Ref. 1128/20-/21
Ref. 1128/500
Ref. 1128/1-/2
Ref. 1128/30-/31

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

For boards of accessories refer to Wall Mounted Panel


Mod. 1128 section of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system
product technical manual.

DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)
C4.001
C4.004
C4.014
VX.006
VX.021
Cut or remove the jumpers on the device(s): 6 10.

42 sec.1a

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SC101-0578G
T1
G/T
CA

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

INTERCOMMUNICATING CONNECTION OF 2 DOOR PHONES


WITH THE POSSIBILITY OF REPLY TO 1 OUTDOOR STATION
Parallel calls from outdoor station
Differentiated calls

1
2
6
10
9

(VX.006)
(VX.021)
(C4.014)

BUZZER -/~
+/~

T1
G/T
CA
1
2
6
10
9

(VX.006)
(VX.021)
(C4.014)

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0

BUZZER -/~
+/~

U1
G/T
L
1A
2
+
1

Name tag
lighting

(C4.004)
Lock
Release

ELECTRIC
LOCK

DOOR PHONE
POWER SUPPLY
WITH RELAY BOX

~12 C2 C1 PS -J 4

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

6 SN2 ~0 8

5 SN1

sec.1a 43

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

MAIN~

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

INTERCOMMUNICATING CONNECTION OF MAXIMUM 13 DOOR PHONES


WITH THE POSSIBILITY OF REPLY TO 1 OUTDOOR STATION
Single calls from outdoor station
Differentiated calls

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

The house phones carry out the intercom service and can, at the same
times, reply to external calls.
Switching from one service to another is automatic and takes place
during the call by means of a reply incorporated in the power supply.
When the intercom service is active, nothing can be heard on the
outdoor station and vice versa.
The various device may be called individually from the panel.
Using the Mod. Atlantico with 12 additional key, it is possible to call up
to 13 shunt phones.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SC101-0839D:
DOOR PHONE REFERENCES
N. 13
N. X

Door phone Mod. Atlantico with


12 additional key A
Diodes (packing of 10)

Ref. 1133/12
Ref. 1131/4

POWER SUPPLY FOR DOOR PHONE SYSTEM REFERENCES


N. 1

Power supply for door phone system

Ref. 786/15

5+n
5+n

OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES

5+n

Sinthesi model
N. X
Button modules
N. 4
Module with door unit set-up
N. 4
Amplified door unit

Ref. 1145/11-/12-/13-/14
Ref. 1145/20-/21-/22
Ref. 1145/500

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.

5+n

or

5+n
5+n

K-Steel model
N. X
Button modules
N. 4
Module with door unit

Ref. 1155/11-/12A-/13A-/14A
Ref. 1155/20-/21-/22A

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

5+n
or

10+n

725 model
N. 1
Panel with N buttons
N. 1
Amplified door unit

Mod. 725
Ref. 1128/500

For the panels references and the accessories refer to Panels


with anodized aluminium front plate Mod. 725 section of
Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

or
1128 model
N. 1
Front case for door unit
N. 1
Door unit
N. X
Front case
N. X
Button

Ref. 1128/20-/21
Ref. 1128/500
Ref. 1128/10-/11
Ref. 1128/1-/2

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

For boards of accessories refer to Wall Mounted Panel


Mod. 1128 section of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system
product technical manual.

DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)
C4.001

C4.004

C4.014

VX.006

VX.021
Cut or remove the jumpers on the device(s): 6 10 (P1).

44 sec.1a

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SC101-0839D

TO THE FOLLOWING
DOOR PHONES
U12
U11
U10
U9
U8
U7
U6

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

INTERCOMMUNICATING CONNECTION OF MAXIMUM 13 DOOR PHONES


WITH THE POSSIBILITY OF REPLY TO 1 OUTDOOR STATION
Single calls from outdoor station
Differentiated calls

U5
U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T
CA
1
P1

2
6
10
9
-/~
+/~

(VX.021)
(C4.014)

U12
U11
U10
U9
U8
U7
U6
U5
U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T
CA
1
P1

2
6
10
9
-/~
+/~

(VX.021)
(C4.014)

U12
U11
U10
U9
U8
U7
U6
U5
U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T
CA
1
P1

(VX.021)
(C4.014)

AI MODULI
SUCCESSIVI

2
6
10
9
-/~
+/~

(C4.007)
(C4.008)

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0

U4
U3
U2
U1

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0
G/T

U2
U1
G/T
(C4.006)
L
1A
2
+
1
(C4.004)

Name tag
lighting

ELECTRIC
LOCK

Lock Release
MAIN~

DOOR PHONE
POWER SUPPLY
WITH RELAY

7 ~12 PS2 C1 PS C2 - 4 1 + - 9 3 6 SN2 ~ 8 2 5 SN1


0
J

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1a 45

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

INTERCOMMUNICATING CONNECTION OF 2 DOOR PHONES


WITH THE POSSIBILITY OF REPLY TO 2 OUTDOOR STATION
Single calls from outdoor station

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

The house phones carry out the intercom service and can, at the same
times, reply to calls from the external push-button panel. Switching
from one service to another is automatic and takes place during the
call by means of a reply incorporated in the power supply and a
separate switching relay.
When the intercom service is active, nothing can be heard on the
outdoor station and vice versa.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SC101-1249A:
DOOR PHONE REFERENCES
N. 2
N. 2

Door phone Mod. Utopia with 1 key


or
Door phone Mod. Atlantico with 1 key

N. 2
N. 2

Diodes (packing of 10)


Extra electronic buzzers

Ref. 1134/1
Ref. 1133/1
Ref. 1131/4
Ref. 9854/52

POWER SUPPLY AND RELAY REFERENCES

N. 1
N. 1

Power supply for door phone system


Relay box

Ref. 786/15
Ref. 788/51

OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES


Sinthesi model
N. 2
Module with door unit set-up
N. 2
Amplified door unit

Ref. 1145/22
Ref. 1145/500

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.

7
or

K-Steel model
N. 2
Module with door unit

12
2

Ref. 1155/22A

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

12
2

or
725 model
N. 2
Panel with 2 buttons
N. 2
Amplified door unit

Ref. 725/102
Ref. 1128/500

For the accessories refer to Panels with anodized aluminium


front plate Mod. 725 section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.
or
1128 model
N. 2
Front case for door unit
N. 2
Door unit
N. 4
Button
N. X
Blank module

Ref. 1128/20-/21
Ref. 1128/500
Ref. 1128/1-/2
Ref. 1128/30-/31

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

For boards of accessories refer to Wall Mounted Panel


Mod. 1128 section of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system
product technical manual.

DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)
C4.001
C4.006
Sinthesi models only:
Connect jumper L with G/T.
C4.014

C4.016

VX.006

VX.014

VX.021
Cut or remove the jumpers on the device(s): 6 10.

46 sec.1a

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SC101-1249A

T1
G/T
CA
1
2
6

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

INTERCOMMUNICATING CONNECTION OF 2 DOOR PHONES


WITH THE POSSIBILITY OF REPLY TO 2 OUTDOOR STATION
Single calls from outdoor station

(C4.014)

10
9

(VX.006)
(VX.021)

Name tag
lighting
T1
G/T
CA
1
2
6

(VX.014)

MAIN~
(C4.014)

10
9

(VX.006)
(VX.021)

~0 ~12

LIGHT BULB
TRANSFORMER

Name tag
lighting

Name tag
lighting
8
G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0

U2
U1
G/T
L
1A
2
+
1

SN1

U2
U1
G/T

SN2

(C4.006)

(C4.006)
10
1
4

12
3
6

Lock
Release

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0

L
1A
2
+
1

Lock
Release

(C4.016)

(C4.016)

ELECTRIC
LOCK

7
~12
~0
C2
13
C1
11
2
5

ELECTRIC
LOCK

15
14

RELAY BOX

MAIN~

7 ~12 ~0 SN2 6 3 + 1 PS C2 4 -J 9

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

- 8 2 5 SN1 C1 PS2

DOOR PHONE
POWER SUPPLY
WITH RELAY BOX

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

sec.1a 47

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

INTERCOMMUNICATING CONNECTION OF 2 DOOR PHONES


WITH THE POSSIBILITY OF REPLY TO 2 OUTDOOR STATION
Parallel calls from outdoor station

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

The house phones carry out the intercom service and can, at the same
times, reply to calls from the external push-button panel. Switching
from one service to another is automatic and takes place during the
call by means of a reply incorporated in the power supply and a
separate switching relay.
When the intercom service is active, nothing can be heard on the
outdoor station and vice versa.
From the push button panel, all the house phones are called in parallel
with a single call key.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SC101-1244A:

DOOR PHONE REFERENCES


N. 2
N. 2

Door phone Mod. Utopia with 1 key


or
Door phone Mod. Atlantico with 1 key

N. 2
N. 2

Diodes (packing of 10)


Extra electronic buzzers

Ref. 1134/1
Ref. 1133/1
Ref. 1131/4
Ref. 9854/52

POWER SUPPLY AND RELAY REFERENCES

N. 1
N. 1

Power supply for door phone system with relay


Relay box

Ref. 786/15
Ref. 788/51

8
OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES
Sinthesi model
N. 2
Module with door unit set-up
N. 2
Amplified door unit

Ref. 1145/21
Ref. 1145/500

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.

6
or

K-Steel model
N. 2
Module with door unit

11
2

Ref. 1155/21

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

11
2

or
725 model
N. 2
Panel with 1 button
N. 2
Amplified door unit

Ref. 725/101
Ref. 1128/500

For the accessories refer to Panels with anodized aluminium


front plate Mod. 725 section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.
or
1128 model
N. 2
Front case for door unit
N. 2
Door unit
N. 2
Button
N. X
Blank module

Ref. 1128/20-/21
Ref. 1128/500
Ref. 1128/1-/2
Ref. 1128/30-/31

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

For boards of accessories refer to Wall Mounted Panel


Mod. 1128 section of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system
product technical manual.

48 sec.1a

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SC101-1244A
T1
G/T
CA
1
2
6

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

INTERCOMMUNICATING CONNECTION OF 2 DOOR PHONES


WITH THE POSSIBILITY OF REPLY TO 2 OUTDOOR STATION
Parallel calls from outdoor station

(C4.014)

10
9
-/~
+/~

(VX.006)
(VX.021)

T1
G/T
CA

Name tag
lighting

1
2
6

(C4.014)

10
9

(VX.014)

MAIN~

-/~
+/~

(VX.006)
(VX.021)

~0 ~12

LIGHT BULB
TRANSFORMER
Name tag
lighting

RELAY
BOX

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0

Name tag
lighting

8
U1
G/T
L
1A
2
+
1

SN1
(C4.006)

(C4.006)
10
1
4

L
1A
2
+
1

12
3
6

Lock Release

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0

U1
G/T

SN2

Lock Release

(C4.016)

(C4.016)

ELECTRIC
LOCK

7
~12
~0
C2
13
C1
11
2
5

ELECTRIC
LOCK

15
14

MAIN~

C1~12 ~0 SN2 6 3 + 1 PS C2 4 -J 9

- 8 2 5 SN1 7 PS2

DOOR PHONE
POWER SUPPLY
WITH RELAY

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)
C4.001
C4.006
Sinthesi models only:
Connect jumper L with G/T.
C4.014

C4.016

VX.006

VX.014

VX.021
Cut or remove the jumpers on the device(s): 6 10.
DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1a 49

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

INTERCOMMUNICATING CONNECTION OF MAXIMUM 13 DOOR PHONES


WITH THE POSSIBILITY OF REPLY TO 2 OUTDOOR STATIONS
Single calls from the push button panels

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

The house phones carry out the intercom service and can, at the same
times, reply to calls from 2 external push button panels.
Switching from one service to another is automatic and takes place
during the call by means of a separate switching relay.
When the intercom service is active, nothing can be heard on the
outdoor station and vice versa.
Using the Mod. Atlantico with 12 additional key, it is possible to call up
to 13 shunt phones
.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SC101-0844E:

6+(n-2)

DOOR PHONE REFERENCES


N. 13

Door phone Mod. Atlantico with


12 additional key A

Ref. 1133/12

POWER SUPPLY AND RELAY REFERENCES


N. 1

6+n

N. 1

Power supply for


door phone system
Relay box

28VA

Ref. 786/11
Ref. 788/58

OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES

6+(n-1)

Sinthesi model
N. X
Button modules
N. 2
Module with door unit set-up
N. 2
Amplified door unit

6+n

Ref. 1145/11-/12-/13-/14
Ref. 1145/20-/21-/22
Ref. 1145/500

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.
or
K-Steel model
N. X
Button modules
N. 2
Module with door unit

5+n

7+n

Ref. 1155/11-/12A-/13A-/14A
Ref. 1155/20-/21-/22A

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

7+n
or

725 model
N. 2
Panel with N buttons
N. 2
Amplified door unit

Mod. 725
Ref. 1128/500

For the panels references and the accessories refer to Panels


with anodized Aluminium front plate Mod. 725 section of
Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.
or

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

1128 model
N. 2
Front case for door unit
N. 2
Door unit
N. X
Front case
N. X
Button

Ref. 1128/20-/21
Ref. 1128/500
Ref. 1128/10-/11
Ref. 1128/1-/2

For boards of accessories refer to Wall Mounted Panel


Mod. 1128 section of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system
product technical manual.

DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)
C4.001
C4.014
VX.006
VX.021
Cut or remove the jumpers on the device(s): 6 10 (P1).

50 sec.1a

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SC101-0844E
TO THE FOLLOWING DOOR PHONES

U12
U11
U10
U9
U8
U7

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

INTERCOMMUNICATING CONNECTION OF MAXIMUM 13 DOOR PHONES


WITH THE POSSIBILITY OF REPLY TO 2 OUTDOOR STATIONS
Single calls from the push button panels

U6
U5
U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T
CA
1
P1

2
6
10
9
-/~
+/~

U12
U11
U10
U9
U8
U7
U6
U5
U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T
CA
1
P1

2
6
10
9
-/~
+/~

(C4.014)
(VX.021)
RELAY
BOX

TO THE FOLLOWING
MODULES

TO THE FOLLOWING
MODULES

(C4.007)
(C4.008)

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0

U4
U3
U2
U1

U4
U3
U2
U1

U2
U1
G/T

U2
U1
G/T
(C4.006)

(C4.006)

L
1A
2
+
1

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0
G/T
G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0

L
1A
2
+
1

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0
G/T

(C4.007)
(C4.008)

Name tag
lighting

Name tag
lighting
ELECTRIC
LOCK

ELECTRIC
LOCK
Lock
Release

MAIN~

Lock
Release

POWER SUPPLY FOR


DOOR PHONE SYSTEM

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1a 51

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

INTERCOMMUNICATING CONNECTION OF MAXIMUM 13 DOOR PHONES


WITH THE POSSIBILITY OF REPLY TO 2 OUTDOOR STATIONS
Parallel calls from the push button panels

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

The house phones carry out the intercom service and can, at the same
times, reply to calls from 2 external push button panels.
Switching from one service to another is automatic and takes place
during the call by means of a separate switching relay.
When the intercom service is active, nothing can be heard on the
outdoor station and vice versa.
From the push button panel, all the house phones are called in parallel
with a single call key.
Using the Mod. Atlantico with 12 additional key, it is possible to call up
to 13 shunt phones
.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SC101-0866G:
DOOR PHONE REFERENCES
DOOR PHONE A
N. 13 Door phone Mod. Atlantico with
12 additional key
POWER SUPPLY AND RELAY REFERENCES
N. 1
N. 1

6+n
6+n

Ref. 1133/12

Power supply for


door phone system
Relay box

28VA

Ref. 786/11
Ref. 788/58

OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES


Sinthesi model
N. 2
Module with door unit set-up
N. 2
Amplified door unit

6+n

Ref. 1145/21
Ref. 1145/500

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.

6+n
or

K-Steel model
N. 2
Module with door unit

6+n
6+n

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

Ref. 1155/21

or

725 model
N. 2
Panel with 1 button
N. 2
Amplified door unit

Ref. 725/101
Ref. 1128/500

For the accessories refer to Panels with anodized aluminium


front plate Mod. 725 section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.

or
1128 model
N. 2
Front case for door unit
N. 2
Door unit
N. 2
Button
N. X
Blank module

Ref. 1128/20-/21
Ref. 1128/500
Ref. 1128/1-/2
Ref. 1128/30-/31

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

For boards of accessories refer to Wall Mounted Panel


Mod. 1128 section of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system
product technical manual.

DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)
C4.001
C4.014
VX.006
VX.021
Cut or remove the jumpers on the device(s): 6 10 (P1).

52 sec.1a

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SC101-0866G
U12
U11
U10
U9
U8
U7

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

INTERCOMMUNICATING CONNECTION OF MAXIMUM 13 DOOR PHONES


WITH THE POSSIBILITY OF REPLY TO 2 OUTDOOR STATIONS
Parallel calls from the push button panels

U6
U5
U4
(VX.021)
(C4.014)

U3
U2
U1
G/T
CA
1
P1

2
6
10
9
-/~
+/~

U12
U11
U10
U9
U8
U7
U6
U5
U4
(VX.021)
(C4.014)

U3
U2
U1
G/T
CA
1
P1

2
6
10
9
-/~
+/~

RELAY
BOX

U1
G/T

U1
G/T

L
1A
2
+
1

L
1A
2
+
1

Name tag
lighting

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0

Name tag
lighting
Lock
Release

MAIN~

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0

Lock
Release

POWER SUPPLY FOR


DOOR PHONE SYSTEM

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1a 53

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF TWO INTERCOMMUNICATING DOOR PHONE EXTENSIONS


TO A SYSTEM WITH DOOR UNIT
Parallel calls from door unit
Differentiated calls

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

The connection example shown in the following diagram offers the


possibility of adding intercom door phones in the same apartment to
an existing system with door unit.
The house phones carry out the intercom service and can, at the same
times, reply to calls external calls.
Switching from one service to another is automatic and takes place
during the call by means of a reply incorporated in the power supply.
When the intercom service is active, nothing can be heard on the
outdoor station and vice versa.
The door unit call is sent to the supplementary electronic buzzer.
The call between two door phones is sent to the speaker of both door
phones.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SC101-0567E:
DOOR PHONE REFERENCES
N. 2
N. 2

Door phone Mod. Utopia with 1 key


or
Door phone Mod. Atlantico with 1 key

N. 2
N. 2

Diodes (packing of 10)


Extra electronic buzzers

Ref. 1134/1
Ref. 1133/1
Ref. 1131/4
Ref. 9854/52

POWER SUPPLY FOR DOOR PHONE SYSTEM REFERENCES


N. 1
N. 1
N. 1

Power supply for door phone system with relay


Relay box A
Relay box B

Ref. 786/11
Ref. 788/52
Ref. 788/51

8
DIAGRAM NOTES
8

(see section 1)

C4.001
C4.014
VX.006
VX.021
Cut or remove the jumpers on the device(s): 6 10.

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

FROM RISING
COLUMN

54 sec.1a

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SC101-0567E

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF TWO INTERCOMMUNICATING DOOR PHONE EXTENSIONS


TO A SYSTEM WITH DOOR UNIT
Parallel calls from door unit
Differentiated calls

(C4.014)
(VX.006)
(VX.021)
-/~
+/~

(C4.014)
(VX.021)
-/~
+/~

RELAY
BOX A
CALL
FROM
RISING
COLUMN

47
3W
RELAY
BOX B

MAIN~

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

POWER SUPPLY

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1a 55

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 1 OUTDOOR STATION


Secrecy of conversation

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

To assure the secrecy of conversation to all the house phones of the


door phone system, a device (Ref. 1131/5 for Scaitel door phones or
Ref. 1134/5 for Utopia door phones) shall be inserted in each door
phone and a switch-off device Ref. 5330/60 in the push button panel.
So, all the house phones will be cut off from any conversation (nothing
can be heard when unhooking the handset); only the called door
phone can start a conversation with the caller, no other being able to
intercept the call.
The door phone is activated to communicate from the call up to the
following call. If it is not direct to the same set the call release the door
phone from the connection with the loudspeaking unit.
The secrecy device offers two possibilities of electric lock opening:
NORMAL OPENING (solution A): which takes place each time the
hook lever of any door phone is pressed to the bottom;
ACTIVATED OPENING (solution B): the electric lock can be
activated only after a call, and only from the called door phone (in
this case, remove the jumper from the door phone printed circuit).

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SC101-1134E:
DOOR PHONE REFERENCES
N. X
N. X

Door phone Mod. Utopia


Secrecy device

Ref. 1134/1
Ref. 1131/5

POWER SUPPLY FOR DOOR PHONE SYSTEM REFERENCES


N. 1

Power supply for


door phone system

28VA

Ref. 786/11

OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES


Sinthesi model
N. X
Button modules
N. 1
Module with door unit set-up
N. 1
Door unit
N. 1
Switch off privacy device

4+(n-2)

Grey colour

Ref. 1145/11-/12-/13-/14
Ref. 1145/20-/21-/22
Ref. 1145/500
Ref. 5330/60

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.
or

4+(n-1)

K-Steel model
N. X
Button modules
N. 1
Module with door unit
N. 1
Switch off privacy device

Ref. 1155/11-/12A-/13A-/14A
Ref. 1155/20-/21-/22A
Ref. 1155/75

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.
or

4+n

725 model
N. 1
Panel with N buttons
N. 1
Amplified door unit
Switch off privacy device
N. 1

9+n

Mod. 725
Ref. 1128/500
Ref. 5330/60

For the panels references and the accessories refer to Panels


with anodized aluminium front plate Mod. 725 section of
Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

C4.001
VX.006

C4.007
VX.013

C4.008

VX.021
Cut or remove the jumpers on the device(s) (solution B only):
P1 (Utopia)
VX.028

56 sec.1a

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SC101-1134E
TO THE FOLLOWING
DOOR PHONES

CA

CA

1
2

1
2

6
9
10

6
9
10

(VX.006)

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 1 OUTDOOR STATION


Secrecy of conversation

(VX.006)
(VX.021)

CA

CA

1
2

1
2

6
9
10

6
9
10

SOLUTION A

SOLUTION B
TO THE FOLLOWING
MODULE
(C4.007)
(C4.008)
U4
U3
U2
U1

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0
G/T

(VX.006)

POWER SUPPLY FOR


DOOR PHONE SYSTEM

-J
PS

PS

~0

1B
2B 1A
9
2A
-/~

-6
+6
SWITCH OFF
PRIVACY DEVICE

~
~

SN

~12 AP

U2
U1
G/T

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0

1A
2
+
1
L

MAIN~
Lock Release

ELECTRIC LOCK

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

~18
~12

Name tag
lighting

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1a 57

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 1 DOOR UNIT


Simultaneous opening of two electrical locks

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

Pressing one of the external panel buttons, the bitonal electronic


call is sent to the correspondent door phone loudspeaker. When the
called door phone handset is unhooked, contact is established and
conversation may take place. Simply press the corresponding button
to release the two electrical door locks.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SC101-0482D:
DOOR PHONE REFERENCES
N. X
N. X

4+(n-2)
5

Door phone Mod. Utopia


or
Door phone Mod. Atlantico

Grey colour
White colour

Ref. 1134/1
Ref. 1133

POWER SUPPLY FOR DOOR PHONE SYSTEM REFERENCES


N. 1
N. 1
N. 1

Power supply for


door phone system
Relay box A
Transformer 12Vac 30VA

28VA

Ref. 786/11
Ref. 788/52
NNF

4+(n-1)
OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES

Sinthesi model
N. X
Button modules
N. 1
Module with door unit set-up
N. 1
Amplified door unit

Ref. 1145/11-/12-/13-/14
Ref. 1145/20-/21-/22
Ref. 1145/500

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.

4+n

11+n

or
K-Steel model
N. X
Button modules
N. 1
Module with door unit

Ref. 1155/11-/12A-/13A-/14A
Ref. 1155/20-/21-/22A

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

2
or

725 model
N. 1
Panel with N buttons
N. 1
Amplified door unit

Mod. 725
Ref. 1128/500

For the panels references and the accessories refer to Panels


with anodized Aluminium front plate Mod. 725 section of
Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.
or

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

1128 model
N. 1
Front case for door unit
N. 1
Door unit
N. X
Front case
N. X
Button

Ref. 1128/20-/21
Ref. 1128/500
Ref. 1128/10-/11
Ref. 1128/1-/2

For boards of accessories refer to Wall Mounted Panel


Mod. 1128 section of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system
product technical manual.
NNF= not supplied by us.

58 sec.1a

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SC101-0482D

TO THE FOLLOWING
DOOR PHONES

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 1 DOOR UNIT


Simultaneous opening of two electrical locks

CA
1
2
6
9
10

CA
1
2
6
9
10

TO THE FOLLOWING
MODULE
(C4.007 )
(C4.008 )
G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0
G/T

U4
U3
U2
U1
MAIN~

~
~

U2
U1
G/T

PS
(C4.006 )

POWER SUPPLY
FOR DOOR
PHONE SYSTEM

-J
~0

L
1A
2
+
1

-6
+6
~12

MAIN~

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0

Name tag
lighting

~
~
~0
~12

~12
2
S1

Lock Release

S4
S3
RELAY
BOX

ELECTRIC
LOCK 1

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

TRANSFORMER
12Vac - 30VA
N.N.F.

Lock Release
S6

ELECTRIC
LOCK 2

DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)
C4.001

C4.004

C4.006
Sinthesi models only:
Connect jumper L with G/T.
C4.007

C4.008

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1a 59

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF TWO INTERCOM DOOR PHONES WITH POSSIBILITY OF


ANSWERING CALLS FROM ONE SECONDARY DOOR UNIT EXTENSION OF AN
ELECTRICAL DOOR UNIT SYSTEM
Parallel calls from outdoor station
Differentiated calls

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

The door phones have intercom features and may at the same time
take calls from both the secondary panel and door phone system to
which they are connected.
Switching from one service to another is automatic and takes place
during the call by means of reply.
When the intercom service is active, nothing can be heard on the
outdoor station and vice versa.
La chiamata tra i citofoni inviata allaltoparlante dei citofoni.
La chiamata dal portiere elettrico inviata sul ronzatore elettronico
supplementare (Buzzer) di entrambe i citofoni.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SC101-0735D:
DOOR PHONE REFERENCES
N. 2
N. 2

Door phone Mod. Utopia with 1 key


or
Door phone Mod. Atlantico with 1 key

N. 2
N. 2

Diodes (packing of 10)


Extra electronic buzzers

Ref. 1134/1
Ref. 1133/1
Ref. 1131/4
Ref. 9854/52

POWER SUPPLY FOR DOOR PHONE SYSTEM REFERENCES

N. 1
N. 1
N. 1

Power supply for door phone system with relay


Relay box 1
Relay box 2

Ref. 786/11
Ref. 788/58
Ref. 788/52

OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES

Sinthesi model
N. 1
Module with door unit set-up
N. 1
Amplified door unit

Ref. 1145/21
Ref. 1145/500

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.

or
K-Steel model
N. 1
Module with door unit

Ref. 1155/21

11
The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with
module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

or
725 model
N. 1
Panel with 1 button
N. 1
Amplified door unit

Ref. 725/101
Ref. 1128/500

For the accessories refer to Panels with anodized aluminium


front plate Mod. 725 section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.
or

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

1128 model
N. 1
Front case for door unit
N. 1
Door unit
N. 1
Button
N. X
Blank module

Ref. 1128/20-/21
Ref. 1128/500
Ref. 1128/1-/2
Ref. 1128/30-/31

For boards of accessories refer to Wall Mounted Panel


Mod. 1128 section of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system
product technical manual.

DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)
C4.001
C4.004
C4.014
VX.006
VX.021
Cut or remove the jumpers on the device(s): 6 10.

60 sec.1a

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SC101-0735D

(C4.014)
(VX.006)
(VX.021)

(C4.014)
(VX.006)
(VX.021)

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF TWO INTERCOM DOOR PHONES WITH POSSIBILITY OF


ANSWERING CALLS FROM ONE SECONDARY DOOR UNIT EXTENSION OF AN
ELECTRICAL DOOR UNIT SYSTEM
Parallel calls from outdoor station
Differentiated calls

-/~
+/~

-/~
+/~

RELAY BOX
(1)

RELAY BOX
(2)

(C4.006)
G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0

U1
G/T
L
1A
2
+
1

Name tag
lighting

ELECTRIC
LOCK

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

Lock Release

MAIN~
POWER SUPPLY

call
FROM RISING
COLUMN

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1a 61

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS


BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS
62 sec.1a

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

SECTION 1B
(REV.D)

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

BASIC DIAGRAMS FOR


1+1 WIRE ELECTRONIC
DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

Download from:
www.urmetdomus.com
Technical Manuals area
DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1b 1

DOOR PHONE AND VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEM - DIAGRAM - Section 1B

SECTION 1B CONTENTS
DOOR PHONE AND VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEM - DIAGRAM

Diagram

Sec.

Pag.

BASIC DIAGRAMS FOR 1+1 WIRE ELECTRONIC DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS


CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 1 OUTDOOR STATION
WITH SECRECY OF CONVERSATION
(Panels Mod. Sinthesi or K-Steel) ................................................................................................................. SC101-1135F ...............1b ................ 2
CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 1 OUTDOOR STATION
WITH SECRECY OF CONVERSATION
(Panels Mod. 725 or Mod. Domus Aura) ....................................................................................................... SC101-0932C ...............1b ................ 4
CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 2 OUTDOOR STATIONS
WITH SECRECY OF CONVERSATION
(Panels Mod. Sinthesi or K-Steel) ................................................................................................................. SC101-1210B ...............1b ................ 6
CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO TWO OUTDOOR STATIONS
WITH SECRECY OF CONVERSATION
(Panels Mod. 725 or Mod. Domus Aura) ....................................................................................................... SC101-0937B ...............1b ................ 8
CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO FOUR OUTDOOR STATIONS
WITH SECRECY OF CONVERSATION
(Panels Mod. Sinthesi or K-Steel) ................................................................................................................. SC101-1218C ...............1b ............. 10
CONNECTION OF SEVERAL COLUMN OF DOOR PHONES TO COMMON OUTDOOR STATIONS
Each group in also connected to its own secondary outdoor station
(Panels Mod. Sinthesi or K-Steel) ................................................................................................................. SC101-1241B ...............1b ............. 12
CONNECTION OF 1 DOOR PHONES TO 1 OUTDOOR STATION
Door phone can open door during call from panel ...........................................................................................SC101-1327 ...............1b ............. 14
RELEASE OF TWO ELECTRICAL LOCKS AT THE SAME TIME
a) 725 or Domus Aura door unit
b) Sinthesi or K-Steel door unit...................................................................................................................... SC101-1269A ...............1b ............. 16

I sec.1b

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

DOOR PHONE AND VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEM - DIAGRAM

1 + 1 DOOR PHONE SYSTEM DIAGRAM CROSS-REFERENCE TABLE


LIST OF AVAILABLE FUNCTIONS
Panel model
Number of main panels to be installed
Number of secondary panels to be installed
Connection of a supplementary electrical lock
Possibility of opening door while calling from the panel
DIAGRAM

PAG

1 0

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 1 OUTDOOR STATION WITH SECRECY


OF CONVERSATION

SC101-1135F

1 K

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL COLUMN OF DOOR PHONES TO COMMON OUTDOOR STATIONS


Each group in also connected to its own secondary outdoor station

SC101-1241B

12

2 0

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 2 OUTDOOR STATIONS WITH SECRECY


OF CONVERSATION

SC101-1210B

4 0

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO FOUR OUTDOOR STATIONS WITH SECRECY


OF CONVERSATION

SC101-1218C

10

1 0

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 1 OUTDOOR STATION WITH SECRECY


OF CONVERSATION

SC101-0932C

2 0

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO TWO OUTDOOR STATIONS WITH SECRECY


OF CONVERSATION

SC101-0937B

-- --

RELEASE OF TWO ELECTRICAL LOCKS AT THE SAME TIME


a) 725 or Domus Aura door unit
b) Sinthesi or K-Steel door unit

SC101-1269A

16

CONNECTION OF 1 DOOR PHONES TO 1 OUTDOOR STATION

Door phone can open door during call from panel

SC101-1327

14

DIAGRAM DESCRIPTION

Sinthesi
or
K-Steel

725 or
Domus Aura

Generic

-- --

K = number of columns with panel

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1b II

DOOR PHONE AND VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEM - DIAGRAM - Section 1B

SECTION 1B CONTENTS

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 1 OUTDOOR STATION


WITH SECRECY OF CONVERSATION
(Panels Mod. Sinthesi or K-Steel)

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

1+1 wire system allows to obtain the service of a standard outdoor set
installation with conversation, call, electric lock opening, with only 2
wires in the rising column: 1 common + 1 single for each door phone.
The outdoor set is fed, with two wires only, by a 12V a.c. voltage
transformer.
To assure secrecy to all the door phones, special devices for secrecy
of conversation are inserted into the push button panel (one for each
key).
So, all the door phones will be cut off from any conversation (nothing
can be heard when picking up the handset); only the called door phone
can start a conversation with the caller, no other being able to intercept
the call.
The called house is qualified to talk until another call is made from the
push button panel to other door phone.
The electric lock opening depends from the circuit of secrecy of
conversation (the lock cannot be operated unless the door phone has
been called).

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SC101-1135F:
DOOR PHONE REFERENCES
N. X
N. X

Door phones Mod. Utopia


or
Door phones Mod. Atlantico

Ref. 1133/35A

POWER SUPPLY REFERENCES


N. 1

Transformer

Ref. 9000/230

OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES


Sinthesi model
N. X
Button modules
N. 1
Module with door unit set-up
N. 1
Amplified door unit
N. X/4 Conversation privacy device

1+(n-2)

Ref. 1134/35

Ref. 1145/11-/12-/13-/14
Ref. 1145/20-/21
Ref. 1145/67
Ref. 1145/74

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.

2
or

K-Steel model
N. X
Button modules
N. 1
Module with door unit
N. X/4 Conversation privacy device

1+(n-1)

Ref. 1155/11-/12A-/13A-/14A
Ref. 1155/30-/31-/32A
Ref. 1145/74

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)

1+n

C1.002
C4.006
Sinthesi models only:
Connect jumper C1 with U1.

1+n
2

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

C4.007
C4.008
VX.006
VX.014

2 sec.1b

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SC101-1135F
COLUMN

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 1 OUTDOOR STATION


WITH SECRECY OF CONVERSATION
(Panels Mod. Sinthesi or K-Steel)

CA1
1
2

CA1
1
2

To the following
conversation
privacy
device

To the following
module

(C4.007)
(C4.008)
BUTTON MODULE

CONVERSATION
PRIVACY
DEVICE
(VX.006)

14

C4
C3
C2
C1

U4
U3
U2
U1

G/T
~12
~0
~12
~0
G/T

U1

G/T
G/T

14

(C4.006)

C2
C1
PS

4
5
F
3
SN
1
1/~
~
2

TRANSFORMER
~0
~12

~0
~12
~0
~12

~
Lock Release

Name tag
lighting

~0
~12
(VX.014)

Amplified
loudspeaking
unit

Name tag
lighting

ELECTRIC
LOCK

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

MAIN~
~

~
~
LIGHT BULB
TRANSFORMER

MAIN~

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1b 3

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 1 OUTDOOR STATION


WITH SECRECY OF CONVERSATION
(Panels Mod. 725 or Mod. Domus Aura)

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

1+1 wire system allows to obtain the service of a standard outdoor set
installation with conversation, call, electric lock opening, with only 2
wires in the rising column: 1 common + 1 single for each door phone.
The outdoor set is fed, with two wires only, by a 12V a.c. voltage
transformer.
To assure secrecy to all the door phones, special devices for secrecy
of conversation are inserted into the push button panel (one for each
key).
So, all the door phones will be cut off from any conversation (nothing
can be heard when picking up the handset); only the called door phone
can start a conversation with the caller, no other being able to intercept
the call.
The called house is qualified to talk until another call is made from the
push button panel to other door phone.
The electric lock opening depends from the circuit of secrecy of
conversation (the lock cannot be operated unless the door phone has
been called).

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SC101-0932C:
DOOR PHONE REFERENCES
N. X
N. X

Door phones Mod. Utopia


or
Door phones Mod. Atlantico

Ref. 1134/35
Ref. 1133/35A

POWER SUPPLY REFERENCES


N. 1

Transformer

Ref. 9000/230

OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES


725 model
N. 1
Panel with N buttons
N. 1
Amplified door unit
N. X/4 Conversation privacy device

1+(n-2)

Mod. 725
Ref. 1035/67
Ref. 1035/25

For the panels references and the accessories refer to Panels


with anodized Aluminium front plate Mod. 725 section of
Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

or
Domus Aura model
N. 1
Panel with N buttons
N. 1
Amplified door unit
N. X/4 Conversation privacy device

1+(n-1)

Mod. 1110
Ref. 1035/67
Ref. 1110/74

For the panels references and the accessories refer to Panels


Domus Aura section of Doorphone and Videodoorphone
system - product technical manual.

DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)
C1.002
VX.006
VX.014

1+n

1+n
2

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

4 sec.1b

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SC101-0932C
COLUMN

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 1 OUTDOOR STATION


WITH SECRECY OF CONVERSATION
(Panels Mod. 725 or Mod. Domus Aura)

CA1
1
2

CA1
1
2

PANEL FOR AMPLIFIED


LOUDSPEAKING UNIT
CONVERSATION
PRIVACY DEVICE

Name tag
lighting

41

14

41

14

(VX.006)

SN
PS
4
3
5
1/~
~
2

TRANSFORMER
~0
~12
~
MAIN ~

(C1.002)
Lock Release

ELECTRIC LOCK

Name tag
lighting

~0
~12
(VX.014)

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

~
~

MAIN ~

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

LIGHT BULB
TRANSFORMER

sec.1b 5

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 2 OUTDOOR STATIONS


WITH SECRECY OF CONVERSATION
(Panels Mod. Sinthesi or K-Steel)

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

The 1+1 wire door phone system makes it possible to set up systems
in which a door phone riser is to be connected to two entrances each
with 1 push button panel with related loudspeaking unit.
Adding a specific relay device, a person can press a key of one of
the two push button panels so that the user of the door phone called,
on lifting the handset, is automatically connected with the calling push
button panel excluding the other service.
Therefore in this system, it is not possible to speak from two outdoor
stations at the same time in that functioning of these is alternative.
to guarantee secrecy of conversation of all the door phones in the
system, the specific secrecy circuits (one for each button) are inserted
inside only one of the two push button panels.
Release of the electric lock is also enabled by the secrecy circuit. This
means that a user cannot release the lock unless he/she has been
called and can open only the lock corresponding to the push button
panel from which the call has been made.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SC101-1210B:
DOOR PHONE REFERENCES
N. X
N. X

Door phones Mod. Utopia


or
Door phones Mod. Atlantico

Ref. 1134/35
Ref. 1133/35A

POWER SUPPLY REFERENCES


N. 2
N. 1

Transformer
Relay box

Ref. 9000/230
Ref. 788/51

OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES

1+(n-2)

Sinthesi model
N. X
Button modules
N. 2
Module with door unit set-up
N. 2
Amplified door unit
N. X/4 Conversation privacy device

Ref. 1145/11-/12-/13-/14
Ref. 1145/20-/21
Ref. 1145/67
Ref. 1145/74

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.

1+(n-1)
or

K-Steel model
N. X
Button modules
N. 2
Module with door unit
N. X/4 Conversation privacy device

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

1+n

6+n

Ref. 1155/11-/12A-/13A-/14A
Ref. 1155/30-/31-/32A
Ref. 1145/74

DIAGRAM NOTES

7+n

(see section 1)
C1.002

2
C4.006
Sinthesi models only:
Connect jumper C1 with U1.
C4.007
C4.008
VX.006
VX.014

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

VX.021
Cut or remove the jumpers on the device(s):
a) PS G/T
b) 4 F

6 sec.1b

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SC101-1210B
COLUMN

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 2 OUTDOOR STATIONS


WITH SECRECY OF CONVERSATION
(Panels Mod. Sinthesi or K-Steel)

CA1
2
1

CA1
2
1

Name tag
lighting
(VX.014)
MAIN ~

To next
conversation
privacy devices

To the following
module
~

(C4.007)
(C4.008)
BUTTON MODULE
G/T
~12
~0
~12
~0
G/T

G/T
~0
~12
~0
~12

~ ~12 ~0
CONVERSATION
PRIVACY
DEVICES
(VX.006)

LIGHT BULB
TRANSFORMER
U4
U3
U2
U1

To the following
module

(C4.007)
(C4.008)
BUTTON MODULE
14
U4
U3
U2
U1

C4
C3
C2
C1
14

G/T
U1
C2
C1
PS

C2
10
6
7

(C4.006)
(VX.021)

5
4
F
3
SN
1
1/~
~
2
DOOR UNIT

Lock
Release

C1
11
4
15

SN2
13
8
3
9

SN1
5
2
1

~0
~12

14
12

(C4.006)
(VX.021)

G/T
U1
C2
C1
PS

G/T
~12
~0
~12
~0
G/T

G/T
~0
~12
~0
~12

5
4
F
3
SN
1
1/~
~
2
Lock
Release

RELAY
BOX

DOOR UNIT

Name tag
lighting
MAIN ~

Name tag
lighting

MAIN ~

ELECTRIC LOCK

ELECTRIC LOCK

~ ~12 ~0

~0 ~12 ~

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

N.2 TRANSFORMER

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1b 7

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO TWO OUTDOOR STATIONS


WITH SECRECY OF CONVERSATION
(Panels Mod. 725 or Mod. Domus Aura)

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

The 1+1 wire door phone system makes it possible to set up systems
in which a door phone riser is to be connected to two entrances each
with 1 push button panel with related loudspeaking unit.
Adding a specific relay device, a person can press a key of one of
the two push button panels so that the user of the door phone called,
on lifting the handset, is automatically connected with the calling push
button panel excluding the other service.
Therefore in this system, it is not possible to speak from two outdoor
stations at the same time in that functioning of these is alternative.
to guarantee secrecy of conversation of all the door phones in the
system, the specific secrecy circuits (one for each button) are inserted
inside only one of the two push button panels.
Release of the electric lock is also enabled by the secrecy circuit. This
means that a user cannot release the lock unless he/she has been
called and can open only the lock corresponding to the push button
panel from which the call has been made.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SC101-0937B:
DOOR PHONE REFERENCES
N. X
N. X

Door phones Mod. Utopia


or
Door phones Mod. Atlantico

Ref. 1134/35
Ref. 1133/35A

POWER SUPPLY REFERENCES


N. X
N. 1

Transformer
Relay box

Ref. 9000/230
Ref. 788/51

OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES

1+(n-2)

725 model
N. 2
Panels with N buttons
N. 2
Amplified door unit
N. X/4 Conversation privacy device

Mod. 725
Ref. 1035/67
Ref. 1035/25

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Panels with anodized aluminium front plate
Mod. 725 section of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system product technical manual.

1+(n-1)
or

Domus Aura model


N. 2
Panels with N buttons
N. 2
Amplified door unit
N. X/4 Conversation privacy device

Mod. 1110
Ref. 1035/67
Ref. 1110/74

For the panels references and the accessories refer to Panels


Domus Aura section of Doorphone and Videodoorphone
system - product technical manual.

1+n
DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)

6+n

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

C1.002
VX.006
VX.014

7+n

8 sec.1b

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SC101-0937B
COLUMN

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO TWO OUTDOOR STATIONS


WITH SECRECY OF CONVERSATION
(Panels Mod. 725 or Mod. Domus Aura)

CA1
1
2

CA1
1
2

Name tag
lighting

(VX.006)

7
10
6
C2

P.E.
SN
PS
4
5
3
1/~
~
2

12
11
2
C1

SN2
3
8

SN1
1
4

9
5

~0
~12

Lock
Release

14

41

14

Name tag
lighting

41

P.E.
SN
PS
4
5
3
1/~
~
2
Lock
Release

RELAY
BOX

ELECTRIC LOCK

ELECTRIC LOCK
MAIN ~

~~
120
~12
~0
(VX.014)

Name tag
lighting

MAIN ~

~~
012

N.2 TRANSFORMERS

~
~

MAIN ~

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

LIGHT BULB
TRANSFORMER

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1b 9

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO FOUR OUTDOOR STATIONS


WITH SECRECY OF CONVERSATION
(Panels Mod. Sinthesi or K-Steel)

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

The 1+1 wire door phone system makes it possible to set up systems
in which a door phone riser is to be connected to four entrances each
with 1 push button panel with related loudspeaking unit.
Adding a specific relay device, a person can press a key of one of
the two push button panels so that the user of the door phone called,
on lifting the handset, is automatically connected with the calling push
button panel excluding the other service.
Therefore in this system, it is not possible to speak from four outdoor
stations at the same time in that functioning of these is alternative.
To guarantee secrecy of conversation of all the door phones in the
system, the specific secrecy circuits (one for each button) are inserted
inside only one of the two push button panels.
Release of the electric lock is also enabled by the secrecy circuit. This
means that a user cannot release the lock unless he/she has been
called and can open only the lock corresponding to the push button
panel from which the call has been made.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SC101-1218C:

1+(n-2)

DOOR PHONE REFERENCES


N. X
N. X

Door phones Mod. Utopia


or
Door phones Mod. Atlantico

Ref. 1134/35
Ref. 1133/35A

POWER SUPPLY REFERENCES


N. 4
N. 1

Transformer
Relay box

Ref. 9000/230
Ref. 788/54

OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES


Sinthesi model
N. X
Button modules
N. 4
Module with door unit set-up
N. 4
Amplified door unit
N. X/4 Conversation privacy device

Ref. 1145/11-/12-/13-/14
Ref. 1145/20-/21
Ref. 1145/67
Ref. 1145/74

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.

1+(n-1)
or

K-Steel model
N. X
Button modules
N. 4
Module with door unit
N. X/4 Conversation privacy device

Ref. 1155/11-/12A-/13A-/14A
Ref. 1155/30-/31-/32A
Ref. 1145/74

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

1+n

DIAGRAM NOTES
8+n

8+n

(see section 1)
C1.002
C4.006
Sinthesi models only:
Connect jumper C1 with U1.

8+n

9+n

C4.007
C4.008
VX.006
VX.014

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

VX.021
Cut or remove the jumpers on the device(s):
a) PS G/T
b) 4 F

10 sec.1b

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SC101-1218C
COLUMN

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO FOUR OUTDOOR STATIONS


WITH SECRECY OF CONVERSATION
(Panels Mod. Sinthesi or K-Steel)

CA1
Name tag
lighting

2
1
(VX.014)
MAIN ~
CA1
2
~

~ ~0 ~12

LIGHT BULB
TRANSFORMER

To the following
module

To the following
module

(C4.007)
(C4.008)
BUTTONS MODULE
G/T
~12
~0
~12
~0
G/T

(C4.007)
(C4.008)
BUTTONS MODULE
U4
U3
U2
U1

U4
U3
U2
U1

G/T
~12
~0
~12
~0
G/T

R1 R2 1 2 6 9 V3 V5
G/T
~0
~12
~0
~12

G/T
U1
C2
C1

C3
+TC
SE
2
-6
+6
R1
SN3
V3

(C4.006)
(VX.021)

5
4
PS
F
3
SN
1/~
1
~
2

Name tag
lighting

DOOR UNIT

COLUMN

INPUT
C

INPUT
D

1
~0
~12
V5

C4
+TC
SE
2
-6
+6
R1
SN4
V3

G/T
U1

(C4.006)
(VX.021)

C2
C1
5

G/T
~0
~12
~0
~12

4
PS
F
3
SN
1/~
1
~
2

1
~0
~12
V5

Lock
Release

Lock
Release

Name tag
lighting

DOOR UNIT

MAIN ~

MAIN ~
ELECTRIC LOCK

ELECTRIC LOCK
~

~ ~12 ~0

~12 ~0 ~

"C"

"D"
TRANSFORMER

TRANSFORMER
RELAY
BOX

To the following
module

(C4.007)
(C4.008)
BUTTONS MODULE

(C4.007)
(C4.008)
BUTTONS MODULE

G/T
~0
~12
~0
~12

14
U4
U3
U2
U1
CONVERSATION
PRIVACY DEVICES
(VX.006)
G/T
U1
C2
C1

C2
+TC
SE
2
-6
+6
R1
SN2
V3

(C4.006)
(VX.021)

5
4
Name tag
lighting

PS
F
3
SN
1/~
1
~
2
DOOR UNIT

1
~0
~12
V5

INPUT
B

INPUT
A

(C4.006)
(VX.021)

VOLTAGE

14
G/T
U1
C2
C1
5

G/T
~12
~0
~12
~0
G/T

G/T
~0
~12
~0
~12

4
PS
F
3
SN
1/~
1
~
2

1
~0
~12
V5

+ + ~ ~ ~ ~
SE 6 TC A 0 12 B R1 6 R2 AP

Lock
Release

C1
+TC
SE
2
-6
+6
R1
SN1
V3

U4
U3
U2
U1

C4
C3
C2
C1

Lock
Release

Name tag
lighting

DOOR UNIT

MAIN ~
RETE ~
ELECTRIC LOCK

ELECTRIC LOCK
~

~ ~12 ~0

"B"

~0

~12 ~

"A"

TRANSFORMER
TRANSFORMER

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1b 11

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

G/T
~12
~0
~12
~0
G/T

To the following
module

To the following
conversation
privacy devices

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL COLUMN OF DOOR PHONES


TO COMMON OUTDOOR STATIONS
Each group in also connected to its own secondary outdoor station
(Panels Mod. Sinthesi or K-Steel)

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

It is the ideal solution for residential centers where the single villas
have to be connected to both their own outdoor stations and a common
one at the main entrance.
During the call the concerned door phone is automatically switched to
the common outdoor station or to the one of the group it belongs to, by
means of a switching relay.
Services towards secondary outdoor stations are independent and can
therefore take place at the same time.
When the call comes from the common outdoor station, only the group
the called door phone belongs to is switched to it, the others being
able to carry on the normal service with their own secondary outdoor
stations.
To guarantee secrecy of conversation of all the door phones in the
system, the specific secrecy circuits (one for each button) are inserted
inside only one of the two push button panels.
Release of the electric lock is also enabled by the secrecy circuit. This
means that a user cannot release the lock unless he/she has been
called and can open only the lock corresponding to the push button
panel from which the call has been made.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SC101-1241B:

1+(n-2)

1+(n-2)

1+(n-1)

1+(n-1)

DOOR PHONE REFERENCES


N. X
N. X

Ref. 1134/35
Ref. 1133/35A

POWER SUPPLY REFERENCES


N. K+1 Transformer
N. K
Relay box

Ref. 9000/230
Ref. 788/51

OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES


Sinthesi model
N. X
Button modules
N. K+1 Module with door unit set-up
N. K+1 Amplified door unit
N. X/4 Conversation privacy device

Ref. 1145/11-/12-/13-/14
Ref. 1145/20-/21
Ref. 1145/67
Ref. 1145/74

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.
or
K-Steel model
N. Y
Button modules
N. K+1 Module with door unit
N. X/4 Conversation privacy device

Ref. 1155/11-/12A-/13A-/14A
Ref. 1155/30-/31-/32A
Ref. 1145/74

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

1+n

1+n

Door phones Mod. Utopia


or
Door phones Mod. Atlantico

DIAGRAM NOTES
9+n

3+n

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

3+n

8+K+
n+n...

9+n 2+(K-2)+
n+n...

(see section 1)
C1.002
C4.007
C4.008
VX.006
VX.014
VX.021
Cut or remove the jumpers on the device(s):
a) 4 F

2
K= quantity of columns

12 sec.1b

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SC101-1241B
1ST COLUMN

2ND COLUMN

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL COLUMN OF DOOR PHONES


TO COMMON OUTDOOR STATIONS
Each group in also connected to its own secondary outdoor station
(Panels Mod. Sinthesi or K-Steel)

CA1
2
1

To the following
conversation
privacy devices

CA1
2

(C4.007)
(C4.008)

CONVERSATION
PRIVACY DEVICES

BUTTONS MODULE

(VX.006)
14

C4
C3
C2
C1

U4
U3
U2
U1

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12
G/T

U4
U3
U2
U1

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12
G/T

14

14

C4
C3
C2
C1
14

To the
following
module
(C4.007)
(C4.008)
BUTTONS MODULE
G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12
G/T

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12

U4
U3
U2
U1

4
7
15
5
C1
8
1
11

C2
6
13
SN2
2
SN1
3
9

14
12

~0
~12
10

F
3
SN
1/~
1
~
2
C2
C1

(VX.021)

DOOR UNIT

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12
G/T

U4
U3
U2
U1

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12

U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12
G/T

U4
U3
U2
U1

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12

U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T

Name tag
lighting

4
PS

Lock
Release
RELAY
BOX

U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T

CONNECTION
AS 1ST GROUP

SECONDARY
ENTRY

(C4.017)

ELECTRIC LOCK

To relay

MAIN ~

MAIN ~

MAIN ENTRY

To the following
module

Name tag
lighting

(VX.014)

~ ~
0 12

TRANSFORMER

C1

1
1/~

~~
12

LIGHT BULB
TRANSFORMER

SN

5
4
F
3
1
1/~
~
2
PS
C1
C2

ELECTRIC LOCK

Calls
C1

DOOR UNIT

(VX.021)
1

Common

1/~
MAIN ~
MAIN ~

Lock
Release
~ ~
12 0

Name tag
lighting
(VX.014)

~
TRANSFORMER

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

~~
12

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

Name tag
lighting

TO THE FOLLOWING
GROUP

(C4.017)

~
LIGHT BULB
TRANSFORMER

sec.1b 13

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF 1 DOOR PHONES TO 1 OUTDOOR STATION


Door phone can open door during call from panel

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

This service is particularly required by professional offices, where a lot


of people coming in and out obliges to often open the door without the
use of the door phone to talk with the outside.
Diagram SC101-1327 shows the connection of a door phone to a
normal 1+1 wire electrical door phone system. Equip the system with
a relay Ref. 788/22, a power unit Ref. 1090/850 and a timed relay
Ref.1032/81.
The concerned door phone will energise the door phone which will in
turn release the electrical lock when the switch (not supplied by us) is
positioned during the call step.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SC101-1327:
DOOR PHONE REFERENCES
N. X
N. X

Door phones Mod. Utopia


or
Door phone Mod. Atlantico

Ref. 1134/35
Ref. 1133/35A

POWER SUPPLY FOR DOOR PHONE SYSTEM REFERENCES

1+n

N. 1
N. 1
N. 1

1+n

Transformer
Relay box
Timer

Ref. 9000/230
Ref. 788/22
Ref. 1032/81

DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)
C4.023

VX.021
Cut or remove the jumpers on the device(s):
a) AMCR

1+n

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

FROM RISING
COLUMN

14 sec.1b

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SC101-1327
TO THE FOLLOWING
DOOR PHONES

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF 1 DOOR PHONES TO 1 OUTDOOR STATION


Door phone can open door during call from panel

1
2

SWITCH
N.N.F.
RELAY
BOX

TIMER TO
ELECTRIC LOCK

+
CH+L CH+
0L
C
NA
NC

SE2
-/~

+24
+12/~
-/~

~12
~0
0
MAIN~
230

AP
NO
C
NC

(C4.023)
(VX.021)

TRANSFORMER

SINGLE
CALLS

COMMON

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

FROM RISING
COLUMN

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1b 15

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

RELEASE OF TWO ELECTRICAL LOCKS AT THE SAME TIME


a) 725 or Domus Aura door unit
b) Sinthesi or K-Steel door unit

SC101-1269A

Example "A"

SUPPLEMENTARY
TRANSFORMER
Ref.9000/230

TRANSFORMER
Ref.9000/230

3
PS
4
5
1/~
SN
~
2

~ ~0 ~12

~12 ~0 ~

MAIN~

MAIN~
RELAY
Ref.788/52
~12
2
CA
~0
S2
S3
S1

Lock Release
ELECTRIC LOCK

Supplementary
Lock Release
SUPPLEMENTARY
ELECTRIC LOCK

Example "B"

SUPPLEMENTARY
TRANSFORMER
Ref.9000/230

TRANSFORMER
Ref.9000/230

~0

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

~12

5
4
PS
F
3
SN
1
1/~
~
2

~ ~0 ~12

~12 ~0 ~

MAIN~

MAIN~
RELAY
Ref.788/52

Lock Release
ELECTRIC LOCK

~12
2
CA
~0
S2
S3
S1

Supplementary
Lock Release
SUPPLEMENTARY
ELECTRIC LOCK

16 sec.1b

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

SECTION 1C
(REV.C)

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

BASIC DIAGRAMS FOR


TRADITIONAL CALL
DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

Download from:
www.urmetdomus.com
Technical Manuals area
DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1c 1

DOOR PHONE AND VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEM - DIAGRAM - Section 1C

SECTION 1C CONTENTS
DOOR PHONE AND VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEM - DIAGRAM

Diagram

Sec.

Pag.

BASIC DIAGRAMS FOR TRADITIONAL CALL DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS


CONNECTION OF DOOR PHONES TO 1 OUTDOOR STATION ................................................................ SC101-1247A .............. 1c ................ 2
CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 2 OUTDOOR STATIONS ............................................ SC101-0440B .............. 1c ................ 4
CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 3 OR 4 OUTDOOR STATIONS ................................... SC101-0441C .............. 1c ................ 6
CONNECTION OF SEVERAL COLUMNS OF DOOR PHONES TO 1 MAIN OUTDOOR STATION
Each column is also connected to its own outdoor station ............................................................................ SC101-0461B .............. 1c ................ 8

I sec.1c

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

DOOR PHONE AND VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEM - DIAGRAM

TRADITIONAL CALL DOOR PHONE SYSTEM DIAGRAM CROSS-REFERENCE TABLE


LIST OF AVAILABLE FUNCTIONS
Number of main panels to be installed
Number of secondary panels to be installed
DIAGRAM

PAG

1 0 CONNECTION OF DOOR PHONES TO 1 OUTDOOR STATION

DIAGRAM DESCRIPTION

SC101-1247A

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL COLUMNS OF DOOR PHONES TO 1 MAIN OUTDOOR STATION


1 K
Each column is also connected to its own outdoor station

SC101-0461B

2 0 CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 2 OUTDOOR STATIONS

SC101-0440B

4 0 CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 3 OR 4 OUTDOOR STATIONS

SC101-0441C

K = number of columns with panel


NOTE: The diagrams shown in this table can be made using Sinthesi, K-Steel, 725 panel models.

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1c II

DOOR PHONE AND VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEM - DIAGRAM - Section 1C

SECTION 1C CONTENTS

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF DOOR PHONES TO 1 OUTDOOR STATION

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

This is certainly the most common type of door phone system.


Press a button on the panel outside the building door to make the
buzzer of the corresponding door phone ring. Lift the handset of the
called door phone to establish a conversation with the door unit.
Simply fully press the handset hook to operate the electrical door
lock.
Using the door phone Ref. 1130/55 must press the button no the
handset to estabilish a conversation with the door unit; simply picking
up the handset is not sufficient.
The advantage is that any handsets left accidentally off-hook do not
interfer with the optimal operation of the other door phones.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SC101-1247A:

4+(n-2)

DOOR PHONE REFERENCES


N. X

Door phones Mod. 1130

N. X

or
Door phones Mod. 1130
with insertion key

Ivory colour
White colour

Ref. 1130
Ref. 1130/50

White colour

Ref. 1130/55

POWER SUPPLY FOR DOOR PHONE SYSTEM REFERENCES


N. 1

Power supply for


door phone system

28VA

Ref. 786/11

OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES


Sinthesi model
N. X
Button modules
N. 1
Module with door unit set-up
N. 1
Amplified door unit

4+(n-1)

Ref. 1145/11-/12-/13-/14
Ref. 1145/20-/21-/22
Ref. 1145/500

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.

or
K-Steel model
N. X
Button modules
N. 1
Module with door unit

4+n

Ref. 1155/11-/12A-/13A-/14A
Ref. 1155/20-/21-/22A

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

9+n
2

or
725 model
N. 1
Panel with N buttons
N. 1
Amplified door unit

Mod. 725
Ref. 1128/500

For the panels references and the accessories refer to Panels


with anodized Aluminium front plate Mod. 725 section of
Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.
or

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

1128 model
N. 1
Front case for door unit
N. 1
Door unit
N. X
Front case
N. X
Button

Ref. 1128/20-/21
Ref. 1128/500
Ref. 1128/10-/11
Ref. 1128/1-/2

For boards of accessories refer to Wall Mounted Panel


Mod. 1128 section of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system
product technical manual.

DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)
C4.001
C4.004
C4.007
C4.008
VX.014

2 sec.1c

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SC101-1247A
COLUMN

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF DOOR PHONES TO 1 OUTDOOR STATION

1
2
6
11
10
9
8
7

LIGHT BULB
TRANSFORMER

1
2
6
11
10
9
8
7

~12
~0

Name tag
lighting
(VX.014)

~
~

MAIN ~

(C4.007)
(C4.008)

U4
U3
U2
U1

POWER SUPPLY
FOR DOOR
PHONE SYSTEM

U2
U1
G/T

PS
~12
~18

L
1
2
+
1A

~0
-J
-6
+6

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0

Lock
Release

~
MAIN ~

(C4.004)

Name tag
lighting
ELECTRIC
LOCK

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0
G/T

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1c 3

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 2 OUTDOOR STATIONS

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

This type of installation solves the problem to connect a series of door


phones of a building with 2 entrances each one equipped with a push
button panel.
This solution permits, by simply pushing a button from one of the 2
push button panels, to connect automatically the user to the calling
push button panels unhooking the handset. This type of installation
does not allow to talk from both outdoor stations simultaneously, since
they work alternatively.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SC101-0440B:

4+(n-2)

DOOR PHONE REFERENCES


N. X

Ivory colour
White colour

Ref. 1130
Ref. 1130/50

POWER SUPPLY FOR DOOR PHONE SYSTEM REFERENCES


N. 1

Door phones Mod. 1130

N. 1

Power supply for


door phone system
Relay box

28VA

Ref. 786/11
Ref. 788/51

OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES

4+(n-1)

Sinthesi model
N. X
Button modules
N. 2
Module with door unit set-up
N. 2
Amplified door unit

Ref. 1145/11-/12-/13-/14
Ref. 1145/20-/21-/22
Ref. 1145/500

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.
or
K-Steel model
N. X
Button modules
N. 2
Module with door unit

4+n

7+n

7+n

Ref. 1155/11-/12A-/13A-/14A
Ref. 1155/20-/21-/22A

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.
or
725 model
N. 2
Panel with N buttons
N. 2
Amplified door unit

Mod. 725
Ref. 1128/500

For the panels references and the accessories refer to Panels


with anodized Aluminium front plate Mod. 725 section of
Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.
or

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

1128 model
N. 2
Front case for door unit
N. 2
Door unit
N. X
Front case
N. X
Button

Ref. 1128/20-/21
Ref. 1128/500
Ref. 1128/10-/11
Ref. 1128/1-/2

For boards of accessories refer to Wall Mounted Panel


Mod. 1128 section of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system
product technical manual.

DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)
C4.001
C4.007
C4.008
VX.014

4 sec.1c

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SC101-0440B
COLUMN

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 2 OUTDOOR STATIONS

1
2
6
11
10
9
8
7

1
2
6
11
10
9
8
7

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0
G/T

U4
U3
U2
U1

U4
U3
U2
U1
(C4.007)
(C4.008)

(C4.007)
(C4.008)
8

U2
U1
G/T

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0

SN1

L
1
2
+
1A

1
4

Lock
Release

Name tag
lighting

L
1
2
+
1A

12
15

RELAY
BOX

Lock
Release

~
C2 C1 12

~
0 11

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0

Name tag
lighting

14
9

ELECTRIC
LOCK

ELECTRIC
LOCK

Name tag
lighting
MAIN ~

MAIN ~

~~
120

~ - - ~ + PS
126 J 0 6

POWER SUPPLY
FOR DOOR
PHONE SYSTEM

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

LIGHT BULB
TRANSFORMER

U2
U1
G/T

3
6

(VX.014)

52
SN2

10
13

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0
G/T

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1c 5

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 3 OR 4 OUTDOOR STATIONS

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

This installation allows connection of a series of door phone to 3 or 4


push button panels.
By simply pushing a button on one of the 4 panels, the called door
phone, picking up the handset, is automatically connected with the
calling push button panel.
It is not possible to talk from the outdoor stations simultaneously, since
they work alternatively.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SC101-0441C:

5+(n-2)
6

DOOR PHONE REFERENCES


N. X

N. 1

7+n

7+n
2

Ref. 1130
Ref. 1130/50

28VA

Ref. 786/11
Ref. 788/58

OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES


Ref. 1145/11-/12-/13-/14
Ref. 1145/20-/21-/22
Ref. 1145/500

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.

5+n
7+n

Power supply for


door phone system
Relay box

Sinthesi model
N. X
Button modules
N. 4
Module with door unit set-up
N. 4
Amplified door unit

Ivory colour
White colour

POWER SUPPLY FOR DOOR PHONE SYSTEM REFERENCES


N. 1

5+(n-1)

Door phones Mod. 1130

or
K-Steel model
N. X
Button modules
N. 4
Module with door unit

Ref. 1155/11-/12A-/13A-/14A
Ref. 1155/20-/21-/22A

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

7+n

or

2
725 model
N. 4
Panel with N buttons
N. 4
Amplified door unit

Mod. 725
Ref. 1128/500

For the panels references and the accessories refer to Panels


with anodized Aluminium front plate Mod. 725 section of
Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.
or

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

1128 model
N. 4
Front case for door unit
N. 4
Door unit
N. X
Front case
N. X
Button

Ref. 1128/20-/21
Ref. 1128/500
Ref. 1128/10-/11
Ref. 1128/1-/2

For boards of accessories refer to Wall Mounted Panel


Mod. 1128 section of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system
product technical manual.

DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)
C4.001
C4.007
C4.008
VX.014

6 sec.1c

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SC101-0441B
TO THE FOLLOWING
DOOR PHONES

1
2
6
11
10
9
8
7

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL DOOR PHONES TO 3 OR 4 OUTDOOR STATIONS

1
2
6
11
10
9
8
7
TO THE FOLLOWING
MODULES

TO THE FOLLOWING
MODULES
(C4.007)
(C4.008)

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0
G/T

(C4.007)
(C4.008)

U4
U3
U2
U1

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0
G/T

U4
U3
U2
U1
AP 2 1

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0

U2
U1
G/T
L
1
2
+
1A

SN4

SN3

1 IV
2 IV
- IV

1 III
2 III
- III

U2
U1
G/T
L
1
2
+
1A
Lock
Release

Lock
Release

Name tag
lighting

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0

AP IV

ELECTRIC LOCK

Name tag
lighting

AP III

ELECTRIC LOCK

TO THE FOLLOWING
MODULES

TO THE FOLLOWING
MODULES
(C4.007)
(C4.008)
U4
U3
U2
U1

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0

U4
U3
U2
U1

U2
U1
G/T
L
1
2
+
1A

SN1

SN2

1I
2I
-I

1 II
2 II
- II
RELAY
BOX

Lock
Release

Name tag
lighting

U2
U1
G/T

AP I

ELECTRIC LOCK

AP II

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0
G/T
G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0

L
1
2
+
1A
Lock
Release

Name tag
lighting

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0
G/T

(C4.007)
(C4.008)

ELECTRIC LOCK

~~
0 12 C1 C2

Name tag
lighting
(VX.014)

~~
120

LIGHT BULB
TRANSFORMER

~18
+6
~0
~12
-6
PS
-J

MAIN~

MAIN~

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

POWER SUPPLY
FOR HOUSE
PHONE SYSTEM

sec.1c 7

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL COLUMNS OF DOOR PHONES TO 1 MAIN


OUTDOOR STATION
Each column is also connected to its own outdoor station

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

It is the ideal solution for residential centers where the single villas
have to be connected to both their own outdoor stations and a common
one at the main entrance.
During the call the concerned door phone is automatically switched to
the common outdoor station or to the one of the group it belongs to, by
means of a switching relay.
Services towards secondary outdoor stations are independent and can
therefore take place at the same time.
When the call comes from the common outdoor station, only the group
the called door phone belongs to is switched to it, the others being
able to carry on the normal service with their own secondary outdoor
stations.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SC101-0461B:

4+(n-2)

4+(n-2)

DOOR PHONE REFERENCES


N. X

Door phones Mod. 1130

Ivory colour
White colour

Ref. 1130
Ref. 1130/50

POWER SUPPLY FOR DOOR PHONE SYSTEM REFERENCES


N. K+1 Power supply for
door phone system
N. K
Relay box
N. K
Call repeater relay

28VA

Ref. 786/11
Ref. 788/51
Ref. 788/52

5
OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES

4+(n-1)

4+(n-1)

4+n

4+n

Sinthesi model
N. X
Button modules
N. K+1 Module with door unit set-up
N. K+1 Amplified door unit

Ref. 1145/11-/12-/13-/14
Ref. 1145/20-/21-/22
Ref. 1145/500

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.
or
K-Steel model
N. X
Button modules
N. K+1 Module with door unit

9+n

5+n

5+n

Ref. 1155/11-/12A-/13A-/14A
Ref. 1155/20-/21-/22A

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

9+n
5+K+n
or

725 model
N. K+1 Panel with N buttons
N. K+1 Amplified door unit

8+K+
n+n...

Mod. 725
Ref. 1128/500

For the panels references and the accessories refer to Panels


with anodized Aluminium front plate Mod. 725 section of
Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

2
or

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

1128 model
N. K+1 Front case for door unit
N. K+1 Door unit
N. X
Front case
N. X
Button

Ref. 1128/20-/21
Ref. 1128/500
Ref. 1128/10-/11
Ref. 1128/1-/2

For boards of accessories refer to Wall Mounted Panel


Mod. 1128 section of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system
product technical manual.

K= quantity of columns

DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)
C4.001
C4.007
C4.008

8 sec.1c

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SC101-0461B
1st COLUMN

2nd COLUMN

1
2
6
11
10
9
8
7

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL COLUMNS OF DOOR PHONES TO 1 MAIN


OUTDOOR STATION
Each column is also connected to its own outdoor station

1
2
6
11
10
9
8
7
TO THE FOLLOWING
MODULES
(C4.007)
(C4.008)
RELAY
BOX

52

10
11
12

~12
~0
~0
~12
G/T

G/T
U4
U3
U2
U1

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12

U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T

~12
~0
~0
~12
G/T

G/T
U4
U3
U2
U1

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12

U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T

~12
~0
~0
~12
G/T

G/T
U4
U3
U2
U1

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12

U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0
G/T

CONNECTION AS
1ST GROUP

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0

L
1
2
+
1A

3
6

1
4
TO THE FOLLOWING
MODULES

U4
U3
U2
U1

U2
U1
G/T

SN2

SN1

U4
U3
U2
U1

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0
G/T

SN1

Lock
Release

13
9
15

14
7

Name tag
lighting

ELECTRIC
LOCK

4
-6

~ ~
C1 C2 12 0
MAIN ~

~12 ~0 -6 +6

POWER SUPPLY
FOR DOOR
PHONE SYSTEM

Calls

Name tag
lighting
(C4.007)
(C4.008)

L
1
2
+
1A
Lock
Release

ELECTRIC
LOCK

SN1

1
4
-6
7
CA
2
S1
S3
~12
~0
6
C
S2

TO THE FOLLOWING
COLUMN

Common

Name tag
lighting
(VX.014)
MAIN ~
MAIN ~

~12 +6 -6 ~0

POWER SUPPLY
FOR DOOR
PHONE SYSTEM

LIGHT BULB
TRANSFORMER

~~
120

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

CALL
REPEATER RELAY

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1c 9

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS


BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS
10 sec.1c

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

SECTION 1D
(REV.C)

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

BASIC DIAGRAMS
FOR COAX ELECTRONIC
VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

Download from:
www.urmetdomus.com
Technical Manuals area
DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1d 1

DOOR PHONE AND VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEM - DIAGRAM - Section 1D

SECTION 1D CONTENTS
DOOR PHONE AND VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEM - DIAGRAM

Diagram

Sec.

Pag.

BASIC DIAGRAMS
FOR COAX ELECTRONIC VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS
CONNECTION OF MAX. 2 VIDEO DOOR PHONES TO 1 VIDEO DOOR UNIT .......................................... SV102-3146D ..............1d ................ 2
CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONES TO 1 VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION ...................... SV102-2631E ..............1d ................ 4
CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONES AND HOUSE PHONES
TO 1 VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION
Connection in the riser of a number of house phones with voice service only ............................................... SV102-1609E ..............1d ................ 6
CONNECTION OF 4 VIDEO DOOR PHONES TO 1 VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION
The video outdoor station calls the 4 video door phones
in parallel with concurrent power-on............................................................................................................... SV102-2066D ..............1d ................ 8
CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONES TO 1 OUTDOOR STATION
EQUIPPED WITH A SEPARATE CCD TV CAMERA
Possibility of automatic connection by the video door phones to the TV camera........................................... SV102-3118C ..............1d ............. 10
CONNECTION OF 1 VIDEO DOOR PHONE TO 1 VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION
Possibility of automatic activation of a second control tv camera................................................................... SV102-3119A ..............1d ............. 12
CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONES TO 2 VIDEO OUTDOOR STATIONS .................... SV102-2892D ..............1d ............. 14
CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONE GROUPS
TO 1 VIDEO DOOR UNIT AND 1 DOOR UNIT ............................................................................................. SV102-2934C ..............1d ............. 16
CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONES TO 4 VIDEO OUTDOOR STATIONS .................... SV102-3078B ..............1d ............. 18
CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONE COLUMNS
TO A MAIN VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION
Each column is connected to 1 proper secondary video outdoor station ....................................................... SV102-3079A ..............1d ............. 20
CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONE COLUMNS
TO 1 MAIN VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION
Each columns is also connected to its own secondary outdoor station.......................................................... SV102-2935E ..............1d ............. 22
CONNECTION OF 3 INTERCOM VIDEO DOOR PHONES WITH POSSIBILITY
OF ANSWERING CALLS FROM 1 ELECTRICAL VIDEO DOOR UNIT
Single call from outside with concurrent power-on ......................................................................................... SV102-2970D ..............1d ............. 24
CONNECTION OF MAXIMUM 9 INTERCOM ATLANTICO VIDEO DOOR PHONES
WITH POSSIBILITY OF ANSWERING CALLS FROM 1 ELECTRICAL VIDEO DOOR UNIT
Single call from the outside with concurrent power-on ................................................................................... SV102-2972D ..............1d ............. 26
CONNECTION OF 3 INTERCOM Atlantico VIDEO DOOR PHONES WITH POSSIBILITY
OF ANSWERING CALLS FROM 2 ELECTRICAL VIDEO DOOR UNITS
The video outdoor stations call the video door phones in parallel with concurrent power-on ........................ SV102-3257A ..............1d ............. 28
CONNECTION OF A CALL REPEATER RELAY IN PARALLELTO THE VIDEO DOOR PHONE ................ SV102-1469D ..............1d ............. 30
CONNECTION IN PARALLEL OF 1 VIDEO DOOR PHONE AND 1 DOOR PHONE.................................... SV102-1574C ..............1d ............. 30
CONNECTION OF A CALL REPEATER RELAY IN PARALLEL TO THE VIDEO DOOR PHONE ............... SV102-0782D ..............1d ............. 31
CONNECTION OF 3 VIDEO DOOR PHONE EXTENSIONS IN PARALLEL
TO A SYSTEM WITH VIDEO DOOR UNIT
The video door phones are called at the same time....................................................................................... SV102-2132E ..............1d ............. 32
CORRISPONDENCE OF TERMINALS BETWEEN
Scaitel AND Sentry+ OR Atlantico VIDEODOORPHONE.............................................................................. SV102-1977A ..............1d ............. 32
CONNECTION OF 3 INTERCOM VIDEO DOOR PHONE EXTENSIONS
TO A SYSTEM WITH VIDEO DOOR UNIT
Single call from outside with concurrent power-on ......................................................................................... SV102-1349E ..............1d ............. 34
CONNECTION OF N VIDEO DOOR PHONES TO 1 VIDEO DOOR UNIT
Distance between video door phone and video door unit in the range from 300 to 1000 metres .................. SV102-1241D ..............1d ............. 36
CONNECTION OF SEVERAL COLOURS VIDEO DOOR PHONES TO 1 VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION.... SV102-3063A ..............1d ............. 38
CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONES TO 1 DOOR UNIT
Door open indicator on video door phones..................................................................................................... SV102-3228A ..............1d ............. 40

I sec.1d

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

DOOR PHONE AND VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEM - DIAGRAM

CONNECTION OF N FREE-HANDS UTOPIA COLOUR VIDEO DOOR PHONES


TO 1 VIDEO DOOR UNIT AND TO 1 DOOR UNIT ..........................................................................................SV102-3227 ..............1d ............. 42
CONNECTION OF N FREE-HANDS COLOUR VIDEO DOOR PHONE COLUMNS
TO 1 MAIN VIDEO DOOR UNIT
Each column is additionally connected to a specific secondary door unit ........................................................SV102-3235 ..............1d ............. 44
CONNECTION OF 3 INTERCOM UTOPIA VIDEO DOOR PHONES WITH POSSIBILITY
OF ANSWERING CALLS FROM 1 ELECTRICAL VIDEO DOOR UNIT...........................................................SV102-3219 ..............1d ............. 46
CONNECTION OF 2 INTERCOM UTOPIA VIDEO DOOR PHONES WITH POSSIBILITY
OF ANSWERING CALLS FROM 1 ELECTRICAL VIDEO DOOR UNIT
Single call from outside with concurrent power-on ............................................................................................SV102-3220 ..............1d ............. 48
EXAMPLES OF COAXIAL CABLE CONNECTION ..........................................................................................SV102-3294 ..............1d ............. 50
EXAMPLES OF COAXIAL CABLE CONNECTION ..........................................................................................SV102-3295 ..............1d ............. 51
EXAMPLES OF COAXIAL CABLE CONNECTION ....................................................................................... SV102-3296A ..............1d ............. 52
EXAMPLE OF CONNECTION TVCC CAMERE OR MICROCAMERA ......................................................... SV102-3229A ..............1d ............. 53

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1d II

DOOR PHONE AND VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEM - DIAGRAM - Section 1D

SECTION 1D CONTENTS

DOOR PHONE AND VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEM - DIAGRAM - Section 1D

SECTION 1D CONTENTS
DOOR PHONE AND VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEM - DIAGRAM

COAX VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEM DIAGRAM CROSS-REFERENCE TABLE


WITH BLACK AND WHITE CAMERA
LIST OF AVAILABLE FUNCTIONS
Number of main video door phone panels to be installed
Number of video door phone secondary panels to be installed
Number of main door phone panels to be installed
Number of secondary door phone panels to be installed
Single calls from panel: each user has its own call button
Calls from panel in parallel: each user has several video door phones in the apartment
Intercom function: users can communicate with each other
Auto-on: users can switch the video door phone on also if no call is received
Monitor with CCTV cameras
Use of some door phones for audio service only
Use of devices in parallel with a video door phone
Distance between video door phones and video door unit from 300 to 1000 metres
Use of kits

DIAGRAM DESCRIPTION

0 0 0

SV102-2631E

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONES AND HOUSE PHONES TO 1 VIDEO


OUTDOOR STATION. Connection in the riser of a number of house phones with voice service only SV102-1609E

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONES TO 1 OUTDOOR STATION


EQUIPPED WITH A SEPARATE CCD TV CAMERA
Possibility of automatic connection by the video door phones to the TV camera

SV102-3118C

10

CONNECTION OF 1 VIDEO DOOR PHONE TO 1 VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION


Possibility of automatic activation of a second control tv camera

SV102-3119A

12

CONNECTION OF 4 VIDEO DOOR PHONES TO 1 VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION


The video outdoor station calls the 4 video door phones in parallel with concurrent power-on

SV102-2066D

CONNECTION OF 3 INTERCOM VIDEO DOOR PHONES WITH POSSIBILITY


OF ANSWERING CALLS FROM 1 ELECTRICAL VIDEO DOOR UNIT
Single call from outside with concurrent power-on

SV102-2970D

24

CONNECTION OF MAXIMUM 9 INTERCOM Atlantico VIDEO DOOR PHONES


WITH POSSIBILITY OF ANSWERING CALLS FROM 1 ELECTRICAL VIDEO DOOR UNIT
Single call from the outside with concurrent power-on

SV102-2972D

26

CONNECTION OF N VIDEO DOOR PHONES TO 1 VIDEO DOOR UNIT


Distance between video door phone and video door unit in the range from 300 to 1000 metres

SV102-1241D

36

0 0 K

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONE COLUMNS


TO 1 MAIN VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION
Each columns is also connected to its own secondary outdoor station

SV102-2935E

22

0 1 0

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONE GROUPS


TO 1 VIDEO DOOR UNIT AND 1 DOOR UNIT

SV102-2934C

16

K 0 0

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONE COLUMNS


TO A MAIN VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION
Each column is connected to 1 proper secondary video outdoor station

SV102-3079A

20

0 0 0

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONES TO 2 VIDEO OUTDOOR STATIONS

SV102-2892D

14

0 0 0

CONNECTION OF 3 INTERCOM Atlantico VIDEO DOOR PHONES WITH POSSIBILITY


OF ANSWERING CALLS FROM 2 ELECTRICAL VIDEO DOOR UNITS
The video outdoor stations call the video door phones in parallel with concurrent power-on

SV102-3257A

28

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONES TO 4 VIDEO OUTDOOR STATIONS

SV102-3078B

18

CONNECTION OF A CALL REPEATER RELAY IN PARALLEL TO THE VIDEO DOOR PHONE SV102-0782D

31

CONNECTION OF 3 VIDEO DOOR PHONE EXTENSIONS IN PARALLEL


TO A SYSTEM WITH VIDEO DOOR UNIT
The video door phones are called at the same time

SV102-2132E

32

CONNECTION OF 3 INTERCOM VIDEO DOOR PHONE EXTENSIONS


TO A SYSTEM WITH VIDEO DOOR UNIT
Single call from outside with concurrent power-on

SV102-1349E

34

CONNECTION IN PARALLEL OF 1 VIDEO DOOR PHONE AND 1 DOOR PHONE

SV102-1574C

30

CONNECTION OF A CALL REPEATER RELAY IN PARALLELTO


THE VIDEO DOOR PHONE

SV102-1469D

30

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONES TO 1 VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION

0 0 0

0 0 0
0 0 0
0 0 0
0 0 0

0 0 0
0 0 0

PAG

SV102-3146D

0 0 0

DIAGRAM

COLLEGAMENTO DI MAX 2 VIDEOCITOFONI AD 1 VIDEOPORTIERE ELETTRICO

4 0 0 0

K = number of columns with panel


NOTE: The diagrams shown in this table can be made using Sinthesi, K-Steel, 725 panel models.

III sec.1d

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

DOOR PHONE AND VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEM - DIAGRAM

WITH COLOUR CAMERA


LIST OF AVAILABLE FUNCTIONS
Number of main video door phone panels to be installed
Number of video door phone secondary panels to be installed
Number of main door phone panels to be installed
Single calls from panel: each user has its own call button
Calls from panel in parallel: each user has several video door phones in the apartment
Intercom function: users can communicate with each other
Auto-on: users can switch the video door phone on also if no call is received
Monitor with CCTV cameras
Use of devices in parallel with a video door phone
Use of free-hands Utopia video door phone
Door open indicator on video door phone
DIAGRAM DESCRIPTION

0 0

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL COLOURS VIDEO DOOR PHONES


TO 1 VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION

0 0

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONES TO 1 DOOR UNIT


Door open indicator on video door phones

0 0

0 0
1

0 0
0 0

CONNECTION OF 3 INTERCOM UTOPIA VIDEO DOOR PHONES WITH POSSIBILITY


OF ANSWERING CALLS FROM 1 ELECTRICAL VIDEO DOOR UNIT

DIAGRAM

PAG

SV102-3063A

38

SV102-3228A

40

SV102-3219

46

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONES TO 1 OUTDOOR STATION


EQUIPPED WITH A SEPARATE CCD TV CAMERA
Possibility of automatic connection by the video door phones to the TV camera

SV102-3118C

10

CONNECTION OF 1 VIDEO DOOR PHONE TO 1 VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION


Possibility of automatic activation of a second control tv camera

SV102-3119A

12

CONNECTION OF 2 INTERCOM UTOPIA VIDEO DOOR PHONES WITH POSSIBILITY


OF ANSWERING CALLS FROM 1 ELECTRICAL VIDEO DOOR UNIT
Single call from outside with concurrent power-on

SV102-3220

48

CONNECTION OF N FREE-HANDS COLOUR VIDEO DOOR PHONE COLUMNS


TO 1 MAIN VIDEO DOOR UNIT
Each column is additionally connected to a specific secondary door unit

SV102-3235

44

CONNECTION OF N FREE-HANDS UTOPIA COLOUR VIDEO DOOR PHONES


TO 1 VIDEO DOOR UNIT AND TO 1 DOOR UNIT

SV102-3227

42

0 K
1 0

CONNECTION OF A CALL REPEATER RELAY IN PARALLEL TO THE VIDEO DOOR PHONE

SV102-0782D

31

CONNECTION OF A CALL REPEATER RELAY IN PARALLELTO THE VIDEO DOOR PHONE

SV102-1469D

30

CONNECTION IN PARALLEL OF 1 VIDEO DOOR PHONE AND 1 DOOR PHONE

SV102-1574C

30

K = number of columns with panel


NOTE: The diagrams shown in this table can be made using Sinthesi, K-Steel, 725 panel models.

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1d IV

DOOR PHONE AND VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEM - DIAGRAM - Section 1D

SECTION 1D CONTENTS

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF MAX. 2 VIDEO DOOR PHONES TO 1 VIDEO DOOR UNIT

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

This system allows connection between the video outdoor station and
the various video door phones situated in the apartments. When the
visitor presses a button on the push button panel, the bitonal electronic
call is sent to the corresponding video door phone loudspeaker and,
after about 7 seconds, the image appears on the screen.
At this point the user sees the visitor and can answer, if he wishes,
unhooking the handset. At the end of the conversation, the electric lock
can be operated by pressing the key (
).
Vision of the image lasts about 60 seconds, after which the intervention
of the built-in timer in the power supply causes it to go off. If a second
video door phone is called before the end of the 60 seconds, the first
video door phone will automatically go off and the latter comes on. This
feature guarantees secrecy of vision.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SV102-3146D:
COAX VIDEO DOOR PHONE KIT DIAGRAMS
N. 1

N. 1

7+coax

N. 1

7+coax

8+coax
TC

N. 1

10+coax

One-family kit (1 button)


with Atlantico video door phone
Ref. 1702/611
consisting of:
Sinthesi camera with integrated door unit and 1 calling
button Ref. 1745/81
1 Atlantico video door phone Ref. 1702/1 with bracket
Ref. 1202/90
1 flush mounting box for 1 module Ref. 1145/51
Module holder with frame for 1 module Ref. 1145/61
Power unit 230Vac-38VA, 10 DIN modules Ref. 789/5B
or
One-family kit (1 button)
with Artico video door phone
Ref. 1705/621
consisting of:
Sinthesi camera with integrated door unit and 1 calling
button Ref. 1745/81
1 Artico video door phone Ref. 1705/1 with bracket
Ref. 1705/90
1 flush mounting box for 1 module Ref. 1145/51
Module holder with frame for 1 module Ref. 1145/61
Power unit 230Vac-38VA, 10 DIN modules Ref. 789/5B
or
Two-family kit (2 buttons)
with Atlantico video door phone
Ref. 1702/612
consisting of:
Sinthesi camera with integrated door unit and 2 calling
buttons Ref. 1745/82
2 Atlantico video door phones Ref. 1702/1 with bracket
Ref. 1202/90
1 flush mounting box for 1 module Ref. 1145/51
Module holder with frame for 1 module Ref. 1145/61
Power unit 230Vac-38VA, 10 DIN modules Ref. 789/5B
or
Two-family kit (2 buttons)
with Artico video door phone
Ref. 1705/622
consisting of:
Sinthesi camera with integrated door unit and 2 calling
buttons Ref. 1745/82
2 Artico video door phones Ref. 1705/1 with bracket
Ref. 1705/90
1 flush mounting box for 1 module Ref. 1145/51
Module holder with frame for 1 module Ref. 1145/61
Power unit 230Vac-38VA, 10 DIN modules Ref. 789/5B

DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

VX.003

2 sec.1d

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SV102-3146D

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF MAX. 2 VIDEO DOOR PHONES TO 1 VIDEO DOOR UNIT

CA
R2
R1

V4
V5
V3

1
2
6
9
10
X1
X2
Y1
Y2
R3

CA
R2
R1

V4
V5
V3

1
2
6
9
10
X1
X2
Y1
Y2
R3

For two-family
kits only

VIDEO
POWER SUPPLY

U2
U1
G/T

PS

CAMERA UNIT
WITH DOOR UNIT
AND BUTTONS

L
1A
2
+
1

AP
~0
-6
+6
1/~
+R

TC

Lock Release
~0
V3
V5
+TC
R1
~12

+TC
R1
~12
SE1
R1
R2
R2
SE2

ELECTRIC LOCK

MAIN~

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

230

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1d 3

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONES


TO 1 VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

This system allows connection between the video outdoor station and
the various video door phones situated in the apartments. When the
visitor presses a button on the push button panel, the bitonal electronic
call is sent to the corresponding video door phone loudspeaker and,
after about 7 seconds, the image appears on the screen.
At this point the user sees the visitor and can answer, if he wishes,
unhooking the handset. At the end of the conversation, the electric lock
can be operated by pressing the key (
).
Vision of the image lasts about 60 seconds, after which the intervention
of the built-in timer in the power supply causes it to go off. If a second
video door phone is called before the end of the 60 seconds, the first
video door phone will automatically go off and the latter comes on. This
feature guarantees secrecy of vision.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SV102-2631E:
VIDEO DOOR PHONE REFERENCES
Atlantico model
N. X
Video door phones
N. X
Bracket

Ref. 1702/1
Ref. 1202/90

or
Artico model
N. X
Video door phones
N. X
Bracket

Ref. 1705/1
Ref. 1705/90
TC

6+(n-2)+coax
VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES

7+coax

Sinthesi model
N. X
Button modules
N. 1
Module with camera and door unit

Ref. 1145/11-/12-/13-/14
Ref. 1745/80-/81-/82

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.

6+(n-1)+coax

or

7+coax

K-Steel model
N. X
Button modules
Ref. 1155/11-/12A-/13A-/14A
N. 1
Module with camera and door unit
Ref. 1755/80
The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with
module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

6+n+coax
TC

or

9+n+coax

725 model
N. 1
Panel with N buttons
N. 1
Amplified door unit
N. 1
Camera
N. 1
Front plate

Mod. 725
Ref. 1128/500
Ref. 725/600
Ref. 725/601-/602

For the panels references and the accessories refer to Panels


with anodized Aluminium front plate Mod. 725 section of
Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.
or

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

1128 model
N. 1
Front case for video door unit
N. 1
Door unit with camera
N. X
Front case
N. X
Button

Ref. 1728/20-/21
Ref. 1728/80
Ref. 1128/10-/11
Ref. 1128/1-/2

For boards of accessories refer to Wall Mounted Panel


Mod. 1128 section of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system
product technical manual.
POWER SUPPLY REFERENCES
N. 1
N. 1

4 sec.1d

Video power supply


Video distributor

Ref. 789/5B
Ref. 1794/4A

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SV102-2631E
(VX.010)
(VX.011)

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONES


TO 1 VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION

CA
R2
R1

1
2
6
9
10
X1
X2
Y1
Y2
R3

V4
V5
V3

CA
R2
R1

1
2
6
9
10
X1
X2
Y1
Y2
R3

V4
V5
V3

TO THE FOLLOWING
MODULE
(C4.007)
(C4.008)

U1
U2
VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR

PS
~12

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12
G/T

U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12

Name tag
lighting

(C4.006)

SE1
AP
~0
-6
+6
Lock Release

L
1A
2
+
1
V5
V3
+TC
R1

+TC
R1
R1
R2

~0
~12

(VD.002)

ELECTRIC LOCK

SE2
VIDEO
POWER SUPPLY
(VX.008)

U4
U3
U2
U1

Name tag
lighting

~
LINE ~
~
~0
~12

DIAGRAM NOTES

LIGHT BULB
TRANSFORMER

(see section 1)

~
(VX.014)

MAIN ~

C4.006
Sinthesi models only:
Connect jumper L with G/T
C4.007
VX.008

C4.008
VX.010

VD.002
VX.011

VX.003
VX.014

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1d 5

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

R2
R1 E

TC

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONES AND HOUSE PHONES TO 1


VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION
Connection in the riser of a number of house phones with voice service only

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

This system has the same operation features as the basic system
(Scheme SV102-2631) with the possibility to add simple house phones
onto the same riser with phonic service only.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SV102-1609E:
VIDEO DOOR PHONE REFERENCES
Atlantico model
N. X
Video door phones
N. X
Bracket

Ref. 1702/1
Ref. 1202/90

or

6+(n-4)+coax

Artico model
N. X
Video door phones
N. X
Bracket

Ref. 1705/1
Ref. 1705/90

5
DOOR PHONE REFERENCES
N. X
N. X

6+(n-3)+coax

Door phone Mod. Utopia


Door phone Mod. Atlantico

Ref. 1134/1
Ref. 1133
TC

VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES

5
Sinthesi model
N. X
Button modules
N. 1
Module with camera and door unit

Ref. 1145/11-/12-/13-/14
Ref. 1745/80-/81-/82

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.

6+(n-2)+coax
7+coax
or

K-Steel model
N. X
Button modules
Ref. 1155/11-/12A-/13A-/14A
N. 1
Module with camera and door unit
Ref. 1755/80

6+(n-1)+coax
The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with
module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

7+coax
or

6+n+coax
TC

725 model
N. 1
Panel with N buttons
N. 1
Amplified door unit
N. 1
Camera
N. 1
Front plate

For the panels references and the accessories refer to Panels


with anodized Aluminium front plate Mod. 725 section of
Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

11+n+coax

or
1128 model
N. 1
Front case for video door unit
N. 1
Door unit with camera
N. X
Front case
N. X
Button

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

Mod. 725
Ref. 1128/500
Ref. 725/600
Ref. 725/601-/602

Ref. 1728/20-/21
Ref. 1728/80
Ref. 1128/10-/11
Ref. 1128/1-/2

For boards of accessories refer to Wall Mounted Panel


Mod. 1128 section of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system
product technical manual.
POWER SUPPLY REFERENCES
N. 1
N. 1

6 sec.1d

Video power supply


Video distributor

Ref. 789/5B
Ref. 1794/4A

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SV102-1609E

TO THE FOLLOWING
VIDEO DOOR PHONES
CA
1
2
6
9
10

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONES AND HOUSE PHONES TO 1


VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION
Connection in the riser of a number of house phones with voice service only

CA
1
2
6
9
10

(VX.010)
(VX.011)

CA
R2
R1

1
2
6
9
10
X1
X2
Y1
Y2
R3

V4
V5
V3

CA
1
2
6
9
10
X1
X2
Y1
Y2
R3

V4
V5
V3

TO THE
FOLLOWING
MODULES
(C4.007)
(C4.008)

U1
U2
R2
R1 E

VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR

PS
~12

U4
U3
U2
U1

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12
G/T

U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12

Name tag
lighting

(C4.006)

SE1
AP
~0
-6
+6

L
1A
2
+
1

Lock Release

V5
V3
+TC
R1

+TC
R1
R1
R2

~0
~12

(VD.002)

ELECTRIC LOCK

SE2
VIDEO
POWER SUPPLY

TC

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

R2
R1

Name tag
lighting

~
LINE~
~

(VX.008)
~0
~12
LIGHT BULB
TRANSFORMER

DIAGRAM NOTES

~
(VX.014)

MAIN~

(see section 1)
VX.003

VX.008

VX.010

VX.011

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1d 7

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF 4 VIDEO DOOR PHONES TO 1 VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION


The video outdoor station calls the 4 video door phones
in parallel with concurrent power-on

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

This system is particularly suited for detached houses where it is


necessary to call and activate 4 video door phones concurrently using
a single call key.
As the video power supply can power only one video door phone,
video door phones 2, 3 and 4 must be powered with a local power
supply.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SV102-2066D:
VIDEO DOOR PHONE REFERENCES
Atlantico model
N. 4
Video door phones
N. 4
Bracket

Ref. 1702/1
Ref. 1202/90

or
Artico model
N. 4
Video door phones
N. 4
Bracket

Ref. 1705/1
Ref. 1705/90
TC

VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES

7+coax

Sinthesi model
N. 1
Module with camera and door unit

Ref. 1745/81

7+coax
The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with
module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.
or

7+coax

K-Steel model
N. 1
Module with camera and door unit

7+coax

Ref. 1755/81

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

9+coax
or

725 model
N. 1
Panel with 1 button
N. 1
Amplified door unit
N. 1
Camera
N. 1
Front plate

8+coax

Ref. 725/101
Ref. 1128/500
Ref. 725/600
Ref. 725/601

For the panels references and the accessories refer to Panels


with anodized Aluminium front plate Mod. 725 section of
Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

12+coax
TC

or

10+coax

1128 model
N. 1
Front case for video door unit
N. 1
Door unit with camera
N. 1
Button
N. X
Blank module

Ref. 1728/20-/21
Ref. 1728/80
Ref. 1128/1-/2
Ref. 1128/30-/31

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

For boards of accessories refer to Wall Mounted Panel


Mod. 1128 section of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system
product technical manual.
POWER SUPPLY REFERENCES
N. 1
N. 1
N. 1
N. 1

8 sec.1d

Video power supply


Power supply (2)
Video distributor
Power supply (1)

Ref. 789/5B
Ref. 789/3
Ref. 1794/4A
Ref. 789/2

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SV102-2066D

CA
R2
R1
RT

1
2
6
9
10
X1
X2
Y1
Y2
R3

V4
V5
V3

R1
R2 in
R1
R2 out
RL

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF 4 VIDEO DOOR PHONES TO 1 VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION


The video outdoor station calls the 4 video door phones
in parallel with concurrent power-on

CA

(VX.007)

R2
R1
RT

1
2
6
9
10
X1
X2
Y1
Y2
R3

~
LINE~

V4
V5
V3

~
ADDITIONAL POWER
SUPPLY UNIT (2)

(VX.025)
(VX.008)

CA

R1
R2 in
R1
R2 out
RL

R2
R1
RT

1
2
6
9
10
X1
X2
Y1
Y2
R3

~
LINE~

V4
V5
V3

ADDITIONAL POWER
SUPPLY UNIT (1)
(VX.008)

CA
RT
R1
R2

1
2
6
9
10
X1
X2
Y1
Y2
R3

V4
V5
V3

U2 U1
R2
R1
E
VIDEO
POWER SUPPLY
(VX.008)

(C4.007)
(C4.008)

~
LINE~
~
PS
AP
~0
-6
+6
SE3
1/~

+TC
R1
R2
R2
R1
~12
+R
SE1
SE2

(C4.006)

U1
G/T
L
1A
2
+
1

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0

Name tag
lighting

TC

Lock Release
V5
V3
+TC
R1

~0
~12

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR

(VD.002)

ELECTRIC LOCK

DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)
C4.006
Sinthesi models only:
Connect jumper L with G/T
VX.003

VX.008

VX.023

VX.025

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1d 9

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONES


TO 1 OUTDOOR STATION EQUIPPED WITH A SEPARATE CCD TV CAMERA
Possibility of automatic connection by the video door phones to the TV camera

FUNCTION
This system allows connection between the video outdoor station and
the various video door phones situated in the apartments.
When the visitor presses a button on the push button panel, the
bitonal electronic call is sent to the corresponding video door phone
loudspeaker and, after about 7 seconds, the image appears on the
screen.
At this point the user sees the visitor and can answer, if he wishes,
unhooking the handset. At the end of the conversation, the electric lock
can be operated by pressing the key
.
Vision of the image lasts about 60 seconds, after which the intervention
of the built-in timer in the power supply causes it to go off. If a second
video door phone is called before the end of the 60 seconds, the first
video door phone will automatically go off and the latter comes on.
This feature guarantees secrecy of vision.
Press button
on the video door phone to switch on the camera also
without having received a call.

Utopia model
N. X
Video door phones direct vision
N. X
Bracket
OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES
Sinthesi model
N. X
Button modules
N. 1
Module with door unit set-up
N. 1
Amplified door unit

Ref. 1145/11-/12-/13-/14
Ref. 1145/20-/21-/22
Ref. 1145/500

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.
or
K-Steel model
N. X
Button modules
N. 1
Module with door unit

Ref. 1703/1
Ref. 1704/90

Ref. 1155/11-/12A-/13A-/14A
Ref. 1155/20-/21-/22A

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

7+(n-1)+coax
or

725 model
N. 1
Panels with N buttons
N. 1
Amplified door unit

Mod. 725
Ref. 1128/500

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Panels with anodized aluminium front plate
Mod. 725 section of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system
- product technical manual.

7+n+coax

or

1128 model
N. 1
Front case for door unit
N. 1
Door unit
N. X
Front case
N. X
Button

Ref. 1128/20-/21
Ref. 1128/500
Ref. 1128/10-/11
Ref. 1128/1-/2

2+coax
For boards of accessories refer to Wall Mounted Panel
Mod. 1128 section of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system
product technical manual.

EQUIPMENT

POWER SUPPLY REFERENCES

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SV102-3118C:
VIDEO DOOR PHONE REFERENCES

N. 1
N. 1
N. 1

Video power supply


Relay box
Video distributor

Ref. 789/5B
Ref. 788/52
Ref. 1794/4A

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

BLACK/WHITE
Atlantico model
N. X
Video door phones
N. X
Bracket

DIAGRAM NOTES
Ref. 1702/1
Ref. 1202/90

C4.006
Sinthesi models only:
Connect jumper L with G/T

or
Artico model
N. X
Video door phones
N. X
Bracket

Ref. 1705/1
Ref. 1705/90

COLOUR
Atlantico model
N. X
Video door phones
N. X
Bracket

(see section 1)

C4.007
VX.003
VX.010
VX.012

C4.008
VX.008
VX.011
VX.014

Ref. 1702/40
Ref. 1202/90

or

10 sec.1d

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SV102-3118C

TO THE FOLLOWING VIDEO DOOR PHONES

(VX.010)
(VX.011)

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONES


TO 1 OUTDOOR STATION EQUIPPED WITH A SEPARATE CCD TV CAMERA
Possibility of automatic connection by the video door phones to the TV camera

VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR

(VX.012)

RELAY
BOX

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0
G/T

U4
U3
U2
U1
(C4.007)
(C4.008)
LINE ~

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0

U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T

Name tag
lighting

(C4.006)
L
1A
2
+
1
Lock Release
ELECTRIC LOCK

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

VIDEO
POWER SUPPLY
(VX.008)
Coax
(R1)
(+TC)

Name tag
lighting

SEE DIAGRAM
SV102-3229
pag.51

MAIN ~
(VX.014)
LIGHT BULB
TRANSFORMER

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1d 11

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF 1 VIDEO DOOR PHONE TO 1 VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION


Possibility of automatic activation of a second control tv camera

FUNCTION

TC

This system is particularly suitable in one-family villas. The video door


phone, besides being connected to a TV camera unit, can self-insert
on a secondary control TV camera by pressing the service button .
An internal closed TV circuit system is thus made, which allows the
control of a room (i.e. childrens room) and the outside entrance at any
time.
The secondary TV camera is turned on for about a minute, after which
it automatically turns off. In any case, a call from the video outdoor
station automatically switches the video door phone to the external TV
camera unit thus excluding the second TV camera; in order to reset the
latter, it is sufficient to press the service key
when the conversation
with the video outdoor station is over.
With the other service key
it is possible to self-insert also on the
video outdoor station.

VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES


BLACK/WHITE
Sinthesi model
N. 1
Module with camera and door unit

Ref. 1745/81

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.
or
K-Steel model
N. 1
Module with camera and door unit

Ref. 1755/81

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

9+coax

or
TC

2+coax

12+coax

725 model
N. 1
Panel with 1 button
N. 1
Amplified door unit
N. 1
Camera
N. 1
Front plate

Ref. 725/101
Ref. 1128/500
Ref. 725/600
Ref. 725/601

For the panels references and the accessories refer to Panels


with anodized Aluminium front plate Mod. 725 section of
Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

2
or

1128 model
N. 1
Front case for video door unit
N. 1
Door unit with camera
N. 1
Button
N. X
Blank module

Ref. 1728/20-/21
Ref. 1728/80
Ref. 1128/1-/2
Ref. 1128/30-/31

EQUIPMENT
For boards of accessories refer to Wall Mounted Panel
Mod. 1128 section of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system
product technical manual.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SV102-3119A:
VIDEO DOOR PHONE REFERENCES

COLOUR

BLACK/WHITE
Atlantico model
N. 1
Video door phones
N. 1
Bracket

Sinthesi model
N. 1
Module with camera and door unit
Ref. 1702/1
Ref. 1202/90

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.

or

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

Artico model
N. X
Video door phones
N. X
Bracket

Ref. 1705/1
Ref. 1705/90

COLOUR
Atlantico model
N. 1
Video door phones
N. 1
Bracket

or
K-Steel model
N. 1
Module with camera and door unit
N. 1
Module with door unit

Ref. 1703/1
Ref. 1704/90

Utopia free-hands model


N. 1
Video door phones direct vision
N. 1
Bracket

12 sec.1d

POWER SUPPLY REFERENCES


N. 1
N. 1

or

Ref. 1755/40
Ref. 1155/21

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

Ref. 1702/40
Ref. 1202/90

or
Utopia model
N. 1
Video door phones direct vision
N. 1
Bracket

Ref. 1745/41

Video power supply


Relay

Ref. 789/5B
Ref. 788/51

Ref. 1703/2
Ref. 1704/91

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SV102-3119A

CA
V4
V5
V3

1
2
6
9
10
X1
X2
Y1
Y2
R3

R1
R2

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF 1 VIDEO DOOR PHONE TO 1 VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION


Possibility of automatic activation of a second control tv camera

Name tag
lighting

14
15

SN1
SN2

U1
G/T

~0
~12

TC

(C4.006)
4
5
6

C1
9
C2

PS
+R

L
1
1A
2
+

AP
-6
+6
R2
R1
Coax
(R1)
(+TC)

SEE DIAGRAM
SV102-3229
pag.51

12

10

RELAY

7
13

11
~12
~0
8

Lock Release
R1
+TC
V5
V3

~12
~0

R1
+TC
~12
~0
SE1
SE2

(VD.002)

SE3
1/~
R2

VIDEO
POWER SUPPLY
(VX.008)

ELECTRIC LOCK

~
LINE ~
~

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

Name tag
lighting

~12
~0
~
(VX.014)
~
TRANSFORMER
MAIN ~

DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)
C4.006
Sinthesi models only:
Connect jumper L with G/T
VX.003

VX.008

VX.014

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1d 13

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONES


TO 2 VIDEO OUTDOOR STATIONS

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

This system allows the connection of a column of video door phones


to 2 video outdoor stations with automatic switching.
When a visitor presses a call button on one of the two push button
panels, in the called apartment the bitonal electronic call is sent to the
corresponding video door phone loudspeaker and the image appears
on the screen after about 8 seconds.
During this phase, the relay box automatically inserts the relative
loudspeaking unit and TV camera, excluding the other video outdoor
station from the service.
At this point, the user sees the visitor and may respond, if desired,
lifting the handset. At the end of the call, only the electric lock of the
entrance concerned is activated pressing the key
.
If, during a conversation, a call is made from the other push button
panel towards another video door phone, the first will automatically
switch off and the last video door phone called will be activated. It
is not possible therefore to communicate with the 2 video outdoor
stations at the same time in that they operate alternatively and are
mutually exclusive.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SV102-2892D:
VIDEO DOOR PHONE REFERENCES
Atlantico model
N. X
Video door phones
N. X
Bracket
or
Artico model
N. X
Video door phones
N. X
Bracket

Ref. 1705/1
Ref. 1705/90
TC

VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES


Sinthesi model
N. X
Button modules
N. 2
Module with camera and door unit

7+coax

Ref. 1702/1
Ref. 1202/90

Ref. 1145/11-/12-/13-/14
Ref. 1745/80-/81-/82

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.

6+coax+(n-2)
or

K-Steel model
N. X
Button modules
Ref. 1155/11-/12A-/13A-/14A
N. 2
Module with camera and door unit
Ref. 1755/80

7+coax

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

6+coax+(n-1)
or

7+coax

725 model
N. 2
Panel with N buttons
N. 2
Amplified door unit
N. 2
Camera
N. 2
Front plate

6+coax+(n)
TC

Mod. 725
Ref. 1128/500
Ref. 725/600
Ref. 725/601-/602

TC

11+n+
coax
2

For the panels references and the accessories refer to Panels


with anodized Aluminium front plate Mod. 725 section of
Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

11+n+
coax

or

1128 model
N. 2
Front case for video door unit
N. 2
Door unit with camera
N. X
Front case
N. X
Button

Ref. 1728/20-/21
Ref. 1728/80
Ref. 1128/10-/11
Ref. 1128/1-/2

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

For boards of accessories refer to Wall Mounted Panel


Mod. 1128 section of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system
product technical manual.
POWER SUPPLY REFERENCES
N. 1
N. 1
N. 1

14 sec.1d

Video power supply


Relay box
Video distributor

Ref. 789/5B
Ref. 788/51
Ref. 1794/4A

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SV102-2892D

TO THE FOLLOWING VIDEO DOOR PHONES


(VX.011)
(VX.010)
CA
R1
R2

1
2
6
9
10
X1
X2
Y1
Y2
R3

V4
V5
V3

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONES


TO 2 VIDEO OUTDOOR STATIONS

CA
R1
R2

1
2
6
9
10
X1
X2
Y1
Y2
R3

V4
V5
V3

CA
R1
R2

1
2
6
9
10
X1
X2
Y1
Y2
R3

V4
V5
V3

Name tag
lighting
U1
U2

~0
~12

VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR

R2
R1 E

~
(VX.014)

MAIN~

~
LINE~

VIDEO
POWER SUPPLY

R1 R2 AP - + SE R1 ~ ~
12 0
6 6 1

SE +
2 TC

LIGHT BULB
TRANSFORMER

PS

(VX.008)

TO THE FOLLOWING
MODULE

TC

(C4.006)
(C4.007)
(C4.008)
(C4.016)

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12
G/T

U4
U3
U2
U1

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12

U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T

11
8

14
5

C1

~0
~12

C2

SN2

(C4.007)
(C4.008)
(C4.016)

SN1

TO THE FOLLOWING
MODULE

U4
U3
U2
U1

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12
G/T

U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12

TC

(C4.006)

(VD.002)

~0
~12

R1
+TC
V5
V3

6
15

4
13

12

10

R1
+TC
V5
V3

Lock Release

ELECTRIC LOCK

L
1A
2
+
1

Name tag
lighting

~0
~12

(VD.002)

Lock Release

ELECTRIC LOCK

DIAGRAM NOTES
RELAY
BOX

(see section 1)
C4.006
Sinthesi models only:
Connect jumper L with G/T
C4.007
VX.003

C4.008
VX.008

C4.016
VX.010

VD.002
VX.011

VX.014

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1d 15

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

L
1A
2
+
1

Name tag
lighting

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONE GROUPS TO 1 VIDEO DOOR UNIT


AND 1 DOOR UNIT

FUNCTION
This type of system is used to connect a video door phone column to
an automatically switching video door unit or door unit.
A two-tone electronic call is sent to the corresponding video door
phone speaker when a call button is pressed on either of the two
panels; the picture appears on the screen after approximately seven
seconds if the call was made by the video door unit.
The video door phone will not light up and the video door phone will
work as a normal door phone if the call is made from thcamera unit and
panel.
Press
at the end of the call to open the concerned door electrical
lock only.

7+coax

K-Steel model
N. X
Button modules
Ref. 1155/11-/12A-/13A-/14A
N. 1
Module with camera and door unit
Ref. 1755/80
The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with
module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.
or
725 model
N. 1
Panel with N buttons
N. 1
Amplified door unit
N. 1
Camera
N. 1
Front plate

For the panels references and the accessories refer to Panels


with anodized Aluminium front plate Mod. 725 section of
Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

6+coax+(n-2)
or

7+coax

1128 model
N. 1
Front case for video door unit
N. 1
Door unit with camera
N. X
Front case
N. X
Button

6+coax+(n-1)
7+coax

Ref. 1728/20-/21
Ref. 1728/80
Ref. 1128/10-/11
Ref. 1128/1-/2

For boards of accessories refer to Wall Mounted Panel


Mod. 1128 section of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system
product technical manual.

6+coax+(n)

TC

Mod. 725
Ref. 1128/500
Ref. 725/600
Ref. 725/601-/602

OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES

9+n

11+n+
coax

Sinthesi model
N. X
Button modules
N. 1
Module with door unit set-up
N. 1
Amplified door unit

Ref. 1145/11-/12-/13-/14
Ref. 1145/20-/21-/22
Ref. 1145/500

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.
or

EQUIPMENT
The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SV102-2934C:

K-Steel model
N. X
Button modules
N. 1
Module with door unit

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

VIDEO DOOR PHONE REFERENCES


Atlantico model
N. X
Video door phones
N. X
Bracket

Ref. 1702/1
Ref. 1202/90

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

or
Artico model
N. X
Video door phones
N. X
Bracket

Ref. 1705/1
Ref. 1705/90

or
725 model
N. 1
Panels with N buttons
N. 1
Amplified door unit

VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES


or
Ref. 1145/11-/12-/13-/14
Ref. 1745/80-/81-/82

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.
or

16 sec.1d

Mod. 725
Ref. 1128/500

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Panels with anodized aluminium front plate
Mod. 725 section of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system
- product technical manual.

TC

Sinthesi model
N. X
Button modules
N. 1
Module with camera and door unit

Ref. 1155/11-/12A-/13A-/14A
Ref. 1155/20-/21-/22A

1128 model
N. 1
Front case for door unit
N. 1
Door unit
N. X
Front case
N. X
Button

Ref. 1128/20-/21
Ref. 1128/500
Ref. 1128/10-/11
Ref. 1128/1-/2

For boards of accessories refer to Wall Mounted Panel


Mod. 1128 section of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system
product technical manual.
DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SV102-2934C

TO THE FOLLOWING VIDEO DOOR PHONES


(VX.011)
(VX.010)
CA
R1
R2

V4
V5
V3

1
2
6
9
10
X1
X2
Y1
Y2
R3

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONE GROUPS TO 1 VIDEO DOOR UNIT


AND 1 DOOR UNIT

CA
R1
R2

V4
V5
V3

1
2
6
9
10
X1
X2
Y1
Y2
R3

CA
R1
R2

V4
V5
V3

1
2
6
9
10
X1
X2
Y1
Y2
R3

U1
U2

VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR

R2
R1 E

Name tag
lighting

~0
~12

LINE ~

~
MAIN~
~
R1

R1

AP 6

+ ~ ~ SE + SE
6 12 0 2 TC 1

R2 PS

(VX.014)
LIGHT BULB
TRANSFORMER

11
8
~0
~12
1
3

VIDEO
POWER SUPPLY
(VX.008)
(C4.007)
(C4.008)
(C4.016)

TC

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12
G/T

U4
U3
U2
U1

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12

U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T

SN2

14
5
2
C1

TO THE FOLLOWING
MODULE
(C4.007)
(C4.008)
(C4.016)

C2

SN1

(C4.006)

(VD.002)

~0
~12

R1
V5
V3
+TC

6
15

4
13

12

10

Lock Release
ELECTRIC LOCK

Video power supply


Relay box
Video distributor

U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12

L
1A
2
+
1

Name tag
lighting

RELAY
BOX
Lock Release

POWER SUPPLY REFERENCES


N. 1
N. 1
N. 1

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12
G/T

(C4.006)

L
1A
2
+
1

Name tag
lighting

U4
U3
U2
U1

ELECTRIC LOCK

DIAGRAM NOTES
Ref. 789/5B
Ref. 788/51
Ref. 1794/4A

(see section 1)
C4.006
Sinthesi models only:
Connect jumper L with G/T
C4.007
VX.014

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

C4.008

C4.016

VD.002

VX.008

VX.010

VX.011

sec.1d 17

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

TO THE FOLLOWING
MODULE

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONES


TO 4 VIDEO OUTDOOR STATIONS

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

This system allows the connection of a column of video door phones


to 4 video outdoor stations with automatic switching. Therefore, it is
suitable for a building with 4 entrances common to all apartments.
When a visitor presses a call button on one of the two push button
panels, in the called apartment the bitonal electronic call is sent to the
corresponding video door phone loudspeaker and the image appears
on the screen after about 7 seconds. During this phase, the relay box
automatically inserts the relative loudspeaking unit and TV camera,
excluding the other video outdoor station from the service. At this
point, the user sees the visitor and may respond, if desired, lifting the
handset. At the end of the call, only the electric lock of the entrance
concerned is activated pressing the key
. If, during a conversation,
a call is made from the other push button panel towards another video
door phone, the first will automatically switch off and the last video
door phone called will be activated. In this system it is not possible
to speak simultaneously from the four outdoor stations because they
work one at a time in automatic switching.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SV102-3078B:
VIDEO DOOR PHONE REFERENCES
Atlantico model
N. X
Video door phones
N. X
Bracket
or
Artico model
N. X
Video door phones
N. X
Bracket

Ref. 1705/1
Ref. 1705/90
TC

VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES


Sinthesi model
N. X
Button modules
N. 4
Module with camera and door unit

7+coax

Ref. 1702/1
Ref. 1202/90

Ref. 1145/11-/12-/13-/14
Ref. 1745/80-/81-/82

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.

6+coax+(n-2)
7+coax
or

6+coax+(n-1)

K-Steel model
N. X
Button modules
Ref. 1155/11-/12A-/13A-/14A
N. 4
Module with camera and door unit
Ref. 1755/80

7+coax

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

6+coax+(n)

TC

TC

or

11+n+
coax

725 model
N. 4
Panel with N buttons
N. 4
Amplified door unit
N. 4
Camera
N. 4
Front plate

11+n+
coax

TC

Mod. 725
Ref. 1128/500
Ref. 725/600
Ref. 725/601-/602

For the panels references and the accessories refer to Panels


with anodized Aluminium front plate Mod. 725 section of
Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

TC

or

11+n+
coax

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

1128 model
N. 4
Front case for video door unit
N. 4
Door unit with camera
N. X
Front case
N. X
Button

11+n+
coax

Ref. 1728/20-/21
Ref. 1728/80
Ref. 1128/10-/11
Ref. 1128/1-/2

2
For boards of accessories refer to Wall Mounted Panel
Mod. 1128 section of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system
product technical manual.
POWER SUPPLY REFERENCES
N. 1
N. 1

18 sec.1d

Video power supply


Relay box

Ref. 789/5B
Ref. 788/54

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SV102-3078B

TO THE FOLLOWING VIDEO DOOR PHONES


(VX.011)
(VX.010)
CA
R1
R2

1
2
6
9
10
X1
X2
Y1
Y2
R3

V4
V5
V3

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONES


TO 4 VIDEO OUTDOOR STATIONS

CA
R1
R2

1
2
6
9
10
X1
X2
Y1
Y2
R3

V4
V5
V3

CA
R1
R2

1
2
6
9
10
X1
X2
Y1
Y2
R3

V4
V5
V3

RELAY
BOX
TO THE FOLLOWING
MODULE

R1 R2

V5 V3

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12
G/T

U4
U3
U2
U1

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12

U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T

(C4.016)
(C4.008)
(C4.007)

SN2

SN3

(C4.006)
L
1A
2
+
1

Name tag
lighting

~0
~12

(VD.002)

INPUT B

ELECTRIC LOCK

V5
V3
R1
+TC

V5
V3
R1
+TC

~12
~0
SE

~12
~0
SE

~0
~12

(VD.002)

ELECTRIC LOCK
Lock Release
TO THE FOLLOWING
MODULE

U4
U3
U2
U1

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12

U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T

SN1

SN4

(C4.006)
L
1A
2
+
1
V5
V3
R1
+TC

ELECTRIC LOCK

U4
U3
U2
U1

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12
G/T

U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12

L
1A
2
+
1

1
2
-6
+6

INPUT D

V5
V3
R1
+TC

V5
V3
R1
+TC

~12
~0
SE

~12
~0
SE

VOLTAGE

Lock Release

Name tag
lighting

V5
V3
R1
+TC

~0
~12

ELECTRIC LOCK

Name tag
lighting

LINE~

(VD.002)

Lock Release

~A AP ~B ~12 -6 SE +6 +TC R1 R2 -6I -6U C1 C2 C3 C4

TC

(C4.006)
1
2
-6
+6

INPUT A
(VD.002)

Name tag
lighting

(C4.016)
(C4.007)
(C4.008)

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12
G/T

~0
~12

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12

V5
V3
R1
+TC

TO THE FOLLOWING
MODULE
(C4.016)
(C4.008)
(C4.007)

Name tag
lighting

U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T

TC

L
1A
2
+
1

INPUT C

Lock Release

TC

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12
G/T

(C4.006)
1
2
-6
+6

1
2
-6
+6

V5
V3
R1
+TC

U4
U3
U2
U1

~0
~12
~0 AP ~12 SE1 -6 SE2 +6 +TC R1 R2

PS

VIDEO
POWER SUPPLY

LIGHT BULB
TRANSFORMER

~
(VX.014)

LINE~

(VX.008)

DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)
C4.006
Sinthesi models only:
Connect jumper L with G/T
C4.007
VX.003

C4.008
VX.008

C4.016
VX.010

VD.002
VX.011

VX.014

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1d 19

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

TC

TO THE FOLLOWING
MODULE

9621

COLUMN

(C4.016)
(C4.008)
(C4.007)

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONE COLUMNS


TO A MAIN VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION
Each column is connected to 1 proper secondary video outdoor station

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

This system is particularly suitable for residential properties where it is


necessary to connect the single villas to a proper video outdoor station
and to a common one located at the main entry.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SV102-3079A:
VIDEO DOOR PHONE REFERENCES

During calling the video door phone is automatically switched on the


main video outdoor station or to the secondary one of its own group, by
means of the switching relay. The services for secondary video outdoor
stations are independent, so that they be realized simultaneously.
When the call is coming from the main video outdoor station, only the
group of the called video door phone is switched on it, the other ones
continue to service towards the secondary.

Atlantico model
N. X
Video door phones
N. X
Bracket

Ref. 1702/1
Ref. 1202/90

or
Artico model
N. X
Video door phones
N. X
Bracket

Ref. 1705/1
Ref. 1705/90
TC

7+
coax

VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES

7+
coax
7+ 6+coax+(n-1)
coax
6+coax+(n-1)

Sinthesi model
N. X
Button modules
N. K+1 Module with camera and door unit

Ref. 1145/11-/12-/13-/14
Ref. 1745/80-/81-/82

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.

7+
coax

6+coax+(n)
or

6+coax+(n)

TC

K-Steel model
N. X
Button modules
Ref. 1155/11-/12A-/13A-/14A
N. K+1 Module with camera and door unit
Ref. 1755/80
The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with
module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

TC

or

8+n+
coax

8+n+
coax
2

10+coax+
K(n+1) 2

725 model
N. K+1 Panel with N buttons
N. K+1 Amplified door unit
N. K+1 Camera
N. K+1 Front plate

Mod. 725
Ref. 1128/500
Ref. 725/600
Ref. 725/601-/602

For the panels references and the accessories refer to Panels


with anodized Aluminium front plate Mod. 725 section of
Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

TC

or

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

K= quantity of columns

1128 model
N. K+1 Front case for video door unit
N. K+1 Door unit with camera
N. X
Front case
N. X
Button

Ref. 1728/20-/21
Ref. 1728/80
Ref. 1128/10-/11
Ref. 1128/1-/2

For boards of accessories refer to Wall Mounted Panel


Mod. 1128 section of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system
product technical manual.
POWER SUPPLY REFERENCES
N. K+1 Video power supply
N. K+1 Relay box
>1
Video distributor

20 sec.1d

Ref. 789/5B
Ref. 788/51
Ref. 1794/4A

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SV102-3079A
1st COLUMN

2nd COLUMN

(VX.010)
(VX.011)

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONE COLUMNS


TO A MAIN VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION
Each column is connected to 1 proper secondary video outdoor station

CA
R2
R1

1
2
6
9
10
X1
X2
Y1
Y2
R3

V4
V5
V3

CA
R2
R1

1
2
6
9
10
X1
X2
Y1
Y2
R3

V4
V5
V3

CONNECTION AS 1ST GROUP

RELAY
BOX
14

(C4.017)
(C4.008)
(C4.007)
8

11

TO THE FOLLOWING
MODULE

52

SN1

SN2

U4
U3
U2
U1

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12
G/T

U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12

TC

TC

(C4.006)
1
4

L
1A
2
+
1

3
6

7
13
C1

V5
V3
+TC
R1

12

10

Name tag
lighting

~0
~12

(VD.002)

~ ~
15 9 C2 0 12
Lock Release
ELECTRIC LOCK

SN1
LINE ~

1
4
-6
7

Coax
VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR

G/T
U4
U3
U2
U1

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12

U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T

~12
~0
~0
~12
G/T

G/T
U4
U3
U2
U1

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12

U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T

~12
~0
~0
~12
G/T

G/T
U4
U3
U2
U1

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12

U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T

U1 U2
R1 U3
R2 U4

Coax

U5
E

Calls

Name tag
lighting

(VD.002)

SN1

L
1A
2
+
1

~0
~12

1
4
-6
7

Common

V5
V3
+TC
R1

R1
13
C1

Lock Release
Name tag
lighting

ELECTRIC LOCK
LINE ~
~0
~12
VIDEO
POWER SUPPLY
(VX.002) (VX.008)

~ SE R1 + + - AP R1R2PS ~ SE
12 2
TC 6 6
0 1

LIGHT BULB
TRANSFORMER

~
(VX.014)

LINE~

DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)
C4.006
Sinthesi models only:
Connect jumper L with G/T
C4.007
VX.001

C4.008
VX.002

C4.017
VX.003

VD.002
VX.008

VX.014

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1d 21

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

TC

R1
13
C1

~
- + + R1SE
R2 AP PS ~
0 12 SE
1 6 6 TC
2

VIDEO
POWER SUPPLY
(VX.008)

(C4.017)
(C4.008)
(C4.007)

~12
~0
~0
~12
G/T

R1

TO THE FOLLOWING COLUMN

TO THE FOLLOWING
MODULE

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONE COLUMNS


TO 1 MAIN VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION
Each columns is also connected to its own
secondary outdoor station

FUNCTION
This system is particularly suitable for residential properties where it is
necessary to connect the single villas to an own video outdoor station
and to a common one located at the main entry.
During calling the interested video door phone is automatically swItched
on the main video outdoor station or to the secondary one of its own
group, by means of the switching relay. The services for secondary
outdoor stations are independent, so that they can be realized
simultaneously. When the call is coming from the main video outdoor
station, only the group of the called video door phone is switched on it,
the other ones continue to service the secondary.
7+
coax

7+
coax

K-Steel model
N. X
Button modules
Ref. 1155/11-/12A-/13A-/14A
N. 1
Module with camera and door unit
Ref. 1755/80
The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with
module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.
or
725 model
N. 1
Panel with N buttons
N. 1
Amplified door unit
N. 1
Camera
N. 1
Front plate

For the panels references and the accessories refer to Panels


with anodized Aluminium front plate Mod. 725 section of
Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

6+n+coax

6+n+coax

7+
coax

7+
coax

Mod. 725
Ref. 1128/500
Ref. 725/600
Ref. 725/601-/602

or
6+n+coax

6+n+coax

8+n+
coax

9+n

1128 model
N. 1
Front case for video door unit
N. 1
Door unit with camera
N. X
Front case
N. X
Button

For boards of accessories refer to Wall Mounted Panel


Mod. 1128 section of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system
product technical manual.

9+n

8+n+coax

8+n+coax

OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES

10+coax+
K(n+1)

Sinthesi model
N. X
Button modules
N. K+1 Module with door unit set-up
N. K+1 Amplified door unit

2
TC

K= number of columns

EQUIPMENT
The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SV102-2935E:

or
K-Steel model
N. X
Button modules
N. K+1 Module with door unit

Atlantico model
N. X
Video door phones
N. X
Bracket

Ref. 1702/1
Ref. 1202/90

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

or
725 model
N. K+1 Panels with N buttons
N. K+1 Amplified door unit

or
Artico model
N. X
Video door phones
N. X
Bracket

Ref. 1705/1
Ref. 1705/90

Mod. 725
Ref. 1128/500

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Panels with anodized aluminium front plate
Mod. 725 section of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system
- product technical manual.

TC

VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES


or
Ref. 1145/11-/12-/13-/14
Ref. 1745/80-/81-/82

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.

22 sec.1d

Ref. 1155/11-/12A-/13A-/14A
Ref. 1155/20-/21-/22A

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

VIDEO DOOR PHONE REFERENCES

or

Ref. 1145/11-/12-/13-/14
Ref. 1145/20-/21-/22
Ref. 1145/500

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.

Sinthesi model
N. X
Button modules
N. 1
Module with camera and door unit

Ref. 1728/20-/21
Ref. 1728/80
Ref. 1128/10-/11
Ref. 1128/1-/2

1128 model
N. K+1 Front case for door unit
N. K+1 Door unit
N. X
Front case
N. X
Button

Ref. 1128/20-/21
Ref. 1128/500
Ref. 1128/10-/11
Ref. 1128/1-/2

For boards of accessories refer to Wall Mounted Panel


Mod. 1128 section of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system
product technical manual.
DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SV102-2935E
1st COLUMN

2nd COLUMN

CA
R2
R1

1
2
6
9
10
X1
X2
Y1
Y2
R3

V4
V5
V3

AS USER

AS USER

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONE COLUMNS


TO 1 MAIN VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION
Each columns is also connected to its own
secondary outdoor station

U5 U4 U3
R2
R1
E U1 U2

VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR
(VX.001)

CA
R2
R1

1
2
6
9
10
X1
X2
Y1
Y2
R3

V4
V5
V3

USER

A
CONNECTION AS 1ST

GROUP

TO THE FOLLOWING
MODULE

RELAY
BOX
14

(C4.017)
(C4.008)
(C4.007)

52

SN1

SN2

U4
U3
U2
U1

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12
G/T

U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12

(C4.006)
1
4

L
1A
2
+
1

3
6

Name tag
lighting

Lock
Release
13
C1
11
12

10
15
9
~
C2 0

ELECTRIC LOCK

~
12

SN1

LINE ~

1
4
-6
7
~
TO THE FOLLOWING
MODULE

~12
~0
~0
~12
G/T

TC

PS ~ - ~ +
0 6 12 6

~
12 S1 2 S3

R1
13
C1
Coax

POWER SUPPLY
FOR DOOR
PHONE SYSTEM
(VX.008)

(C4.017)
(C4.008)
(C4.007)

CALL
REPEATER
RELAY

VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR
(VX.001)

G/T
U4
U3
U2
U1

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12

U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T

~12
~0
~0
~12
G/T

G/T
U4
U3
U2
U1

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12

U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T

~12
~0
~0
~12
G/T

G/T
U4
U3
U2
U1

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12

U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T

U1

U2
U3

Coax

R1
R2

U4

Coax

U5
E

Coax

TO THE
FOLLOWING
COLUMN
Calls

~0
~12

1
4
-6
7
Common

V5
V3
+TC
R1

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

Name tag
lighting

(VD.002)

SN1

L
1A
2
+
1

R1
13
C1

Lock
Release
Name tag
lighting

ELECTRIC LOCK
LINE ~
POWER SUPPLY
FOR VIDEO DOOR
PHONE SYSTEM
(VX.002) (VX.008)

~0
~12
~

~ SE R1 + + - AP R1R2PS ~ SE
12 2
TC 6 6
0 1

LIGHT BULB
TRANSFORMER

~
(VX.014)

LINE~

DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)
POWER SUPPLY REFERENCES
N. 1
N. K
N. K
N. K
>1

Video power supply


Door phone power supply
Relay box
Call repeater relay
Video distributor

Ref. 789/5B
Ref. 786/11
Ref. 788/51
Ref. 788/52
Ref. 1794/4A

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

C4.006
Sinthesi models only:
Connect jumper L with G/T
C4.007
VX.002

C4.008
VX.008

VD.002
VX.014

VX.001
VX.034

sec.1d 23

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF 3 INTERCOM VIDEO DOOR PHONES WITH POSSIBILITY OF


ANSWERING CALLS FROM 1 ELECTRICAL VIDEO DOOR UNIT
Single call from outside with concurrent power-on

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

This system is particularly suited for detached houses where the video
door phones provide the intercom service and can also be called at the
same time in parallel by the video outdoor station. Switching from one
service to another is automatic and is assured during the call phase by
a relay device.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SV102-2970D:

When the intercom service is activated, listening to the conversation


from the loudspeaking unit of the video outdoor station is excluded.
If a call is made from the video outdoor station during an intercom
conversation, all the video door phones are automatically switched to
the outside.
Extra buzzers are used for intercom calls; for external calls from
the video outdoor station, the two-tone electronic call is sent to the
loudspeaker of the handset of the video door phone concerned.
The
and
service keys are used for intercom calls.
When the video door phones are called in parallel by the video outdoor
station, they switch on at the same time. At the end of the conversation,
the electric lock is released pressing the key
.
Viewing lasts approximately 60 seconds, after which it is interrupted
automatically following tripping of the timer incorporate in the power
supply.

VIDEO DOOR PHONE REFERENCES


Atlantico model
N. 3
Video door phones
N. 3
Bracket

Ref. 1702/1
Ref. 1202/90

or
Artico model
N. 3
Video door phones
N. 3
Bracket

Ref. 1705/1
Ref. 1705/90
TC

VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES


Sinthesi model
N. 1
Module with camera and door unit

Ref. 1745/81

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.
or

12+coax

K-Steel model
N. 1
Module with camera and door unit

Ref. 1755/81

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

12+coax
or

12+coax

725 model
N. 1
Panel with 1 button
N. 1
Amplified door unit
N. 1
Camera
N. 1
Front plate

Ref. 725/101
Ref. 1128/500
Ref. 725/600
Ref. 725/601

12+coax
For the panels references and the accessories refer to Panels
with anodized Aluminium front plate Mod. 725 section of
Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

12+2coax
or

1128 model
N. 1
Front case for video door unit
N. 1
Door unit with camera
N. 1
Button
N. X
Blank module

For boards of accessories refer to Wall Mounted Panel


Mod. 1128 section of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system
product technical manual.

10+coax

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

Ref. 1728/20-/21
Ref. 1728/80
Ref. 1128/1-/2
Ref. 1128/30-/31

TC

POWER SUPPLY REFERENCES

24 sec.1d

N. 1
N. 1
N. 1
N. 1
N. 3
N. 1
N. 1

Video power supply


Power supply
Impedance generator
Video distributor
Extra Buzzer
Kit of 10 diodes
Relay box

Ref. 789/5B
Ref. 789/3
Ref. 789/51
Ref. 1794/4A
Ref. 9854/52
Ref. 1131/4
Ref. 788/51

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SV102-2970D

R2
R1
RT

Alt

CA

Mic

1
2
6

R
75

10
9
X1
X2
Y1
Y2
R3

V4
V5
V3

-/~
BUZZER +/~

(C4.014)
(VX.006)
(VX.021)

(VX.007)

R2
R1
RT

R2 R1 R2
in out
~ ~

47
3W

Alt

CA

Mic

2
6

R
75

10
9
X1
X2
Y1
Y2
R3

V4
V5
V3

LINE ~

(VX.008)

-/~
BUZZER +/~

(C4.014)
(VX.006)
(VX.021)

POWER
SUPPLY

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF 3 INTERCOM VIDEO DOOR PHONES WITH POSSIBILITY OF


ANSWERING CALLS FROM 1 ELECTRICAL VIDEO DOOR UNIT
Single call from outside with concurrent power-on

RT
R1
R2

47
3W

Alt

CA

Mic

2
6
10
9
X1
X2
Y1
Y2
R3

V4
V5
V3

VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR

(C4.014)
(VX.006)
(VX.021)

-/~
BUZZER +/~
47
3W

U2 U1
R2
R1

(VX.008)
LINE~

R1

TC

IMPEDANCE
GENERATOR
R2

~
AP

R1

+
6

SE +
2 R

SE ~ ~ + 1
1 12 0 6 PS TC /~

R2

POWER
SUPPLY

~ ~ 2 C1 11
C2 12
0
15
9
7
8

(VD.002)

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0

U1
G/T
L
1A
2
+
1

SN1
4
13
3

V5
V3
+TC
R1

~0
~12

SN2

(C4.006)

1
14
5

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

Name tag
lighting

10
Lock Release

12

RELAY
BOX

ELECTRIC LOCK

DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)
C4.014

VX.003

VX.006

VX.007

VX.008

VX.021
Cut or remove the jumpers on the device(s): 6 10.
DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1d 25

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF MAXIMUM 9 INTERCOM Atlantico VIDEO DOOR PHONES WITH


POSSIBILITY OF ANSWERING CALLS FROM 1 ELECTRICAL VIDEO DOOR UNIT
Single call from the outside with concurrent power-on

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

This system is particularly suited for detached houses where the video
door phones provide the intercom service and can also be called at the
same time in parallel by the video outdoor station.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SV102-2972D:
VIDEO DOOR PHONE REFERENCES

Switching from one service to another is automatic and is assured


during the call phase by a relay device.
When the intercom service is activate, listening to the conversation
from the loudspeaking unit of the video outdoor station is excluded.
If a call is made from the video outdoor station during an intercom
conversation, all the video door phones are automatically switched to
the outside.
Extra buzzers are used for external calls from the video outdoor
station; for intercom calls, the two-tone electronic call is sent to the
loudspeaker of the handset of the video door phone concerned.
When the video door phones are called in parallel by the video outdoor
station, they switch on at the same time. At the end of the conversation,
the electric lock is released pressing the key
.
Viewing lasts approximately 60 seconds, after which it is interrupted
automatically following tripping of the timer incorporate in the power
supply.

Atlantico model
N. 9
Video door phone
N. 9
Bracket with 8 Button add-on

Ref. 1702/1
Ref. 1702/86
TC

VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES


Sinthesi model
N. 1
Module with camera and door unit

Ref. 1745/81

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.
or
K-Steel model
N. 1
Module with camera and door unit

"9"

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

19+coax
19+coax
"8"
23+coax

Ref. 1755/81

or
725 model
N. 1
Panel with 1 button
N. 1
Amplified door unit
N. 1
Camera
N. 1
Front plate

Ref. 725/101
Ref. 1128/500
Ref. 725/600
Ref. 725/601

19+coax
For the panels references and the accessories refer to Panels
with anodized Aluminium front plate Mod. 725 section of
Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

"3"
25+coax
or

"2"

19+coax

25+coax

1128 model
N. 1
Front case for video door unit
N. 1
Door unit with camera
N. 1
Button
N. X
Blank module

20+coax

Ref. 1728/20-/21
Ref. 1728/80
Ref. 1128/1-/2
Ref. 1128/30-/31

For boards of accessories refer to Wall Mounted Panel


Mod. 1128 section of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system
product technical manual.

"1"
19+coax

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

VARIOUS

12+coax
TC

N. 1
N. 1
N. 2
N. 1
N. 1
N. 1
N. 1
N. 9
N. 1

Video power supply


Power supply (2)
Power supply (1)
Impedance generator
Relay box
Call repeater relay
Video distributor
Extra Buzzer
Kit of 10 diodes

Ref. 789/5B
Ref. 789/2
Ref. 789/3
Ref. 789/51
Ref. 788/51
Ref. 788/52
Ref. 1794/4A
Ref. 9854/52
Ref. 1131/4

DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)
C4.014

26 sec.1d

VD.002

VX.001

VX.003

VX.006

VX.007

VX.008

VX.021
Cut or remove the jumpers on the device(s): 6 10.
DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SV102-2972D

POWER
SUPPLY (2)

CA
R2
R1
RD

1
2
6

R2 R1 R2
in
out
~ ~

R
75

LINE~
(VX.008)

10
9
X1
X2
Y1
Y2
R3

V4
V5
V3

(C4.014)
(VX.006)
(VX.021)

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF MAXIMUM 9 INTERCOM Atlantico VIDEO DOOR PHONES WITH


POSSIBILITY OF ANSWERING CALLS FROM 1 ELECTRICAL VIDEO DOOR UNIT
Single call from the outside with concurrent power-on

G/T2
T6
T5
T4
T3
T2
T1
G/T
-/~
+/~

POWER
SUPPLY
(1)
(VX.007)

CA
R2
R1
RD

2
6

R2 R1 R2
in
out
~ ~

R
75

LINE~
(VX.008)

10
9
X1
X2
Y1
Y2
R3

V4
V5
V3

(C4.014)
(VX.006)
(VX.021)

G/T2
T6
T5
T4
T3
T2
T1
G/T
-/~
+/~

TO THE
VIDEO R1 RD
DOOR PHONES
6 - 7

TO THE
VIDEO
DOOR PHONES
4 - 5
R1 RD
CA

(VX.007)

R2
R1
RD

1
2
6

R2 R1 R2
in
out
~ ~

10
9
X1
X2
Y1
Y2
R3

V4
V5
V3

LINE~
(VX.008)

POWER
SUPPLY
(1)

(C4.014)
(VX.006)
(VX.021)

G/T2
T6
T5
T4
T3
T2
T1
G/T
-/~
+/~

CA
RD
R1
R2

2
6
R
75

10
9
X1
X2
Y1
Y2
R3

V4
V5
V3

(C4.014)
(VX.006)
(VX.021)

G/T2
T6
T5
T4
T3
T2
T1
G/T
-/~
+/~

CA
RD
R1
R2

1
2
6

(C4.014)
(VX.006)
(VX.021)

G/T2
T6
T5
T4
T3
T2
T1
G/T

VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR
U5 U4 U3 U2 U1
R1
R2

-/~
+/~
47
3W

(VX.008)
LINE~

R1
R1

Name tag
lighting

TC

SE
2

+ + 1
6 TC /~

CALL
REPEATER
RELAY
S3
2
12~
S1

~ ~ 2 15 11
C2 C1 12
0
6
7
8

U1
G/T

SN1

L
1
+
2
1A
V5
V3
R1
+TC

SE ~ ~ PS 1 12 0 6

AP

(C4.006)

~12
~0
~0
~12

~0
~12

(VD.002)

R2
~

IMPEDANCE
GENERATOR

POWER
SUPPLY

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

(VX.001)

10
9
X1
X2
Y1
Y2
R3

V4
V5
V3

SN2
1
14
5

3
13
4
Lock
Release
10

RELAY
BOX

ELECTRIC
LOCK

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1d 27

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF 3 INTERCOM Atlantico VIDEO DOOR PHONES WITH


POSSIBILITY OF ANSWERING CALLS FROM 2 ELECTRICAL VIDEO DOOR UNITS
The video outdoor stations call the video door phones in parallel with concurrent
power-on

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

The 3 video door phones perform the intercom service and can be
called at the same time in parallel by one of the two video outdoor
stations.
Switching to the three services is automatic and is assured during the
call phase by a relay device.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SV102-3257A:

When the intercom service is activated, listening to the conversation


from the loudspeaking units of the video outdoor stations is excluded.
If a call is made from the one of the two video outdoor stations during
an intercom conversation, all the video door phones are automatically
switched to the entrance from which the call has been sent.
Therefore, concurrent communication with the 2 video outdoor stations
is not possible in that either one or the other of these operates
alternatively, in mutual exclusion.
Extra buzzers are used for the intercom calls while for those of the
video outdoor stations, the two-tone electronic call is sent to the
loudspeaker of the handset of the video door phone concerned.
When the video door phones are called in parallel by the one of the two
video outdoor stations, they switch on at the same time. At the end of
the conversation, only the electric lock of the entrance concerned is
released pressing the key
.
Viewing lasts approximately 60 seconds, after which it is interrupted
automatically following tripping of the timer incorporate in the power
supply.

VIDEO DOOR PHONE REFERENCES


Atlantico model
N. 3
Video door phones
N. 3
Bracket

Ref. 1702/1
Ref. 1202/90
TC

VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES


Sinthesi model
N. 2
Module with camera and door unit

Ref. 1745/81

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.
or
K-Steel model
N. 2
Module with camera and door unit

Ref. 1755/81

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.
or

11+coax
725 model
N. 2
Panel with 1 button
N. 2
Amplified door unit
N. 2
Camera
N. 2
Front plate

11+coax

Ref. 725/101
Ref. 1128/500
Ref. 725/600
Ref. 725/601

11+coax
For the panels references and the accessories refer to Panels
with anodized Aluminium front plate Mod. 725 section of
Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

12+coax

13+coax

or
1128 model
N. 2
Front case for video door unit
N. 2
Door unit with camera
N. 2
Button
N. X
Blank module (*)

Ref. 1728/20-/21
Ref. 1728/80
Ref. 1128/1-/2
Ref. 1128/30-/31

(*) for small button installation only

12+coax

12+coax

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

TC

For boards of accessories refer to Wall Mounted Panel


Mod. 1128 section of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system
product technical manual.

TC

POWER SUPPLY REFERENCES

28 sec.1d

N. 1
N. 1
N. 1
N. 1
N. 1
N. 1
N. 3
N. 1

Video power supply


Supplementary power supply
Impedance generator
Relay box (1)
Relay box (2)
Video distributor
Extra Buzzer
Kit of 10 diodes

Ref. 789/5B
Ref. 789/2
Ref. 789/51
Ref. 788/54
Ref. 788/52
Ref. 1794/4A
Ref. 9854/52
Ref. 1131/4

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

LINE ~

R1
R2out
R2in
R1
RL
0

R1
RD

SV102-3257A

CA
1
2
6

R
75

230

V4
V5
V3
SUPPLEMENTARY
POWER SUPPLY
(VX.008)

10
9
X1
X2
Y1
Y2
R3

(C4.014)
(VX.006)
(VX.021)

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF 3 INTERCOM Atlantico VIDEO DOOR PHONES WITH


POSSIBILITY OF ANSWERING CALLS FROM 2 ELECTRICAL VIDEO DOOR UNITS
The video outdoor stations call the video door phones in parallel with concurrent
power-on

BUZZER -/~
+/~
47
3W
R1
RD

CA
1
2
6

R
75
V4
V5
V3

10
9
X1
X2
Y1
Y2
R3

(C4.014)
(VX.006)
(VX.021)

BUZZER -/~
+/~
47
3W
RD
R1
R2

V4
V5
V3

CA
1
2
6
10
9
X1
X2
Y1
Y2
R3

(C4.014)
(VX.006)
(VX.021)

BUZZER -/~
+/~
47
3W

U2 U1
R1
R2

R1 R2

Name tag
lighting

VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR

9621

V5 V3

COLUMN
(C4.016)
G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0

TC

U1
G/T
L
1A
2
+
1

SN2

1
2
-6
+6

ELECTRIC
LOCK

(VD.002)

1
2
-6
+6

INPUT B

V5
V3
R1
+TC

~0
~12

SN3

(C4.006)

INPUT C

V5
V3
R1
+TC

V5
V3
R1
+TC

~0
~12
SE

~0
~12
SE

Lock Release
RELAY
BOX(1)

Name tag
lighting

(C4.016)

TC

U1
G/T
L
1A
2
+
1

SN4

1
2
-6
+6

1
2
-6
+6

INPUT A

V5
V3
R1
+TC

~0
~12

(VD.002)

SN1
(C4.006)

ELECTRIC
LOCK

INPUT D

V5
V3
R1
+TC

~0
~12
SE

~0
~12
SE

V5
V3
R1
+TC

VOLTAGE

Lock Release
I
N
H

G
N
D

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0

~0 ~A AP ~B ~12 -6 SE +6 +TC R1 C1 C2 C3 C4 R2 -6I -6U

DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)
(VX.008)
LINE~

C4.014
VD.002

C4.016
VX.003

VX.006

C4.006
Sinthesi models only:
Connect jumper L with G/T

~0 AP ~12 SE1 -6 SE2 +6 +TC R1 PS R2

VX.008

VIDEO
POWER SUPPLY

S1 S2 15 14

RELAY
BOX(2)

-6 -J

IMPEDANCE
GENERATOR

VX.021
Cut or remove the jumpers on the device(s): 6 10.
DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1d 29

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

SV102-1469D: CONNECTION OF A CALL REPEATER RELAY IN PARALLEL


TO THE VIDEO DOOR PHONE
SV102-1574C: CONNECTION IN PARALLEL OF 1 VIDEO DOOR PHONE AND 1 DOOR PHONE

SV102-1469D

RISING COLUMN

CA
R1
R2

V4
V5
V3

2
6
10
9
X1
X2
Y1
Y2
R3

CHIME
12V~

Ref.788/52
RELE'

S1
S3

CA
6
~12
~0

LINE~

R1 R2 COAX

TRANSFORMER
Ref.9000/230

~ ~
12 0

~
9621

calls

(VX.008)

SV102-1574C
RISING
COLUMN

CA
R1
R2

V4
V5
V3

2
6
10
9
X1
X2
Y1
Y2
R3

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

CA
1
2
6
10
9

R1 R2 COAX

30 sec.1d

9 6 2 1 calls
DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SV102-0782D

POWER SUPPLY
Ref.789/2

CA
R1
RT

V4
V5
V3

2
6
10
9
X1
X2
Y1
Y2
R3

R2 R1 R2
in
out
~

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF A CALL REPEATER RELAY IN PARALLEL


TO THE VIDEO DOOR PHONE

LINE ~

RT
R1
R2

CA

V4
V5
V3

1
2
6
10
9
X1
X2
Y1
Y2
R3

Calls
1
2
6
9
COAX

FROM
RISING
COLUMN

COAX

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

R2
R1

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1d 31

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF 3 VIDEO DOOR PHONE EXTENSIONS IN PARALLEL TO A


SYSTEM WITH VIDEO DOOR UNIT
The video door phones are called at the same time

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

The system is particularly suitable to be installed in buildings where


three video door phones belonging to a more complex system with
video door phone unit must be called and switched on at the same time
by one only call button.
Since the video power unit cannot power more than one video door
phone, a supplementary local power unit is needed to power video
door phones 2 and 3.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SV102-2132E:
VIDEO DOOR PHONE REFERENCES
Atlantico model
N. 4
Video door phones
N. 4
Bracket

Ref. 1702/1
Ref. 1202/90

or
Artico model
N. 4
Video door phones
N. 4
Bracket

7+coax

POWER SUPPLY REFERENCES


N. 1
N. 1
N. 1
N. 1

7+coax
7+2coax

Ref. 1705/1
Ref. 1705/90

Supplementary power supply


Video distributor
Door phone power supply
Relay

Ref. 789/3
Ref. 1794/4A
Ref. 786/11
Ref. 788/52

DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)
VX.001

VX.007

VX.008

8+2coax
10+2coax

7+2coax

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

FROM RISING
COLUMN

32 sec.1d

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SV102-2132E
R2
R1
RT

V4
V5
V3

SUPPLEMENTARY
POWER SUPPLY

R2
R1
RT

R2 R1 R2
in
out
~

V4
V5
V3

LINE~

RT
R1
R2

V4
V5
V3

CA
1
2
6
10
9
X1
X2
Y1
Y2
R3

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF 3 VIDEO DOOR PHONE EXTENSIONS IN PARALLEL TO A


SYSTEM WITH VIDEO DOOR UNIT
The video door phones are called at the same time

CA
1
2
6
10
9
X1
X2
Y1
Y2
R3

CA
1
2
6
10
9
X1
X2
Y1
Y2
R3

calls
1
2
6
9

VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR
U2 U1
R1 U5
R2
E

(VX.001)

COAX

FROM
RISING
COLUMN

COAX

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

R2
R1
S3
RELAY

CA
6
~ ~
0 12 S1

47
3W

(VX.008)
LINE~

~ ~ PS
0 12

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

DOOR PHONE
POWER SUPPLY

sec.1d 33

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF 3 INTERCOM VIDEO DOOR PHONE EXTENSIONS TO A SYSTEM


WITH VIDEO DOOR UNIT
Single call from outside with concurrent power-on

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

This system is particularly suited for detached houses where the video
door phones provide the intercom service and can also be called at the
same time in parallel by the video outdoor station. Switching from one
service to another is automatic and is assured during the call phase by
a relay device.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SV102-1349E:

When the intercom service is activated, listening to the conversation


from the loudspeaking unit of the video outdoor station is excluded.
The external call from the video door phone system is sent to the video
door phone speaker. The intercom call is sent to the buzzers.
The
and
service keys are used for intercom calls.
When the video door phones are called in parallel by the video outdoor
station, they switch on at the same time. At the end of the conversation,
the electric lock is released pressing the key
.
Viewing lasts approximately 60 seconds, after which it is interrupted
automatically following tripping of the timer incorporate in the power
supply.

VIDEO DOOR PHONE REFERENCES


Atlantico model
N. 3
Video door phones
N. 3
Bracket
or
Artico model
N. 3
Video door phones
N. 3
Bracket

Ref. 1705/1
Ref. 1705/90

POWER SUPPLY REFERENCES


N. 1
N. 1
N. 1
N. 3
N. 1
N. 1
N. 1

11+coax

Ref. 1702/1
Ref. 1202/90

Power supply
Supplementary power supply
Video distributor
Extra Buzzer
Kit of 10 diodes
Relay box B
Relay box A

Ref. 786/11
Ref. 789/3
Ref. 1794/4A
Ref. 9854/52
Ref. 1131/4
Ref. 788/52
Ref. 788/51

DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)

11+coax
C4.014

VX.006

VX.007

VX.008

VX.021
Cut or remove the jumpers on the device(s): 6 10.

12+2coax

VX.023

VX.034

12+2coax

12+2coax

7+2coax

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

FROM RISING
COLUMN

34 sec.1d

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SV102-1349E

(VX.006)
(VX.021)
(C4.014)

-/
+/

(VX.006)
(VX.021)
(C4.014)

-/
+/

(VX.006)
(VX.021)
(C4.014)

-/
+/

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF 3 INTERCOM VIDEO DOOR PHONE EXTENSIONS TO A SYSTEM


WITH VIDEO DOOR UNIT
Single call from outside with concurrent power-on

(VX.007)

MAIN~

SUPPLEMENTARY
POWER SUPPLY

RELAY
BOX (A)

VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR

RELAY
BOX (B)

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

FROM
RISING
COLUMN

LINE~

POWER SUPPLY

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1d 35

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF N VIDEO DOOR PHONES TO 1 VIDEO DOOR UNIT


Distance between video door phone and video door unit in the range from 300 to
1000 metres

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

The system allows the connection between the video door phone unit
and the various video door phones located in the apartments also
when the distance between them is higher than 300 m and lower than
1000m.
When the visitor presses a button on the push button panel, the
bitonal electronic call is sent to the corresponding video door phone
loudspeaker and, after about 7 seconds, the image appears on the
screen.
At this point the user sees the visitor and can answer, if he wishes,
unhooking the handset. At the end of the conversation, the electric lock
can be operated by pressing the key (
).
Vision of the image lasts about 60 seconds, after which the intervention
of the built-in timer in the power supply causes it to go off. If a second
video door phone is called before the end of the 60 seconds, the first
video door phone will automatically go off and the latter comes on. This
feature guarantees secrecy of vision.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SV102-1241D:
VIDEO DOOR PHONE REFERENCES
Atlantico model
N. X
Video door phones
N. X
Bracket

Ref. 1702/1
Ref. 1202/90

or
Artico model
N. X
Video door phones
N. X
Bracket

Ref. 1705/1
Ref. 1705/90
TC

VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES

6+(n-2)+coax
Sinthesi model
N. X
Button modules
N. 1
Module with camera and door unit

7+coax

Ref. 1145/11-/12-/13-/14
Ref. 1745/80-/81-/82

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.

6+(n-1)+coax
or

K-Steel model
N. X
Button modules
Ref. 1155/11-/12A-/13A-/14A
N. 1
Module with camera and door unit
Ref. 1755/80

7+coax

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

6+n+coax
or

9+n+coax
>300m
<1000m

725 model
N. 1
Panel with N buttons
N. 1
Amplified door unit
N. 1
Camera
N. 1
Front plate

Mod. 725
Ref. 1128/500
Ref. 725/600
Ref. 725/601-/602

For the panels references and the accessories refer to Panels


with anodized Aluminium front plate Mod. 725 section of
Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

TC

or

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

1128 model
N. 1
Front case for video door unit
N. 1
Door unit with camera
N. X
Front case
N. X
Button

Ref. 1728/20-/21
Ref. 1728/80
Ref. 1128/10-/11
Ref. 1128/1-/2

For boards of accessories refer to Wall Mounted Panel


Mod. 1128 section of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system
product technical manual.
POWER SUPPLY REFERENCES
N. 1
N. X
N. 1

36 sec.1d

Video power supply


Supplementary power supply
Video amplifier

Ref. 789/5B
Ref. 789/2
Ref. 1090/729

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

TO THE FOLLOWING
VIDEO DOOR PHONES

SV102-1241D

LINE~

(VX.010)
(VX.011)

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF N VIDEO DOOR PHONES TO 1 VIDEO DOOR UNIT


Distance between video door phone and video door unit in the range from 300 to
1000 metres

0
230
R1
R2out
R1
R2in
RL

R1
R2

LINE~

SUPPLEMENTARY
POWER SUPPLY
(VX.008)

CA
1
2
6
9
10
X1
X2
Y1
Y2
R3

V4
V5
V3

0
230
CA

R1
R2

SUPPLEMENTARY
POWER SUPPLY
(VX.008)

1
2
6
9
10
X1
X2
Y1
Y2
R3

V4
V5
V3

TO THE FOLLOWING
MODULES

VIDEO
POWER SUPPLY
(VX.008)
0
230

(C4.007)
(C4.008)
U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T

LINE~
(VX.008)

PS
1/~
+R
AP
~0
-6
+6
R2
R2
R1
R1
+TC

OUT

(C4.006)

Lock
Release

L
1A
2
+
1

TC
Name tag
lighting

R1
+TC
V3
V5

IN

VIDEO AMPLIFIER

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

R1
R2out
R1
R2in
RL

~0
~12

~12

ELECTRIC
LOCK

SE1
SE2

(VD.002)

LINE~
(VX.008)

DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)
C4.006
Sinthesi models only:
Connect jumper L with G/T
DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

C4.007
VD.002

C4.008
VX.008

VX.010

VX.011

VX.016

sec.1d 37

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL COLOURS VIDEO DOOR PHONES


TO 1 VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

This system allows connection between the video outdoor station and
the various video door phones situated in the apartments. When the
visitor presses a button on the push button panel, the bitonal electronic
call is sent to the corresponding video door phone loudspeaker and,
after about 7 seconds, the image appears on the screen.
At this point the user sees the visitor and can answer, if he wishes,
unhooking the handset. At the end of the conversation, the electric lock
can be operated by pressing the key (
).
Vision of the image lasts about 60 seconds, after which the intervention
of the built-in timer in the power supply causes it to go off. If a second
video door phone is called before the end of the 60 seconds, the first
video door phone will automatically go off and the latter comes on. This
feature guarantees secrecy of vision.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SV102-3063A:
VIDEO DOOR PHONE REFERENCES
Atlantico model
N. X
Video door phones
N. X
Bracket

Ref. 1702/40
Ref. 1202/90

or
Utopia model
N. X
Video door phones direct vision
N. X
Bracket

Ref. 1703/1
Ref. 1703/90
TC

6+(n-2)+coax
VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES

7+coax

Sinthesi model
N. 1
Module camera
N. 1
Module with door unit
N. 1
Amplified door unit
N. X
Button modules

6+(n-1)+coax

Ref. 1745/40
Ref. 1145/20-/21-/22
Ref. 5150/500
Ref. 1145/11-/12-/13-/14

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.

7+coax
or

K-Steel model
N. 1
Module camera
N. 1
Module with door unit
N. X
Button modules

6+n+coax

Ref. 1755/40
Ref. 1155/20-/21-/22A
Ref. 1155/11-/12A-/13A-/14A

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

TC

9+n+coax
POWER SUPPLY REFERENCES

N. 1
N. 1

Video power supply


Video distributor

Ref. 789/5B
Ref. 1794/4A

DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)
C4.006
Sinthesi models only:
Connect jumper L with G/T
C4.008
VX.010

VD.002
VX.011

VX.003

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

C4.007
VX.008

38 sec.1d

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SV102-3063A
TO THE FOLLOWING
VIDEO DOOR PHONES

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL COLOURS VIDEO DOOR PHONES


TO 1 VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION

(VX.010)
(VX.011)
CA
1
2
6
9
10
X1
X2
Y1
Y2
R3

R2
R1

V4
V5
V3

CA
1
2
6
9
10
X1
X2
Y1
Y2
R3

R2
R1

V4
V5
V3

VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR
TO THE FOLLOWING
MODULES

U1
U2
R2
R1
E

U4
U3
U2
U1
U2
U1
G/T

PS
(C4.006)
AP
~0
-6
+6
1/~
~12
+R
SE1

V5
V3
+TC
R1

TC

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0
Name tag
lighting

Lock Release

+TC
R1
R1
R2
R2
SE2

(C4.007)
(C4.008)
~0
~12

(VD.002)

ELECTRIC
LOCK
(VX.008)
LINE~

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

VIDEO
POWER
SUPPLY

L
1A
2
+
1

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0
G/T

sec.1d 39

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONES TO 1 DOOR UNIT


Door open indicator on video door phones

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

The system provides an open door monitoring service, in addition to


providing a connection between the video door unit and the various
colour video door phone in the apartments following a call.
An indicator LED lights up on all video door phones when the entrance
door is open.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SV102-3228A:
VIDEO DOOR PHONE REFERENCES
EXAMPLE A
Utopia model
N. 1
Video door phones direct vision
N. 1
Bracket

Ref. 1703/1
Ref. 1704/90

or

10+coax
"B"

EXAMPLE B
Atlantico model
N. 1
Video door phones
N. 1
Bracket

Ref. 1702/40
Ref. 1702/86

Utopia free-hands model


N. 1
Video door phones direct vision
N. 1
Bracket

Ref. 1703/2
Ref. 1703/91
TC

10+coax

VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES

"A"
Sinthesi model
N. 1
Module camera
N. 1
Module with door unit
N. 1
Amplified door unit
N. X
Button modules

8+n+coax
(NOTE *)
10+coax

Ref. 1745/40
Ref. 1145/20-/21-/22
Ref. 5150/500
Ref. 1145/11-/12-/13-/14

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.
or
K-Steel model
N. 1
Module camera
N. 1
Module with door unit
N. X
Button modules

8+n+coax
(NOTE *)

Ref. 1755/40
Ref. 1155/20-/21-/22A
Ref. 1155/11-/12A-/13A-/14A

TC

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

13+n+coax

POWER SUPPLY REFERENCES


N. 1
N. 1
N. 1

Video power supply


Supplementary power supply
Relay box

Ref. 789/5B
Ref. 1090/850
Ref. 788/52

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)
C4.006
Sinthesi models only:
Connect jumper L with G/T
C4.007
VX.003
VX.011

C4.008
VX.006
VX.012

VD.002
VX.008
VX.014

VX.010
VX.015

NOTE *: add 1 optional conductor for the video door phone


autoinsertion (with the Utopia free-hands video door phone is
possible also the fonic autoinsertion).

40 sec.1d

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SV102-3228
TO THE FOLLOWING VIDEO DOOR PHONES
(VX.011)

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONES TO 1 DOOR UNIT


Door open indicator on video door phones

CA
R1
R2

1
2
6
9
10
X1
X2
Y1
Y2
R3

V4
V5
V3

"B"

R
AP
+
T6
//
//
T1
G/T

(VX.006)

CA
R1
R2

1
2
6
9
10
AP
+
X1
X2
Y1
Y2
R3

V4
V5
V3

"A"

CA
R1
R2

1
2
6
9
10
AP
+
X1
X2
Y1
Y2
R3

V4
V5
V3

(VX.012)
NOTE *

RELAY
BOX
NOTE *
14
15

S1
S2

POWER SUPPLY

(C4.007) (C4.008)

230
LINE ~

U4
U3
U2
U1

0
(VX.008)
(VX.015)

P2

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0
G/T

P1
+12
GND
U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T

NOTA *

1/~
R2
PS
~12
+R
SE1
AP
~0
-6
+6

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0

Name tag
lighting

(C4.006)

TC
L
1A
2
+
1

(VX.010)

R1
+TC
V3
V5

R2
R1
SE3
SE2

VIDEO
POWER SUPPLY
(VX.008)

~12
~0

ELECTRIC
LOCK

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

Lock Release
R1
+TC

(VD.002)

DOOR OPEN
NORMALLY OPEN CONTACT

LINE~
~

Name tag
lighting

~12
~0
~
(VX.014)
~
LIGHT BULB
TRANSFORMER

LINE~

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1d 41

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF N FREE-HANDS UTOPIA COLOUR VIDEO DOOR PHONES TO 1


VIDEO DOOR UNIT AND TO 1 DOOR UNIT

FUNCTION
This type of system is used to connect a video door phone column to
an automatically switching video door unit or door unit.
A two-tone electronic call is sent to the corresponding video door
phone speaker when a call button is pressed on either of the two
panels; the picture appears on the screen after approximately seven
seconds if the call was made by the video door unit.
The video door phone monitor will be blank and will work as a regular
free-hands door phone if the call is received from the door unit.
Press
at the end of the call to open the concerned door electrical
lock only.

K-Steel model
N. 1
Module camera
N. 1
Module with door unit
N. X
Button modules

Ref. 1755/40
Ref. 1155/20-/21-/22A
Ref. 1155/11-/12A-/13A-/14A

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.
OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES
Sinthesi model
N. 1
Button modules
N. 1
Module with door unit set-up
N. 1
Amplified door unit

7+coax

Ref. 1145/11-/12-/13-/14
Ref. 1145/20-/21-/22
Ref. 1145/500

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.

6+coax+(n-2)
or

7+coax

K-Steel model
N. 1
Button modules
N. 1
Module with door unit

Ref. 1155/11-/12A-/13A-/14A
Ref. 1155/20-/21-/22A

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

6+coax+(n-1)
7+coax
or

725 model
N. 1
Panels with N buttons
N. 1
Amplified door unit

6+coax+n
TC

11+n
+coax

Mod. 725
Ref. 1128/500

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Panels with anodized aluminium front plate
Mod. 725 section of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system
- product technical manual.

9+n

or

EQUIPMENT
The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SV102-3227:

1128 model
N. 1
Front case for door unit
N. 1
Door unit
N. X
Front case
N. X
Button

VIDEO DOOR PHONE REFERENCES


Utopia free-hands model
N. 1
Video door phones direct vision
N. 1
Bracket

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

TC

Sinthesi model
N. 1
Module camera
N. 1
Module with door unit
N. 1
Amplified door unit
N. X
Button modules

Ref. 1745/40
Ref. 1145/20-/21-/22
Ref. 1145/500
Ref. 1145/11-/12-/13-/14

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.
or

42 sec.1d

For boards of accessories refer to Wall Mounted Panel


Mod. 1128 section of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system
product technical manual.

Ref. 1703/2
Ref. 1703/91

VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES

Ref. 1128/20-/21
Ref. 1128/500
Ref. 1128/10-/11
Ref. 1128/1-/2

POWER SUPPLY REFERENCES


N. 1
N. 1
N. 1

Video power supply


Relay box
Video distributor

Ref. 789/5B
Ref. 788/51
Ref. 1794/4A

DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)
C4.006
Sinthesi models only:
Connect jumper L with G/T
C4.007
VX.014

C4.008

C4.016

VD.002

VX.008

VX.010

VX.011

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SV102-3227
TO THE FOLLOWING VIDEO DOOR PHONES

(VX.011)

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF N FREE-HANDS UTOPIA COLOUR VIDEO DOOR PHONES TO 1


VIDEO DOOR UNIT AND TO 1 DOOR UNIT

CA
R1
R2

1
2
6
9
10
X1
X2
Y1
Y2
R3

V4
V5
V3

CA
R1
R2

1
2
6
9
10
X1
X2
Y1
Y2
R3

V4
V5
V3

(VX.010)
CA
R1
R2

1
2
6
9
10
X1
X2
Y1
Y2
R3

V4
V5
V3

U1
U2

VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR

R2
R1 E

LINE ~

R1 R2

R2 + R1
R

AP - + ~ ~ SE + SE
6 6 12 0 2 TC 1

1 PS
/
~

VIDEO
POWER SUPPLY
(VX.008)
11
8
~0
~12
1
3

(C4.007) (C4.008)
G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0
G/T

Name tag
lighting

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0

14
5
2
C1

(C4.007) (C4.008)

C2

U4
U3
U2
U1

U4
U3
U2
U1

U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T

SN2

U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T

SN1

(C4.006)

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0
G/T

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0

Name tag
lighting

(C4.006)

TC

~12
~0

R1
V5
V3
+TC

6
15

4
13

12

10

L
1A
2
+
1

(C4.016)

RELAY
BOX

(C4.016)
Lock Release

Lock Release

(VD.002)
9
Name tag
lighting

ELECTRIC
LOCK

7
ELECTRIC
LOCK

~12
~0
~
(VX.014)
~
LIGHT BULB
TRANSFORMER

MAIN ~

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1d 43

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

L
1A
2
+
1

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF N FREE-HANDS COLOUR VIDEO DOOR PHONE COLUMNS TO 1


MAIN VIDEO DOOR UNIT
Each column is additionally connected to a specific secondary door unit

FUNCTION
This system is particularly suitable for residential properties where it is
necessary to connect the single villas to a proper video outdoor station
and to a common one located at the main entry.
During calling the video door phone is automatically switched on the
main video outdoor station or to the secondary one of its own group, by
means of the switching relay. The services for secondary video outdoor
stations are independent, so that they be realized simultaneously.
When the call is coming from the main video outdoor station, only the
group of the called video door phone is switched on it, the other ones
continue to service towards the secondary.
7+
coax

K-Steel model
N. 1
Module camera
N. 1
Module with door unit
N. X
Button modules

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.
OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES
Sinthesi model
N. 1
Button modules
N. 1
Module with door unit set-up
N. 1
Amplified door unit

7+
coax

6+n+coax

6+n+coax

6+n+coax

6+n+coax

or
K-Steel model
N. 1
Button modules
N. 1
Module with door unit

9+n

8+n+coax

Ref. 1155/11-/12A-/13A-/14A
Ref. 1155/20-/21-/22A

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

9+n

8+n+
coax

Ref. 1145/11-/12-/13-/14
Ref. 1145/20-/21-/22
Ref. 1145/500

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.

7+
coax

7+
coax

Ref. 1755/40
Ref. 1155/20-/21-/22A
Ref. 1155/11-/12A-/13A-/14A

8+n+coax
10+coax+
K(n+1)

or

725 model
N. 1
Panels with N buttons
N. 1
Amplified door unit

TC

Mod. 725
Ref. 1128/500

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Panels with anodized aluminium front plate
Mod. 725 section of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system
- product technical manual.

2
K= number of columns

or

EQUIPMENT
The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SV102-3235:

1128 model
N. 1
Front case for door unit
N. 1
Door unit
N. X
Front case
N. X
Button

For boards of accessories refer to Wall Mounted Panel


Mod. 1128 section of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system
product technical manual.

VIDEO DOOR PHONE REFERENCES


Utopia free-hands model
N. 1
Video door phones direct vision
N. 1
Bracket

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

Ref. 1128/20-/21
Ref. 1128/500
Ref. 1128/10-/11
Ref. 1128/1-/2

Ref. 1703/2
Ref. 1703/91

POWER SUPPLY REFERENCES

TC

VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES


Sinthesi model
N. 1
Module camera
N. 1
Module with door unit
N. 1
Amplified door unit
N. X
Button modules

Ref. 1745/40
Ref. 1145/20-/21-/22
Ref. 1145/500
Ref. 1145/11-/12-/13-/14

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.
or

44 sec.1d

N. K+1 Video power supply


N. K
Relay box
N. 1
Video distributor

Ref. 789/5B
Ref. 788/51
Ref. 1794/4A

DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)
C4.006
Sinthesi models only:
Connect jumper L with G/T
C4.007
VX.001

C4.008
VX.002

C4.017
VX.003

VD.002
VX.008

VX.014

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SV102-3235
1st COLUMN

2nd COLUMN

(VX.011)

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF N FREE-HANDS COLOUR VIDEO DOOR PHONE COLUMNS TO 1


MAIN VIDEO DOOR UNIT
Each column is additionally connected to a specific secondary door unit

CA
R1
R2

1
2
6
9
10
X1
X2
Y1
Y2
R3

V4
V5
V3

CA
R1
R2

1
2
6
9
10
X1
X2
Y1
Y2
R3

V4
V5
V3

(VX.010)
RELAY
BOX

(C4.007) (C4.008)

14

52

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0
G/T

U4
U3
U2
U1

SN1

U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T

SN2

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0

CONNECTION AS 1ST

GROUP

Name tag
lighting

(C4.006)
1
4

L
1A
2
+
1

3
6

7
13
C1
~ ~
12 11 10 12 0 C2 9

15

Lock Release

ELECTRIC
LOCK

Name tag
lighting

SN1

(VX.014)
LINE ~

LINE~

4
-6
7

(C4.007)

R1 R2

+TC R1 R2 SE1 ~12 ~0 PS AP -6 +6 SE2

(C4.008)

~0
~12
~12
~0
G/T

U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0

U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T

~0
~12
~12
~0
G/T

U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0

U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T

~0
~12
~12
~0
G/T

U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0

U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T

POWER SUPPLY
FOR DOOR
PHONE SYSTEM
(VX.008)

~ ~
12

R1
13
C1

Coax

LIGHT BULB
TRANSFORMER
VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR

U1
R1
R2

U2
Coax

U3
U4
E

Calls

TC

SN1

1
1A
2
+
L

1
4
-6
7
Common

V5
V3
+TC
R1
~0
~12

R1
13
C1
(VD.002)

Lock
Release

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

Name tag
lighting

TO THE FOLLOWING
COLUMN

Name tag
lighting
(VX.014)

ELECTRIC LOCK

LINE ~
LINE~

~0 SE2 R1 +TC +6 -6 AP R1 R2 PS ~12

VIDEO
POWER SUPPLY
(VX.002) (VX.008)

SE1

~ ~
12

LIGHT BULB
TRANSFORMER

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1d 45

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF 3 INTERCOM UTOPIA VIDEO DOOR PHONES WITH POSSIBILITY


OF ANSWERING CALLS FROM 1 ELECTRICAL VIDEO DOOR UNIT

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

This system is particularly suited for detached houses where the video
door phones provide the intercom service and can also be called at the
same time by the video outdoor station. Switching from one service to
another is automatic and is assured during the call phase by a relay
device.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SV102-3219:

When the intercom service is activated, listening to the conversation


from the loudspeaking unit of the video outdoor station is excluded.
If a call is made from the video outdoor station during an intercom
conversation, all the video door phones are automatically switched to
the outside.
The
and
service keys are used for intercom calls.
When the video door phones are called in parallel by the video outdoor
station, they switch on at the same time. At the end of the conversation,
the electric lock is released pressing the key
.
Viewing lasts approximately 60 seconds, after which it is interrupted
automatically following tripping of the timer incorporate in the power
supply.

VIDEO DOOR PHONE REFERENCES


Utopia model
N. 3
Video door phones
N. 3
Bracket

Ref. 1703/1
Ref. 1703/90
TC

VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES


Sinthesi model
N. 1
Module with camera and door unit
N. 1
Button modules

Ref. 1745/41
Ref. 1145/12

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.
or
K-Steel model
N. 1
Module camera
N. 1
Module with door unit
N. X
Button modules

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

12+coax

12+coax

Ref. 1755/40
Ref. 1155/20
Ref. 1155/13A

POWER SUPPLY REFERENCES


N. 1
N. 1

Video power supply


Door phone power supply with relay

Ref. 789/5B
Ref. 786/15

12+coax
DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)

12+coax

12+2coax

C4.006
Sinthesi models only:
Connect jumper L with G/T
VD.002

VX.003

VX.008

VX.014

VX.031

10+coax

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

TC

46 sec.1d

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SV102-3219
CA
R1
R2
RD

1
2
6
10
9
Y1
Y2
X1
X2
Z1
Z2
R3

V4
V5
V3

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF 3 INTERCOM UTOPIA VIDEO DOOR PHONES WITH POSSIBILITY


OF ANSWERING CALLS FROM 1 ELECTRICAL VIDEO DOOR UNIT

"3"

(VX.031)

CA
R1
R2
RD

1
2
6
10
9
Y1
Y2
X1
X2
Z1
Z2
R3

V4
V5
V3

"2"

(VX.031)

CA
R1
R2
RD

1
2
6
10
9
Y1
Y2
X1
X2
Z1
Z2
R3

V4
V5
V3

"1"

(VX.031)

LINE ~

~0 ~12 SE1 R1

VIDEO
POWER SUPPLY
(VX.008)

R1+TC SE2 ~

AP -6 +6 R2 1 PS
/
~
5
2
7
SN1

Name tag
lighting

C2
~0
8

Name tag
lighting

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0

U1
U2
U3
G/T
L
+
1A
2
1

TC

~0
~12

SN2
1
+

(C4.006)

6
3
C1
~12
PS2

V5
V3
R1
+TC

0
LINE ~
230

Lock Release
(VD.002)

POWER SUPPLY FOR


DOOR PHONE SYSTEM
WITH RELAY
(VX.008)

ELECTRIC
LOCK

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1d 47

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

9
4
PS
-J

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF 2 INTERCOM UTOPIA VIDEO DOOR PHONES WITH POSSIBILITY


OF ANSWERING CALLS FROM 1 ELECTRICAL VIDEO DOOR UNIT
Single call from outside with concurrent power-on

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

This system is particularly suited for detached houses where the video
door phones provide the intercom service and can also be called at the
same time in parallel by the video outdoor station. Switching from one
service to another is automatic and is assured during the call phase by
a relay device.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SV102-3220:

When the intercom service is activated, listening to the conversation


from the loudspeaking unit of the video outdoor station is excluded.
If a call is made from the video outdoor station during an intercom
conversation, all the video door phones are automatically switched to
the outside.
The
and
service keys are used for intercom calls.
When the video door phones are called in parallel by the video outdoor
station, they switch on at the same time. At the end of the conversation,
the electric lock is released pressing the key
.
Viewing lasts approximately 60 seconds, after which it is interrupted
automatically following tripping of the timer incorporate in the power
supply.

VIDEO DOOR PHONE REFERENCES


Utopia model
N. 2
Video door phones
N. 2
Bracket

Ref. 1703/1
Ref. 1703/90
TC

VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES


Sinthesi model
N. 1
Module with camera and door unit

Ref. 1745/41

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.
or
K-Steel model
N. 1
Module with camera

Ref. 1755/41

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

10+coax

POWER SUPPLY REFERENCES


N. 1
N. 1
N. 1

11+coax

Video power supply


Door phone power supply with relay
Kit of 10 diodes

Ref. 789/5B
Ref. 786/15
Ref. 1131/4

DIAGRAM NOTES
8+coax
(see section 1)
C4.006
Sinthesi models only:
Connect jumper L with G/T
C4.014

VD.002

VX.003

VX.008

VX.014

VX.031

12+coax

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

TC

48 sec.1d

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SV102-3220
R3
Z1
Z2
CA

R2
R1
RD

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF 2 INTERCOM UTOPIA VIDEO DOOR PHONES WITH POSSIBILITY


OF ANSWERING CALLS FROM 1 ELECTRICAL VIDEO DOOR UNIT
Single call from outside with concurrent power-on

1
2
6
10
9
Y1
Y2
X1
X2

V4
V5
V3

"2"

(C4.014) (VX.031)

R3
Z1
Z2
CA

RD
R1
R2

1
2
6
10
9
Y1
Y2
X1
X2

V4
V5
V3

"1"

(C4.014) (VX.031)

LINE ~

VIDEO
POWER SUPPLY

~0 ~12 SE1 R1

R1+TC SE2 ~

AP -6 +6 R2 1 PS
/
~

(VX.008)

Name tag
lighting

5
2
7
SN1
C2
~0
8

~0
~12

U1
G/T
L
+
1A
2
1

TC

~0
~12

SN2
1
+

(C4.006)

6
3
C1
~12
PS2

V5
V3
R1
+TC

0
LINE ~

230

Lock Release
POWER SUPPLY FOR
DOOR PHONE SYSTEM
WITH RELAY

(VD.002)

(VX.008)
ELECTRIC
LOCK

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1d 49

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

Name tag
lighting

9
4
PS
-J

50 sec.1d

TC
TC

CONNECTION WITH DISTRIBUTION


TO THE FLOORS

TC

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

Power supply
Ref.789/5B
(Max. 10
distributors)

CONNECTION WITH DISTRIBUTION AT RISER BEGINNING


In each riser the cable goes in and
comes out from each video door phone

SEVERAL RISER

Power supply
Ref.789/5B
(Max. 10
distributors) Video power unit Ref. 789/5B can power up to 10
video distributors Ref. 1794/4A if Atlantico, or Scaitel
video door phones are not connected in parallel. Use
two additional wires in the system and other power
units Ref. 789/2 (one for each next group of 20) to
install more distributors.
With distributor in which the U5 output is used it is
necessary to remove the 75 Ohm resistance
Note: if on the video door phone terminals V4 and
(mounted raised from the PCB) .
V5 there is not the coaxial cable connect the
75 1/4W resistance.

SERIES CONNECTION
The cable goes in and
mes out from each video door phone

ONE RISER

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

EXAMPLES OF COAXIAL CABLE CONNECTION

SV102-3294

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams


TC

Power supply
Ref.789/5B
(Max. 10
distributors)

sec.1d 51

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

Note: if on the video door phone terminals V4 and


V5 there is not the coaxial cable connect the
75 1/4W resistance.

SV102-3295

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

Video power unit Ref. 789/5B can power up to 10


video distributors Ref. 1794/4A if Atlantico, or Scaitel
monitors are not connected in parallel. Use two
additional wires in the system and other power units
Ref. 789/2 (one for each next group of 20) to install
more distributors.
With distributor in which the U5 output is used it is
necessary to remove the 75 Ohm resistance
(mounted raised from the PCB)

IN EACH RISER THE CABLE CONNECTION IS MADE WITH DISTRIBUTION TO THE FLOORS

SEVERAL RISER

EXAMPLES OF COAXIAL CABLE CONNECTION

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

EXAMPLES OF COAXIAL CABLE CONNECTION

SV102-3296A

SEVERAL COLUMNS
I COLUMN

II COLUMN

VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR
Ref.1794/4A

II GROUP
DISTRIBUTOR

II GROUP
DISTRIBUTOR

TO THE FOLLOWING
VIDEO DISTRIBUTOR

MAIN~

I GROUP
DISTRIBUTOR

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

MAIN~

52 sec.1d

TO THE FOLLOWING
VIDEO DISTRIBUTOR

SUPPLEMENTARY
POWER SUPPLY
Ref.789/2

I GROUP
DISTRIBUTOR

TO THE FOLLOWING
VIDEO DISTRIBUTOR

Video power unit Ref. 789/5B can


power up to 10 video distributors
Ref. 1794/4A if Atlantico, or Scaitel
monitors are not connected in
parallel. Use two additional wires in
the system and other power units
Ref. 789/2 (one for each next group
of 20) to install more distributors.
With distributor in which the U5
output is used it is necessary to
remove the 75 Ohm resistance
(mounted raised from the PCB)

TO THE FOLLOWING COLUMNS

VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR
Ref.1794/4A

MAIN~

SUPPLEMENTARY
POWER SUPPLY
Ref.789/2

TO THE FOLLOWING
VIDEO DISTRIBUTOR

SUPPLEMENTARY
POWER SUPPLY
Ref.789/2

MAIN~

SUPPLEMENTARY
POWER SUPPLY
Ref.789/2

VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR
Ref.1794/4A
(VX.001)

TC

VIDEO
POWER SUPPLY
Ref.789/5B

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SV102-3229A

CAMERA
Vision

Ref.

Risolution
(line)

1090/108

380

Power
voltage

12 Vcc
(VX.032)
1090/141

>380

1090/142

>380

B/W

COLOUR

230 Vca

Power supply
adviced
Ref.
1840/44

Example
of
connection
1

1090/850 or
1090/849
1840/44
1090/850 or
1090/849
- -

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

EXAMPLE OF CONNECTION TVCC CAMERE OR MICROCAMERA

1
2
3

1092/001A

420

12 Vcc
(VX.033)

1092/002A
1090/122
1090/215

420
420
380

230 Vca
230 Vca
230 Vca

1840/44
1090/850 or
1090/849
- - - -

1090/241

350

12 Vcc
(VX.032)

1840/44
1090/849

1
2

1090/243

350

230 Vca

- -

2
3
3
3

NOTE: For optics, bracket, custody see the TVCC technical manual.

MICROCAMERA
Use

Ref.

Risolution
(line)

1090/117

>420

1090/185

420

1090/187

>420

1090/189

>420

1090/191

420

1090/194

420

1090/188

300

Power
voltage

Internal
B/W

12Vdc
(VX.032)

External

Internal

12Vdc
(VX.032)

COLOUR
External

1090/198

380

Example 1

Power supply
adviced
Ref.
1840/44
1090/850 or
1090/849
1840/44
1090/850 or
1090/849
1840/44
1090/850 or
1090/849
1840/44

Accessories
Ref.
1090/840
1090/840 only
for 1090/850
1090/840
1090/840 only
for 1090/850
1090/840
1090/840 only
for 1090/850
1090/840

1090/850 or
1090/849
1090/849
1840/44
1090/850 or
1090/849
1840/44
1090/850 or
1090/849
1840/44
1090/849

1090/840 only
for 1090/850
- 1090/840
1090/840 only
for 1090/850
1090/840
1090/840 only
for 1090/850
1090/840
- -

Example
of
connection
1
2
1
2
1
2
1
2
2
1
2
1
2
1
2

Example 2
Coax
R1
+TC

ne
bi/ne

Coax

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

Vision

-+
12

+ - R1 +TC
12

POWER SUPPLY
(VX.008)

VOLTAGE ADAPTER

Line~

Example 3
Coax

Line~

(VX.008)

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1d 53

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS


BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS
54 sec.1d

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

SECTION 1E
(REV.D)

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

5-WIRE ELECTRONIC
VIDEO DOOR PHONE
SYSTEMS

Download from:
www.urmetdomus.com
Technical Manuals area
DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1e 1

DOOR PHONE AND VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEM - DIAGRAM - Section 1E

SECTION 1E CONTENTS
DOOR PHONE AND VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEM - DIAGRAM

Diagram

Sec.

Pag.

BASIC DIAGRAMS FOR 5-WIRE ELECTRONIC DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS


CONNECTION OF 2 VIDEO DOOR PHONES TO 1 VIDEO DOOR UNIT.................................................... SV102-3147B ..............1e ................ 2
CONNECTION OF 1 VIDEO DOOR PHONE TO 1 VIDEO DOOR UNIT ...................................................... SV102-2082C ..............1e ................ 4
CONNECTION OF 2 VIDEO DOOR PHONES TO 1 VIDEO DOOR UNIT.................................................... SV102-2081B ..............1e ................ 5
CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONE TO 1 VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION......................... SV102-2633H .............1e ................ 6
CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONE TO 2 VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION
Automatic switching during calls (Mod. Sinthesi or Mod. K-Steel) ................................................................ SV102-2902G ..............1e ................ 8
CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONE TO 2 VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION
Automatic switching during calls (Mod. 725) ................................................................................................. SV102-2913B ..............1e ............. 10
CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONE TO 4 VIDEO OUTDOOR STATIONS
Automatic switching during calls (Mod. Sinthesi or Mod. K-Steel) ................................................................. SV102-3092D ..............1e ............. 12
CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONE TO 4 VIDEO OUTDOOR STATIONS
Automatic switching during calls (Mod. 725) .................................................................................................. SV102-2806F ..............1e ............. 14
CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONE TO 1 VIDEO DOOR UNIT AND 1 DOOR UNIT
Automatic switching during calls (Mod. Sinthesi o K-Steel)............................................................................ SV102-3121C ..............1e ............. 16
CONNECTION OF SEVERAL SETS OF VIDEO DOOR PHONES
TO 1 MAIN VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION
Each column is also connected to its own secondary video outdoor station
(Mod. Sinthesi or Mod. K-Steel) .................................................................................................................... SV102-3060B ..............1e ............. 18
CONNECTION OF SEVERAL SETS OF VIDEO DOOR PHONES
TO 1 MAIN VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION
Each column is also connected to its own secondary outdoor station
(Mod. Sinthesi or Mod. K-Steel) ..................................................................................................................... SV102-3094D ..............1e ............. 20
CONNECTION OF 4 VIDEO DOOR PHONES TO 1 VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION
(Mod. Sinthesi or Mod. K-Steel)
The video door unit calls the 4 video door phones in parallel with switch-on at the same time ..................... SV102-3166C ............. 1e ............. 22
CONNECTION OF SEVERAL COLOUR VIDEO DOOR PHONES TO 1 VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION
(Mod. Sinthesi) ............................................................................................................................................... SV102-3122E ..............1e ............. 24
CONNECTION OF 1 VIDEO DOOR PHONE AND 1 DOOR PHONE
TO 1 RISING COLUMN. SINGLE CALLS ........................................................................................................ SV102-3239 ..............1e ........... 26
CONNECTION OF ONE DOOR PHONE IN PARALLEL TO 1 VIDEO DOOR PHONE ............................... SV102-1710D ..............1e ........... 26
CONNECTION OF TWO VIDEO DOOR PHONES IN PARALLEL ............................................................... SV102-1712F ..............1e ........... 26
CONNECTION OF A CALL REPEATER RELAY Ref. 788/52 FOR OPERATING ADDITIONAL RINGER... SV102-1470C ..............1e ............. 27
CONNECTION OF A CALL REPEATER RELAY Ref. 788/22 FOR OPERATING ADDITIONAL RINGER......SV102-3240 ..............1e ............. 27
EXAMPLE OF CONNECTION FOR RELEASING DOOR LOCK
DURING A CALL BY THE VIDEO DOOR PHONE ...........................................................................................SV102-3238 ..............1e ............. 27
EXAMPLE OF SIGNAL A, SIGNAL B AND POWER (R1, R2)
DISTRIBUTION ON SEVERAL COLUMNS ................................................................................................... SV102-2978C ..............1e ............. 28

I sec.1e

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

DOOR PHONE AND VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEM - DIAGRAM

5-WIRE VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEM DIAGRAM CROSS-REFERENCE TABLE


LIST OF AVAILABLE FUNCTIONS
Panel model
Number of main video door phone panels to be installed
Number of video door phone secondary panels to be installed
Number of main door phone panels to be installed
Number of secondary door phone panels to be installed
Single calls from panel: each user has its own call button
Calls from panel in parallel: each user has several video door phones in the apartment
Use of devices in parallel with a video door phone
Use of some door phones for audio service only
Colour camera
Possibility of opening door during call
Use of kits
DIAGRAM DESCRIPTION
Smyle

COLLEGAMENTO DI MAX 2 VIDEOCITOFONI AD 1 VIDEOPORTIERE ELETTRICO SV102-3147B

0 0 0

COLLEGAMENTO DI 1 VIDEOCITOFONO AD 1 VIDEOPORTIERE ELETTRICO

SV102-2082C

COLLEGAMENTO DI 2 VIDEOCITOFONI AD 1 VIDEOPORTIERE ELETTRICO

SV102-2081B

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONE TO 1 VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION SV102-2633H

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL COLOUR VIDEO DOOR PHONES


TO 1 VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION

1 0 0 0

Generic

0 0 0

Sinthesi

0 0 0

SV102-3122E

24
22

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL SETS OF VIDEO DOOR PHONES


TO 1 MAIN VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION
Each column is also connected to its own secondary outdoor station

SV102-3094D

20

0 1 0

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONE TO 1 VIDEO DOOR UNIT


AND 1 DOOR UNIT
Automatic switching during calls

SV102-3121C

16

K 1 0

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL SETS OF VIDEO DOOR PHONES


TO 1 MAIN VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION
Each column is also connected to its own secondary video outdoor station

SV102-3060B

18

0 0 0

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONE TO 2 VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION


SV102-2902G
Automatic switching during calls

0 0 0

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONE TO 2 VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION


SV102-2913B
Automatic switching during calls

10

0 0 0

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONE TO 4 VIDEO OUTDOOR STATIONS


SV102-3092D
Automatic switching during calls

12

0 0 0

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONE TO 4 VIDEO OUTDOOR STATIONS


SV102-2806F
Automatic switching during calls

14

CONNECTION OF 1 VIDEO DOOR PHONE AND 1 DOOR PHONE


TO 1 RISING COLUMN. SINGLE CALLS

0 0 0

Sinthesi or
K-Steel

1 0 0 K

Sinthesi or
K-Steel

725

725
Sinthesi or
K-Steel

CONNECTION OF 4 VIDEO DOOR PHONES TO 1 VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION


The video door unit calls the 4 video door phones in parallel with switch-on at the same time SV102-3166C

Sinthesi or
K-Steel

Sinthesi or
K-Steel

PAG

0 0 0

Sinthesi

Sinthesi or
K-Steel

DIAGRAM

SV102-3239

26

SV102-1712F

26

CONNECTION OF ONE DOOR PHONE IN PARALLEL TO 1 VIDEO DOOR PHONE SV102-1710D

26

CONNECTION OF A CALL REPEATER RELAY Ref. 788/52


FOR OPERATING ADDITIONAL RINGER

SV102-1470C

27

CONNECTION OF A CALL REPEATER RELAY Ref. 788/22


FOR OPERATING ADDITIONAL RINGER

SV102-3240

27

EXAMPLE OF CONNECTION FOR RELEASING DOOR LOCK


DURING A CALL BY THE VIDEO DOOR PHONE

SV102-3238

27

CONNECTION OF TWO VIDEO DOOR PHONES IN PARALLEL

K = number of columns with panel

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1e II

DOOR PHONE AND VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEM - DIAGRAM - Section 1E

SECTION 1E CONTENTS

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF 2 VIDEO DOOR PHONES TO 1 VIDEO DOOR UNIT

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

The system can be used to connect the video door unit to various
video door phones fitted in apartments.
When a visitor presses a button on the panel, a two-tone electronic call
signal is sent to the corresponding video door phone speaker and the
image appears on the screen a few seconds later.
At this point, the user can see the visitor and reply by picking up the
handset.
All video door phones are normally deactivated (no sound is heard
when the handset is picked up); only the video door phone called from
the door can start the conversation. No other users can cut into the
call.
The voice circuit of the called video door phone remains activate until
the following call is made from the panel to another device.
The door opening function is connected to conversation privacy; this
means that a user must be called to be able to open the electrical
lock.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SV102-3147B:
5-WIRE VIDEO DOOR PHONE KIT DIAGRAMS
N. 1

N. 1

(*)
5

N. 1
7
6
TC

10

N. 1
2

One-family kit (1 button)


with Atlantico video door phone
Ref. 1702/601
consisting of:
Sinthesi camera with integrated door unit and 1 calling
button Ref. 1745/21
1 Atlantico video door phone Ref. 1702/1 with bracket
Ref. 1202/955
Flush-mounting box for 2 modules Ref. 1145/52
Module holder with frame for 2 modules Ref. 1145/62
Power unit 230Vac-38VA, 10 DIN modules Ref. 789/5B
or
One-family kit (1 button)
with Artico video door phone
Ref. 1705/601
consisting of:
Sinthesi camera with integrated door unit and 1 calling
button Ref. 1745/21
1 Artico video door phoneRef. 1705/1 with bracket
Ref. 1705/955
Flush-mounting box for 2 modules Ref. 1145/52
Module holder with frame for 2 modules Ref. 1145/62
Power unit 230Vac-38VA, 10 DIN modules Ref. 789/5B
or
Two-family kit (2 buttons)
with Atlantico video door phone
Ref. 1702/602
consisting of:
Sinthesi camera with integrated door unit and 2 calling
buttons Ref. 1745/22
2 Atlantico video door phones Ref. 1702/1 with bracket
Ref. 1202/955
Flush-mounting box for 2 modules Ref. 1145/52
Module holder with frame for 2 modules Ref. 1145/62
Power unit 230Vac-38VA, 10 DIN modules Ref. 789/5B
or
Two-family kit (2 buttons)
with Artico video door phone
Ref. 1705/602
consisting of:
Sinthesi camera with integrated door unit and 2 calling
buttons Ref. 1745/22
2 Artico video door phones Ref. 1705/1 with bracket
Ref. 1705/955
Flush-mounting box for 2 modules Ref. 1145/52
Module holder with frame for 2 modules Ref. 1145/62
Power unit 230Vac-38VA, 10 DIN modules Ref. 789/5B

DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)
V5.001
V5.006

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

(*) For two-family kits only

2 sec.1e

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SV102-3147B
(*)
R1

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF 2 VIDEO DOOR PHONES TO 1 VIDEO DOOR UNIT

R2
B
A
CA
(V5.006)

R1
R2
A
B
CA

VIDEO
POWER SUPPLY

TC
C1
C2

CAMERA UNIT
WITH DOOR UNIT
AND 2 BUTTONS

+R
-6
+6

G/T
3
PS
4
5
F
SN
1/~
1/~
~
SE

AP
R1
R2
PS
1/~
~0
~12
SE2

B
A
R1
+TC

R1
+TC
SE1
R2

Lock Release

MAIN~

230

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

ELECTRIC LOCK

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1e 3

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF 1 VIDEO DOOR PHONE TO 1 VIDEO DOOR UNIT

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

The system can be used to connect the video door unit to the video
door phone fitted in the apartment.
When a visitor presses a button on the panel, a two-tone electronic call
signal is sent to the corresponding video door phone speaker and the
image appears on the screen a few seconds later.
At this point, the user can see the visitor and reply by picking up the
handset.
The door opening function is connected to conversation privacy; this
means that a user must be called to be able to open the electrical
lock.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SV102-2082C:
VIDEO DOOR PHONE REFERENCES
N. 1

One-family kit
(1 button)
Ref. 956/31
consisting of:
Smyle panel with camera and 1 button with built-in door
unit.
1 Artico video door phone with bracket
Power unit 110-230Vac 38VA, 7 DIN modules

DIAGRAM NOTES
6
(see section 1)
V5.007
V5.011
TC

SV102-2082C

(V5.011)
R3

POWER SUPPLY

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

MAIN~

TC

Lock
Release
ELECTRIC LOCK

4 sec.1e

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

The system can be used to connect the video door unit to the video
door phone fitted in the apartment.
When a visitor presses a button on the panel, a two-tone electronic call
signal is sent to the corresponding video door phone speaker and the
image appears on the screen a few seconds later.
At this point, the user can see the visitor and reply by picking up the
handset.
The door opening function is connected to conversation privacy; this
means that a user must be called to be able to open the electrical
lock.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SV102-2081B:
VIDEO DOOR PHONE KIT DIAGRAMS
N. 1

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF 2 VIDEO DOOR PHONES TO 1 VIDEO DOOR UNIT

Two-family kit
(2 buttons)
Ref. 956/32
consisting of:
Smyle panel with camera and 2 buttons with built-in door
unit.
2 Artico video door phones with bracket
Power unit 110-230Vac 38VA, 7 DIN modules

DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)
8
V5.007
V5.011

TC

(V5.011)
R3

SV102-2081B

2
(V5.006)
(V5.011)
R3

1
POWER SUPPLY

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

MAIN~

TC

Lock
Release
ELECTRIC LOCK

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1e 5

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONE


TO 1 VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

The 5-wire video door phone system implements conversation privacy,


call and door opener functions in normal door phone systems with only
5 wires in the riser column: 4 commons + 1 single for each device.
The door unit is powered with only two wires and a transformer at
12V~.
The most interesting application of a 5-wire system is in old buildings
where a door phone system is already fitted. The existing system can
be transformed into a video door phone system without adding wires
to the column or in the apartments.
Specific conversation privacy circuits must be fitted in the panel for
ensuring conversation privacy for all video door phones in the system
(one for each button). All video door phones are normally deactivated
(no sound is heard when the handset is picked up); only the video door
phone called from the door can start the conversation. No other users
can cut into the call.
The voice circuit of the called video door phone remains activate until
the following call is made from the panel to another device.
The door opening function is connected to conversation privacy; this
means that a user must be called to be able to open the electrical
lock.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SV102-2633H:

2 x 82 1/4W
5

VIDEO DOOR PHONE REFERENCES


Atlantico model
N. X
Video door phone
N. X
Bracket
or
Artico model
N. X
Video door phone
N. X
Bracket

TC

Sinthesi model
N. 1
Module with camera and door unit
N. X
Button modules
N. X/4 Conversation privacy device

4+n

or
K-Steel model
N. 1
Module camera
N. 1
Module with door unit
N. X
Button modules
N. X/4 Conversation privacy device

VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR

Ref. 1755/30A
Ref. 1155/30-/31-/32A
Ref. 1155/11-/12A-/13A-/14A
Ref. 1145/74

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

5
4+n
or

TC

Ref. 1745/20-/21-/22
Ref. 1145/11-/12-/13-/14
Ref. 1145/74

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.

VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR

Ref. 1705/1
Ref. 1705/955

VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES

Ref. 1702/1
Ref. 1202/955

10+n

725 model
N. 1
Panel with N buttons
N. 1
Amplified door unit
N. 1
Camera
N. 1
Video adapter
N. 1
Front plate
N. X/4 Conversation privacy device

Mod. 725
Ref. 1035/67
Ref. 725/600
Ref. 1742/13A
Ref. 725/601-/602
Ref. 1035/25

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Panels with anodized aluminium front plate
Mod. 725 section of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system
- product technical manual.
POWER SUPPLY REFERENCES
N. 1
N. 1

Video power supply


Video distributor

Ref. 789/5B
Ref. 955/40

DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)
C4.007
V5.001

6 sec.1e

C4.008
VU.002

C4.018
VX.006

CU.009
VX.008

VD.002
VX.014

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SV102-2633H
2 x 82
AB

1/4W

R2R1

Output
R1
R2

R1
R2
III

R1
R2

A
B

A
B
CA

R1
R2

R1
R2

A
B

A
B
CA

R1
R2

R1
R2

A
B

A
B
CA

R1
R2

R1
R2

A
B

A
B
CA

II

A
B

A
B
CA

R1
R2

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONE


TO 1 VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION

VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR

R1
R2

R1
R2

A
B
CA

A
B

IV

Input
AB

R2 R1

AB

R2R1

TO THE FOLLOWING
VIDEO DISTRIBUTOR

Output
R1
R2

R1
R2

A
B
CA

A
B

III

II

VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR

R1
R2

R1
R2

A
B
CA

A
B

IV

Input
To the
following
To the following
conversation
module
privacy device
(C4.007)
(C4.008)
BUTTON MODULE
Name tag
lighting

(VX.006)

TC

To the
following
conversation
privacy
device
(C4.018)

PS
4
3
SN
5
1/~
~
2
(CU.009)

Camera
+
Adapter

41

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12
G/T

U4
U3
U2
U1

C2
C1

C2
C1

~12
~0
PS
3
G/T
F
5
4
SN
1
1/~
~
2

G/T
F
5
4
SN
1/~
1/~
~
SE

A
B
R1
+TC

A
B
R1
+TC
~12
~0

41

(VX.006)

-6
+6
AP
R1
R2
+R

PS

PS
1/~
~0
~12
SE2

(VX.008)

~
LINE~
~
Lock
Release

(VD.002)

ELECTRIC LOCK

Name tag
lighting

~0
~12
~

LINE~

Mod.725

VIDEO
POWER SUPPLY

SE1
R2
R1
+TC

A
B
R1
+TC

K-Steel Sinthesi

(VU.002)

ELECTRIC LOCK

C4
C3
C2
C1

Name tag
lighting

14

P. E.

R2 R1

Mod. K-Steel/Sinthesi

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

(VX.014)

LIGHT BULB
TRANSFORMER

sec.1e 7

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

41

AB

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONE TO 2 VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION


Automatic switching during calls (Mod. Sinthesi or Mod. K-Steel)

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

This system allows the connection of a column of video door phones


to 2 video outdoor stations with automatic switching.
When a visitor presses a call button on one of the two push button
panels, in the called apartment the bitonal electronic call is sent to the
corresponding video door phone loudspeaker and the image appears
on the screen after about 8 seconds.
During this phase, the relay box automatically inserts the relative
loudspeaking unit and TV camera, excluding the other video outdoor
station from the service.
At this point, the user sees the visitor and may respond, if desired,
lifting the handset. At the end of the call, only the electric lock of the
entrance concerned is activated pressing the key
.
If, during a conversation, a call is made from the other push button
panel towards another video door phone, the first will automatically
switch off and the last video door phone called will be activated. It
is not possible therefore to communicate with the 2 video outdoor
stations at the same time in that they operate alternatively and are
mutually exclusive.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SV102-2902G:

Atlantico model
N. X
Video door phone
N. X
Bracket
or
Artico model
N. X
Video door phone
N. X
Bracket

TC

or
K-Steel model
N. 2
Module camera
N. 2
Module with door unit
N. X
Button modules
N. X/4 Conversation privacy device

4+n

Ref. 1755/30A
Ref. 1155/30-/31-/32A
Ref. 1155/11-/12A-/13A-/14A
Ref. 1145/74

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR

Ref. 1745/20-/21-/22
Ref. 1145/11-/12-/13-/14
Ref. 1145/74

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.

VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR

Ref. 1705/1
Ref. 1705/955

VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES

Ref. 1702/1
Ref. 1202/955

Sinthesi model
N. 2
Module with camera and door unit
N. X
Button modules
N. X/4 Conversation privacy device

2 x 82 1/4W
5

VIDEO DOOR PHONE REFERENCES

5
4+n

POWER SUPPLY REFERENCES


N. 1
N. 1
N. 1
N. X
TC

Video power supply


Transformer
Relay box
Video distributor

Ref. 789/5B
Ref. 9000/230
Ref. 788/51
Ref. 955/40

TC

13+n

14+n

DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)
C4.007
VD.002

C4.008
VX.006

C4.016
VX.008

C4.018
VX.014

CU.009

V5.001

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

VX.021
Cut or remove the jumpers on the device(s):
a) PS - G/T
b) 4 - F

8 sec.1e

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SV102-2902G
COLUMN
2 x 82
AB

1/4W

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONE TO 2 VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION


Automatic switching during calls (Mod. Sinthesi or Mod. K-Steel)

R2 R1

Output
R1
R2

R1
R2

III
A
B

A
B
CA

R1
R2

R1
R2

A
B

A
B
CA

R1
R2

R1
R2

A
B

A
B
CA

R1
R2

R1
R2

A
B

A
B
CA

R1
R2

R1
R2

A
B

A
B
CA

IV

VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR

R1
R2

R1
R2
A
B
CA

II

A
B
Input
AB

R2 R1

AB

R2 R1

TO THE FOLLOWING
VIDEO DISTRIBUTOR

Output
R1
R2

R1
R2

III
A
B
CA

IV

A
B
VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR
R1
R2

R1
R2
A
B
CA

II

A
B
Input
R2 R1

To the following
conversation
privacy device

To the following
module
(C4.007)
(C4.008)
BUTTON MODULE

CONVERSATION
PRIVACY DEVICE
(VX.006)

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12
G/T

U4
U3
U2
U1

To the following
module

(C4.007)
(C4.008)
BUTTON MODULE

14
U4
U3
U2
U1

C4
C3
C2
C1
14

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12
G/T

Name tag
lighting
(C4.018)

TC

(CU.009)
(C4.016)

C2
C1

C2
C1

~12
~0
G/T
3
4
PS
F
5
SN
1
1/~
~
2

G/T
3
4
PS
F
5
SN
1/~
1/~
~
SE

C2

A
B
+TC
R1

6
9
15

A
B
+TC
R1
~12
~0

(VX.021)

C2
C1

G/T
3
4
PS
F
5
SN
1/~
1/~
~
SE

~12
~0
G/T
3
4
PS
F
5
SN
1
1/~
~
2

(VX.021)
C1
10
2
SN1
1
12

SN2
3
11
~0
~12

4
7
13

A
B
+TC
R1

14
Lock
Release

K-Steel Sinthesi

(VD.002)

58

C2
C1

Lock
Release

A
B
+TC
R1
~12
~0

Name tag
lighting
(C4.018)

TC

"1"

(CU.009)
(C4.016)

Sinthesi K-Steel

(VD.002)
ELECTRIC
LOCK
(VX.014)

Name tag
lighting

RELAY
BOX

ELECTRIC
LOCK

LINE ~

LINE ~

LINE~

~ ~
12

LIGHT BULB
TRANSFORMER

AP PS 1 ~ ~ R1 + + / 0 12 TC 6 6
~

R2 R1 +
R

VIDEO POWER SUPPLY


(VX.008)

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

~ ~
12 0

TRANSFORMER
(VX.008)

sec.1e 9

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

AB

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONE TO 2 VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION


Automatic switching during calls (Mod. 725)

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

This system allows the connection of a column of video door phones


to 2 video outdoor stations with automatic switching.
When a visitor presses a call button on one of the two push button
panels, in the called apartment the bitonal electronic call is sent to the
corresponding video door phone loudspeaker and the image appears
on the screen after about 8 seconds.
During this phase, the relay box automatically inserts the relative
loudspeaking unit and TV camera, excluding the other video outdoor
station from the service.
At this point, the user sees the visitor and may respond, if desired,
lifting the handset. At the end of the call, only the electric lock of the
entrance concerned is activated pressing the key
.
If, during a conversation, a call is made from the other push button
panel towards another video door phone, the first will automatically
switch off and the last video door phone called will be activated. It
is not possible therefore to communicate with the 2 video outdoor
stations at the same time in that they operate alternatively and are
mutually exclusive.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SV102-2913B:

Atlantico model
N. X
Video door phone
N. X
Bracket

or
Artico model
N. X
Video door phone
N. X
Bracket

Ref. 1705/1
Ref. 1705/955
TC

VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES

VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR

Ref. 1702/1
Ref. 1202/955

725 model
N. 2
Panel with N buttons
N. 2
Amplified door unit
N. 2
Camera
N. 2
Video adapter
N. 2
Front plate
N. X/4 Conversation privacy device

2 x 82 1/4W
5

VIDEO DOOR PHONE REFERENCES

Mod. 725
Ref. 1035/67
Ref. 725/600
Ref. 1742/13A
Ref. 725/601-/602
Ref. 1035/25

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Panels with anodized aluminium front plate
Mod. 725 section of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system
- product technical manual.

5
4+n

POWER SUPPLY REFERENCES

N. 1
N. 1
N. 1
N. X

VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR

Video power supply


Transformer
Relay box
Video distributor

Ref. 789/5B
Ref. 9000/230
Ref. 788/51
Ref. 955/40

5
DIAGRAM NOTES

4+n

(see section 1)
CU.009

TC

VU.002

VX.006

VX.008

VX.014

TC

13+n

14+n

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

V5.001

10 sec.1e

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SV102-2913B

COLUMN

Output

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONE TO 2 VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION


Automatic switching during calls (Mod. 725 or Mod. Domus Aura)

VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR

Input

TO THE FOLLOWING
VIDEO DISTRIBUTOR

Output

VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR

Push
button
panel

Push
button
panel

Input

CONVERSATION
PRIVACY DEVICE
(VX.006)

(CU.009)

(CU.009)
RELAY
BOX

"1"

"2"

TV Camera
+
adapter

TV Camera
+
adapter

(VU.002)

(VU.002)

ELECTRIC
LOCK

Lock
Release

Lock
Release

LINE~

VIDEO POWER
SUPPLY
(VX.008)
LINE~

TRANSFORMER
(VX.008)

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

ELECTRIC
LOCK

Name tag
lighting
(VX.014)

LINE~

LIGHT BULB
TRANSFORMER

sec.1e 11

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

TC

TC

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONE TO 4 VIDEO OUTDOOR


STATIONS
Automatic switching during calls (Mod. Sinthesi or Mod. K-Steel)

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

This system allows the connection of a column of video door phones


to 4 video outdoor stations with automatic switching. Therefore, it is
suitable for a building with 4 entrances common to all apartments.
When a visitor presses a call button on one of the two push button
panels, in the called apartment the bitonal electronic call is sent to the
corresponding video door phone loudspeaker and the image appears
on the screen after about 7 seconds. During this phase, the relay box
automatically inserts the relative loudspeaking unit and TV camera,
excluding the other video outdoor station from the service. At this
point, the user sees the visitor and may respond, if desired, lifting the
handset. At the end of the call, only the electric lock of the entrance
concerned is activated pressing the key
. If, during a conversation,
a call is made from the other push button panel towards another video
door phone, the first will automatically switch off and the last video
door phone called will be activated. In this system it is not possible
to speak simultaneously from the four outdoor stations because they
work one at a time in automatic switching.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SV102-3092D:

2 x 82 1/4W
5

VIDEO DOOR PHONE REFERENCES


Atlantico model
N. X
Video door phone
N. X
Bracket
or
Artico model
N. X
Video door phone
N. X
Bracket

TC

VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES

VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR

4+n

or
K-Steel model
N. 4
Module camera
N. 4
Module with door unit
N. X
Button modules
N. X/4 Conversation privacy device

5
VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR

Ref. 1745/20-/21-/22
Ref. 1145/11-/12-/13-/14
Ref. 1145/74

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.

Ref. 1705/1
Ref. 1705/955

Sinthesi model
N. 4
Module with camera and door unit
N. X
Button modules
N. X/4 Conversation privacy device

Ref. 1702/1
Ref. 1202/955

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

4+n

TC

Ref. 1755/30A
Ref. 1155/30-/31-/32A
Ref. 1155/11-/12A-/13A-/14A
Ref. 1145/74

TC

2
14+n

POWER SUPPLY REFERENCES


N. 1
N. 3
N. 1
N. X

14+n

Video power supply


Transformer
Relay box
Video distributor

Ref. 789/5B
Ref. 9000/230
Ref. 788/54
Ref. 955/40

DIAGRAM NOTES
TC

TC

14+n

15+n

(see section 1)

C4.007
VD.002

C4.008
VX.006

C4.016
VX.008

C4.018
VX.014

CU.009

V5.001

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

VX.021
Cut or remove the jumpers on the device(s):
a) PS - G/T
b) 4 - F

12 sec.1e

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SV102-3092D
COLUMN
2 x 82

R1R2

1/4W

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONE TO 4 VIDEO OUTDOOR


STATIONS
Automatic switching during calls (Mod. Sinthesi or Mod. K-Steel)

AB

Output
R1
R2

R1
R2

II

R1
R2

R1
R2

A
B

A
B
CA

R1
R2

R1
R2

A
B

A
B
CA

IV

A
B

A
B
CA

DISTRIBUTOR

R1
R2

R1
R2

A
B
CA

A
B

III

Input
R1 R2

AB

TO THE FOLLOWING
VIDEO DISTRIBUTOR

R1R2

AB

Output
R1
R2

R1
R2

A
B
CA

A
B

II

R1
R2

R1
R2

A
B

A
B
CA

R1
R2

R1
R2

A
B

A
B
CA

IV

DISTRIBUTOR

R1
R2

R1
R2

A
B
CA

A
B

III

Input
R1 R2

AB

To the following
module

To the following
module
(C4.007)
(C4.008)

(C4.007)
(C4.008)

Button module
G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12
G/T

Button module

U4
U3
U2
U1

U4
U3
U2
U1

Name tag
lighting
(C4.018)

TC

"3"

R1 R2
C2
C1
~12
~0
G/T
3
4
PS
F
SN
5
1
1/~
~
2
A
B
+TC
R1
~12
~0

(C4.016)
(CU.009)

K-Steel

C2
C1

Name tag
lighting

1 2 6 9 V3 V5
C2
C1

COLUMN
(VX.021)

(VX.021)

G/T

C3

4
PS
F
SN
5
1/~
1/~
~
SE

SN3
V3
+6
V5
SE
~0
~12

A
B
+TC
R1

1
2
+TC
R1
-6

Sinthesi

Lock
Release

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12
G/T

INPUT

INPUT

C2

G/T

SN2
V3
+6
V5
SE
~0
~12

4
PS
F
SN
5
1/~
1/~
~
SE

1
2
+TC
R1
-6

A
B
+TC
R1

LINE~

LINE~

Lock
Release

C2
C1

(C4.018)

~12
~0
G/T
3
4
PS
F
SN
5
1
1/~
~
2

TC

"2"

A
B
+TC
R1
~12
~0

(C4.016)
(CU.009)

Sinthesi K-Steel

(VD.002)

(VD.002)
~

~ ~
12 0

~ ~
0 12

ELECTRIC
LOCK

ELECTRIC
LOCK

TRANSFORMER
TRANSFORMER
To the following
conversation
privacy device

(VX.008)

To the following
module
(C4.007)
(C4.008)

RELAY
BOX

Button module

Conversation
privacy device
(VX.006)

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12
G/T

TC

"4"
(C4.016)
(CU.009)

C2
C1
~12
~0
G/T
3
4
PS
F
SN
5
1
1/~
~
2
A
B
+TC
R1
~12
~0
K-Steel

U4
U3
U2
U1
14

Name tag
lighting
(C4.018)

Button module
14

C4
C3
C2
C1

U4
U3
U2
U1

C2
C1
(VX.021)

G/T

C4

4
PS
F
SN
5
1/~
1/~
~
SE

SN4
V3
+6
V5
SE
~0
~12

A
B
+TC
R1

1
2
+TC
R1
-6

Sinthesi

Lock
Release

INPUT

INPUT

VOLTAGE

LINE~

(VD.002)

C1

G/T

SN1
V3
+6
V5
SE
~0
~12

4
PS
F
SN
5
1/~
1/~
~
SE

1
2
+TC
R1
-6

A
B
+TC
R1

Lock
Release

ELECTRIC
LOCK

Name tag
lighting

~ ~
12 0

TRANSFORMER

C2
C1

(C4.018)

~12
~0
G/T
3
4
PS
F
SN
5
1
1/~
~
2

TC

"1"

A
B
+TC
R1
~12
~0

(C4.016)
(CU.009)

Sinthesi K-Steel

(VD.002)

-6I-6U +TC R2 R1 AP +6 ~12 ~B ~A ~0 SE GND


~

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12
G/T

Name tag
lighting
C2
C1

(VX.021)

To the following
module

(C4.007)
(C4.008)

(VX.014)

LINE~

(VX.008)

ELECTRIC
LOCK

LINE~

VIDEO POWER
SUPPLY
+TC R2 R1

PS

(VX.008)

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

~12 ~0

1/~

~ ~
12

LIGHT BULB
TRANSFORMER

sec.1e 13

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

(VX.008)

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONE


TO 4 VIDEO OUTDOOR STATIONS
Automatic switching during calls (Mod. 725)

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

This system allows the connection of a column of video door phones


to 4 video outdoor stations with automatic switching. Therefore, it is
suitable for a building with 4 entrances common to all apartments.
When a visitor presses a call button on one of the two push button
panels, in the called apartment the bitonal electronic call is sent to the
corresponding video door phone loudspeaker and the image appears
on the screen after about 7 seconds. During this phase, the relay box
automatically inserts the relative loudspeaking unit and TV camera,
excluding the other video outdoor station from the service. At this
point, the user sees the visitor and may respond, if desired, lifting the
handset. At the end of the call, only the electric lock of the entrance
concerned is activated pressing the key
. If, during a conversation,
a call is made from the other push button panel towards another video
door phone, the first will automatically switch off and the last video
door phone called will be activated. In this system it is not possible
to speak simultaneously from the four outdoor stations because they
work one at a time in automatic switching.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SV102-2806F:

2 x 82 1/4W
5

Atlantico model
N. X
Video door phone
N. X
Bracket

VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR

or
Artico model
N. X
Video door phone
N. X
Bracket

Ref. 1705/1
Ref. 1705/955
TC

VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES

Mod. 725
Ref. 1035/67
Ref. 725/600
Ref. 1742/13A
Ref. 725/601-/602
Ref. 1035/25

5
The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with
module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Panels with anodized aluminium front plate
Mod. 725 section of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system
- product technical manual.

4+n

5
POWER SUPPLY REFERENCES

VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR

N. 1
N. 3
N. 1
N. X

5
4+n

TC

2
14+n

Ref. 789/5B
Ref. 9000/230
Ref. 788/54
Ref. 955/40

(see section 1)
CU.009
VX.006

14+n

TC

Video power supply


Transformer
Relay box
Video distributor

DIAGRAM NOTES

TC

V5.001
VX.008

VX.014

VU.002

TC

14+n

15+n

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

Ref. 1702/1
Ref. 1202/955

725 model
N. 4
Panel with N buttons
N. 4
Amplified door unit
N. 4
Camera
N. 4
Video adapter
N. 4
Front plate
N. X/4 Conversation privacy device

VIDEO DOOR PHONE REFERENCES

14 sec.1e

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SV102-2806F
COLUMN
2 x 82
R1R2

1/4W

AB

Output
R1
R2

R1
R2

II

R1
R2

R1
R2

A
B

A
B
CA

R1
R2

R1
R2

A
B

A
B
CA

IV

A
B

A
B
CA

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONE


TO 4 VIDEO OUTDOOR STATIONS
Automatic switching during calls (Mod. 725)

VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR

R1
R2

R1
R2

A
B
CA

A
B

III

Input
R1 R2

AB

TO THE FOLLOWING
VIDEO DISTRIBUTOR
R1R2

AB

Output
R1
R2

R1
R2

A
B
CA

A
B

II

R1
R2

R1
R2

A
B

A
B
CA

R1
R2

R1
R2

A
B

A
B
CA

IV

VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR

R1
R2

R1
R2

A
B
CA

A
B

III

Input
R1 R2

AB

R1 R2

1 2 6 9 V3 V5

Name tag
lighting

Name tag
lighting

TC

TC

COLUMN
P. E.
PS
4
SN
5
1/~
3
~
2

(CU.009)

INPUT
C

INPUT
D

-6
1
2
+TC
R1

A
TV Camera
B
+
Adapter +TC
R1

C4
SN4
V3
+6
SE
~0
~12
V5

PS
4
SN
5
1/~
3
~
2
(CU.009)

-6
1
2
+TC
R1

A TV Camera
B
+
+TC Adapter
R1
Lock
Release

Lock
Release
(VU.002)

(VU.002)
LINE ~

ELECTRIC
LOCK

LINE ~

~ ~
12 0

~ ~
0 12
RELAY
BOX

TRANSFORMER

ELECTRIC
LOCK

TRANSFORMER

(VX.008)

(VX.008)

CONVERSATION
PRIVACY DEVICE
(VX.006)

Name tag
lighting

14

41

14

Name tag
lighting

41

TC

TC
P. E.

"2"

"4"

P. E.
C2
SN2
V3
+6
SE
~0
~12
V5

PS
4
SN
5
1/~
3
~
2
(CU.009)

-6
1
2
+TC
R1

A
TV Camera
B
+
Adapter +TC
R1
Lock
Release

INPUT
B

INPUT
A

VOLTAGE

C1
SN1
V3
+6
SE
~0
~12
V5

PS
4
SN
5
1/~
3
~
2
(CU.009)

-6
1
2
+TC
R1

A
B TV Camera
+
+TC Adapter
R1
Lock
Release

I
G
N
N
+ + ~ ~ ~ ~
H AP 6 R2 R1 TC 6 0 A B 12 SE D

(VU.002)
LINE ~

(VU.002)
Name tag
lighting

ELECTRIC
LOCK

(VX.014)

LINE ~

(VX.008)

ELECTRIC
LOCK
LINE~

~ ~
12 0

TRANSFORMER

"1"

+ - R2 R1 R2 R1 + PS AP ~ ~ SE 1 SE +
6 6
TC
0 12 1 / 2 R
~

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

VIDEO POWER SUPPLY


(VX.008)

~~
0 12

~
LIGHT BULB
TRANSFORMER

sec.1e 15

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

"3"

P. E.
C3
SN3
V3
+6
SE
~0
~12
V5

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONE


TO 1 VIDEO DOOR UNIT AND 1 DOOR UNIT
Automatic switching during calls (Mod. Sinthesi o K-Steel)

FUNCTION

TC

This type of system is used to connect a video door phone column to


an automatically switching video door unit or door unit.
A two-tone electronic call is sent to the corresponding video door
phone speaker when a call button is pressed on either of the two
panels; the picture appears on the screen after approximately seven
seconds if the call was made by the video door unit.
The video door phone will not light up and the video door phone will
work as a normal door phone if the call is made from thcamera unit and
panel.
Press
at the end of the call to open the concerned door electrical
lock only.

2 x 82 1/4W
5

Sinthesi model
N. 1
Module with camera and door unit
N. X
Button modules
N. X/4 Conversation privacy device

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.
K-Steel model
N. 1
Module camera
N. 1
Module with door unit
N. X
Button modules
N. X/4 Conversation privacy device

VIDEO
DISTRIBUTORE

OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES

VIDEO
DISTRIBUTORE

Ref. 1755/30A
Ref. 1155/30-/31-/32A
Ref. 1155/11-/12A-/13A-/14A
Ref. 1145/74

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

4+n
5

Ref. 1745/20-/21-/22
Ref. 1145/11-/12-/13-/14
Ref.1145/74

or

VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES

Sinthesi model
N. X
Button modules
N. 1
Module with door unit set-up
N. 1
Amplified door unit
N. X/4 Conversation privacy device

5
4+n

Ref. 1145/11-/12-/13-/14
Ref. 1145/20-/21
Ref. 1145/67
Ref. 1145/74

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.
TC

or

14+n

8+n

K-Steel model
N. X
Button modules
N. 1
Module with door unit
N. X/4 Conversation privacy device

Ref. 1155/11-/12A-/13A-/14A
Ref. 1155/30-/31-/32A
Ref. 1145/74

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.
POWER SUPPLY REFERENCES

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

EQUIPMENT
The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SV102-3121C:

Video power supply


Transformer
Relay box
Video distributor

Ref. 789/5B
Ref. 9000/230
Ref. 788/51
Ref. 955/40

DIAGRAM NOTES

VIDEO DOOR PHONE REFERENCES


Atlantico model
N. X
Video door phone
N. X
Bracket

N. 1
N. 1
N. 1
N. X

(see section 1)
Ref. 1702/1
Ref. 1202/955

C4.006
V5.001

C4.007
VD.002

C4.008
VU.002

C4.016
VX.006

C4.018
VX.008

CU.009
VX.014

or
Artico model
N. X
Video door phone
N. X
Bracket

Ref. 1705/1
Ref. 1705/955

VX.021a
Cut or remove the jumpers on the device(s):
a) PS - G/T
b) 4 - F
VX.021b
Cut or remove the jumpers on the device(s):
a) 4 - F

16 sec.1e

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SV102-3121C
2 x 82

1/4W

R1 R2

AB

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL VIDEO DOOR PHONE


TO 1 VIDEO DOOR UNIT AND 1 DOOR UNIT
Automatic switching during calls (Mod. Sinthesi o K-Steel)

Output
R1
R2

R1
R2

III
A
B
CA

R1
R2

R1
R2

A
B

A
B
CA

R1
R2

R1
R2

A
B

A
B
CA

IV

A
B
VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR

R1
R2

R1
R2

II

A
B

A
B
CA

Input
R1 R2

AB

TO THE FOLLOWING
VIDEO DISTRIBUTOR

R1 R2

AB

Output
R1
R2

R1
R2
III
A
B

A
B
CA

R1
R2

R1
R2

A
B

A
B
CA

R1
R2

R1
R2

A
B

A
B
CA

IV

VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR

R1
R2

R1
R2
A
B
CA

II

A
B
Input
AB

R1 R2

To the following
conversation
privacy device

To the
following
module

To the
following
module

(C4.007)
(C4.008)
BUTTON MODULE

TC
AMPLIFIED
LOUDSPEAKING
UNIT

(CU.009)
(C4.016)
(VX.021a)

TV CAMERA

41

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12
G/T

U4
U3
U2
U1

C2
C1

C2
C1

C4
C3
C2
C1
41

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12
G/T

U4
U3
U2
U1

CONVERSATION
PRIVACY DEVICE
(VX.006)

~12
~0
G/T
3
4
PS
F
SN
5
1
1/~
~
2
A
B
+TC
R1
~12
~0
K-Steel

G/T
U1
13
C1

G/T

2
SN1
1

4
PS
F
SN
5
1/~
1/~
~
SE

C1
C2
3
4
PS
F
SN
5
1
1/~
~
2

C2
SN2
3

~0
~12

A
B
+TC
R1

7
8
9
10
11
12

4
5
6
14
15

G/T
~12
~0
~12
~0

Name tag
lighting
(C4.006)
(C4.016)
(CU.009)
(VX.021b)

Lock
Release

ELECTRIC
LOCK

Sinthesi

(VD.002)
ELECTRIC
LOCK

Mod. K-Steel/Sinthesi

Lock
Release

RELAY
BOX

Name tag
lighting

LINE~

(VX.014)

LINE~
LINE~

Mod. K-Steel/Sinthesi

R1 + ~ ~ PS +R
TC 12 0

1/~ R1 R2R2

-6 +6

VIDEO POWER SUPPLY


(VX.008)

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

~ ~
0 12

TRANSFORMER

~ ~
12

LIGHT BULB
TRANSFORMER

(VX.008)

sec.1e 17

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

Name tag
lighting
(C4.018)

(C4.007)
(C4.008)
BUTTON MODULE

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL SETS OF VIDEO DOOR PHONES


TO 1 MAIN VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION
Each column is also connected to its own secondary video outdoor station
(Mod. Sinthesi or Mod. K-Steel)

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

This system is particularly suitable for residential properties where it is


necessary to connect the single villas to a proper video outdoor station
and to a common one located at the main entry.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SV102-3060B:
VIDEO DOOR PHONE REFERENCES

During calling the video door phone is automatically switched on the


main video outdoor station or to the secondary one of its own group, by
means of the switching relay. The services for secondary video outdoor
stations are independent, so that they be realized simultaneously.
When the call is coming from the main video outdoor station, only the
group of the called video door phone is switched on it, the other ones
continue to service towards the secondary.
2 x 82 1/4W
5

Ref. 1702/1
Ref. 1202/955

or
Artico model
N. X
Video door phone
N. X
Bracket

2 x 82 1/4W
5

Atlantico model
N. X
Video door phone
N. X
Bracket

Ref. 1705/1
Ref. 1705/955

5
TC
VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR

VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR

4+n

Sinthesi model
N. 1+K Module with camera and door unit
N. X
Button modules
N. X/4 Conversation privacy device

5
VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR

VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR

4+n

VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES

4+n

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.

5
4+n

14+n

14+n

8+n

Ref. 1745/20-/21-/22
Ref. 1145/11-/12-/13-/14
Ref. 1145/74

or

8+n

TC

TC

K-Steel model
N. 1+K Module camera
N. 1+K Module with door unit
N. X
Button modules
N. X/4 Conversation privacy device

Ref. 1755/30A
Ref. 1155/30-/31-/32A
Ref. 1155/11-/12A-/13A-/14A
Ref. 1145/74

11+k(n+1)

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

TC

K= quantity of columns

POWER SUPPLY REFERENCES


N. K
N. 1
N. K
N. X
N. 1

Video power supply


Transformer
Relay box
Video distributor
Supplementary power supply

Ref. 789/5B
Ref. 9000/230
Ref. 788/51
Ref. 955/40
Ref. 1090/850

DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)
C4.007
V5.001

C4.008
VD.002

C4.014
VX.006

C4.017
VX.008

CU.009
VX.014

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

VX.021a
Cut or remove the jumpers on the device(s):
a) 4 - F
VX.021b
Cut or remove the jumpers on the device(s):
a) P1 - P2

18 sec.1e

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SV102-3060B

1st COLUMN
2 x 82
R1R2

2nd COLUMN

-1/4W

AB

Output
R1
R2

R1
R2

A
B
CA

A
B

II

R1
R2

R1
R2

A
B

A
B
CA

R1
R2

R1
R2

A
B

A
B
CA

IV

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL SETS OF VIDEO DOOR PHONES


TO 1 MAIN VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION
Each column is also connected to its own secondary video outdoor station
(Mod. Sinthesi or Mod. K-Steel)

VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR
R1
R2

R1
R2

A
B
CA

A
B

III

Input
R1 R2

AB

TO THE FOLLOWING
VIDEO DISTRIBUTOR

R1R2

AB

Output
R1
R2

R1
R2

A
B
CA

A
B

R1
R2

R1
R2

A
B
CA

A
B

II

R1
R2

R1
R2

A
B

A
B
CA

R1
R2

R1
R2

A
B

A
B
CA

IV

VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR

III

Input
R1 R2

AB

To the
following
module

To the following
conversation
privacy device

MAIN ~

LIGHT BULB
TRANSFORMER

CONVERSATION
PRIVACY DEVICE

(VX.006)

C4
C3
C2
C1

(VX.014)
~

Name tag
lighting

~12
~0

BUTTON MODULE
14

U4
U3
U2
U1

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12
G/T

U4
U3
U2
U1

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12
G/T

14

AS 1ST COLUMN

(C4.007)
(C4.008)
14

R1
R2
AP

C4
C3
C2
C1

11 14

SE3
SE2
SE1

14
VIDEO POWER
SUPPLY
(VX.008)

+R
-6
+6

Name tag
lighting
(CU.009)
(C4.017)

C2
RELAY
BOX

(C4.014)
+TC
PS

8
5

1/~
~0
~12

(VX.021a)

SN2
2
SN1
3
6

~0
~12

3
4
PS
F
SN
5
1/~
1/~
~
SE

A
B
+TC
R1

A
B
+TC
R1
~12
~0

TC

PS
F
SN
5
1
1/~
~
2

TC

0
LINE ~

12
15
9

230
R1
R2
C1 7

14

1013

SECONDARY

Sinthesi K-Steel

Lock
Release

(VD.002)
TV CAMERA UNIT
AMPLIFIED LOUDSPEAKING
UNIT
2 x 82
1/4W

ELECTRIC
LOCK
R1R2
B
A

To the
following
module

AB

Output
II

I
R2
R1
VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR

B
A

BUTTON MODULE

A
B
IV

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12
G/T

R2
R1

U4
U3
U2
U1

III

Input
R1 R2

R1
R2

AB

P1

A
B
R1
R2

P2
GND
V out
U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12

0
LINE ~
230

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12
G/T

U4
U3
U2
U1

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12

U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12
G/T

U4
U3
U2
U1

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12

U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T

~12
~0
A
B
R1
+TC

A
B
R1
+TC

TO THE FOLLOWING
COLUMN

(C4.007)
(C4.008)

Calls

Name tag
lighting

(VD.002)
(CU.009)
(C4.017)

TC

3
PS

MAIN

5
F
SN
1/~
1
~
2
K-Steel

3
PS
4
5
F
SN
1/~
1/~
~
SE

(VX.021a)

Name tag
lighting
Lock
Release

(VX.014)

LINE ~
LINE~

Sinthesi

TV CAMERA UNIT
AMPLIFIED LOUDSPEAKING
UNIT

ELECTRIC
LOCK

~ ~
12 0

TRANSFORMER
(VX.008)

~ ~
12

LIGHT BULB
TRANSFORMER

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1e 19

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

ADDITIONAL POWER
SUPPLY UNIT
(VX.008) (VX.021b)

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL SETS OF VIDEO DOOR PHONES


TO 1 MAIN VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION
Each column is also connected to its own secondary outdoor station
(Mod. Sinthesi or Mod. K-Steel)
The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with
module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.

FUNCTION
This system is particularly suitable for residential properties where it is
necessary to connect the single villas to a proper video outdoor station
and to a common one located at the main entry.
During calling the video door phone is automatically switched on the
main video outdoor station or to the secondary one of its own group, by
means of the switching relay. The services for secondary video outdoor
stations are independent, so that they be realized simultaneously.
When the call is coming from the main video outdoor station, only the
group of the called video door phone is switched on it, the other ones
continue to service towards the secondary.
2 x 82 1/4W
5

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

4+n

OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES

4+n

Sinthesi model
N. X
Button modules
N. K
Module with door unit set-up
N. K
Amplified door unit
N. X/4 Conversation privacy device

5
VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR

VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR

Ref. 1755/30A
Ref. 1155/30-/31-/32A
Ref. 1155/11-/12A-/13A-/14A
Ref. 1145/74

VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR

K-Steel model
N. 1
Module camera
N. 1
Module with door unit
N. X
Button modules
N. X/4 Conversation privacy device

2 x 82 1/4W

VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR

or

4+n

Ref. 1145/11-/12-/13-/14
Ref. 1145/20-/21
Ref. 1145/67
Ref. 1145/74

4+n

14+n

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.

14+n

8+n

8+n

TC

TC

K-Steel model
N. X
Button modules
N. K
Module with door unit
N. X/4 Conversation privacy device

11+k(n+1)
TC

or
Ref.1155/11-/12A-/13A-/14A
Ref. 1155/30-/31-/32A
Ref. 1145/74

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

K= quantity of columns

POWER SUPPLY REFERENCES


N. K
N. 1
N. K
N. X
N. 1
N. X

EQUIPMENT

Video power supply


Transformer
Relay box
Video distributor
Supplementary power supply
Kit of 10 diodes

Ref. 789/5B
Ref. 9000/230
Ref. 788/51
Ref. 955/40
Ref. 1090/850
Ref. 1131/4

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SV102-3094D:

DIAGRAM NOTES

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

VIDEO DOOR PHONE REFERENCES

(see section 1)

Atlantico model
N. X
Video door phone
N. X
Bracket

Ref. 1702/1
Ref. 1202/955

or
Artico model
N. X
Video door phone
N. X
Bracket

Ref. 1705/1
Ref. 1705/955
TC

VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES


Sinthesi model
N. 1
Module with camera and door unit
N. X
Button modules
N. X/4 Conversation privacy device

20 sec.1e

C4.007
V5.001

C4.008
VD.002

C4.014
VX.006

C4.017
VX.008

CU.009
VX.014

VX.021a
Cut or remove the jumpers on the device(s):
a) 4 - F
VX.021b
Cut or remove the jumpers on the device(s):
a) P1 - P2

Ref. 1745/20-/21-/22
Ref. 1145/11-/12-/13-/14
Ref. 1145/74
DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SV102-3094D
1st COLUMN
2 x 82
R1R2

2nd COLUMN

-1/4W

AB

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL SETS OF VIDEO DOOR PHONES


TO 1 MAIN VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION
Each column is also connected to its own secondary outdoor station
(Mod. Sinthesi or Mod. K-Steel)

Output
R1
R2

R1
R2

A
B
CA

A
B

II

R1
R2

R1
R2

A
B

A
B
CA

R1
R2

R1
R2

A
B

A
B
CA

R1
R2

R1
R2

A
B

A
B
CA

R1
R2

R1
R2

A
B

A
B
CA

IV

VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR
R1
R2

R1
R2

A
B
CA

A
B

III

Input
R1 R2

AB

TO THE FOLLOWING
VIDEO DISTRIBUTOR
R1R2

AB

Output
R1
R2

R1
R2

A
B
CA

A
B

II

IV

VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR
R1
R2

R1
R2

A
B
CA

A
B

III

Input
R1 R2

LIGHT BULB
TRANSFORMER

AB

To the following
conversation
privacy device
CONVERSATION
PRIVACY DEVICE
(VX.006)
14

MAIN ~

C4
C3
C2
C1

~
(VX.014)
~

BUTTON MODULE
U4
U3
U2
U1

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12
G/T

U4
U3
U2
U1

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12
G/T

14

Name tag
lighting

~12
~0

14
VIDEO POWER
SUPPLY
(VX.008)

14
8

+R
-6
+6

C4
C3
C2
C1

R1
R2

11
5

1/~
~0
~12

Name tag
lighting

C2
(VX.021a)

SN2
2
SN1
3
6
12

(C4.014)

+TC
PS

AS 1ST COLUMN

(C4.007)
(C4.008)
RELAY
BOX

AP
SE3
SE2
SE1

To the
following
module

~0
~12
9

3
4
PS
F
SN
5
1
1/~
~
2

(CU.009)
(C4.017)

~
LINE ~
AMPLIFIED LOUDSPEAKING UNIT

~
R1
R2
C1

ELECTRIC
LOCK

Lock
Release

10 4 1

2 x 82
1/4W
R1R2

Output

B
A

To the
following
module

AB

II

R2
R1
VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR

BUTTON MODULE

B
A

A
B
IV

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12
G/T

R2
R1

U4
U3
U2
U1

III
Input

R1 R2

R1
R2

AB

P1

A
B
R1
R2

P2
GND
V out
G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12

U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T

0
LINE ~
230
ADDITIONAL POWER
SUPPLY UNIT
(VX.008) (VX.021b)

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12
G/T

U4
U3
U2
U1

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12

U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12
G/T

U4
U3
U2
U1

G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12

U4
U3
U2
U1
G/T

~12
~0
A
B
R1
+TC

A
B
R1
+TC

(C4.007)
(C4.008)

TO THE FOLLOWING
COLUMN

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

Calls

Name tag
lighting

(VD.002)

(CU.009)
(C4.017)

TC

3
PS
5
SN
F
1/~
1
~
2
K-Steel

3
PS
4
5
SN
F
1/~
1/~
~
SE

(VX.021a)

Name tag
lighting

Lock
Release

(VX.014)

LINE ~
LINE~

Sinthesi

TV CAMERA UNIT
AMPLIFIED LOUDSPEAKING
UNIT

ELECTRIC
LOCK

~ ~
12 0

TRANSFORMER
(VX.008)

~ ~
12

LIGHT BULB
TRANSFORMER

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1e 21

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF 4 VIDEO DOOR PHONES TO 1 VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION


(Mod. Sinthesi or Mod. K-Steel)
The video door unit calls the 4 video door phones in parallel with switch-on at
the same time

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

This system allows the connection of a column of video door phones


to 4 video outdoor stations with automatic switching. Therefore, it is
suitable for a building with 4 entrances common to all apartments.
When a visitor presses a call button on one of the two push button
panels, in the called apartment the bitonal electronic call is sent to the
corresponding video door phone loudspeaker and the image appears
on the screen after about 7 seconds.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SV102-3166C:
VIDEO DOOR PHONE REFERENCES
Atlantico model
N. X
Video door phone
N. X
Bracket

Ref. 1702/1
Ref. 1202/955
TC

2 x 82 1/4W

VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES


Sinthesi model
N. 1
Module with camera and door unit

5
VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR

Ref. 1745/21

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.

5
or

K-Steel model
N. 1
Module with camera and door unit

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to K-Steel modular vandal-proof panel section
of Doorphone and Videodoorphone system - product technical
manual.

TC

Ref. 1755/21

POWER SUPPLY REFERENCES


N. 1
N. 1
N. X

Video power supply


Supplementary power supply
Video distributor

Ref. 789/5B
Ref. 789/3
Ref. 955/40

DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)
VD.002

VX.008

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

V5.001

22 sec.1e

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SV102-3166C
~

LINE~
~

POWER SUPPLY
(VX.008)

V2
R2 out
R1
RL
R2 in
R1

2 x 82

AB

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF 4 VIDEO DOOR PHONES TO 1 VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION


(Mod. Sinthesi or Mod. K-Steel)
The video door unit calls the 4 video door phones in parallel with switch-on at
the same time

1/4W

R2R1

Output
R2
R1
RD

II
A
B
R3
CA

R2
R1
RD

R1
R2

R1
R2
IV

A
B

A
B
G
CA

A
B

VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR
RD
R1
R2
A
B
G
CA

R1
R2

R2
R1
RD

R1
R2
III

A
B

A
B
G
CA

A
B

Input
AB

(VD.002)

C1
G/T

PS
4
5
F
A
~12 B
~0
+TC
R1
SN
1/~
1/~
1/~
~
SE

PS
4
5
F
A
B

K-Steel

AP
-6
+6
SE1
+R
R1
R2

+TC
R1
SN

+TC
R1
PS

1/~
1/~
~
SE

1/~
~0
~12
SE2
R2

VIDEO
POWER SUPPLY
(VX.008)

Sinthesi

Lock Release
ELECTRIC
LOCK

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

LINE~
~

sec.1e 23

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

TC

C1
G/T

R2R1

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL COLOUR VIDEO DOOR PHONES


TO 1 VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION
(Mod. Sinthesi)

FUNCTION

EQUIPMENT

The 5-wire video door phone system implements conversation privacy,


call and door opener functions in normal door phone systems with only
5 wires in the riser column: 4 commons + 1 single for each device.
The door unit is powered with only two wires and a transformer at
12V~.
The most interesting application of a 5-wire system is in old buildings
where a door phone system is already fitted. The existing system can
be transformed into a video door phone system without adding wires
to the column or in the apartments.
Specific conversation privacy circuits must be fitted in the panel for
ensuring conversation privacy for all video door phones in the system
(one for each button). All video door phones are normally deactivated
(no sound is heard when the handset is picked up); only the video door
phone called from the door can start the conversation. No other users
can cut into the call.
The voice circuit of the called video door phone remains activate until
the following call is made from the panel to another device.
The door opening function is connected to conversation privacy; this
means that a user must be called to be able to open the electrical
lock.

The following devices are needed for the system illustrated in diagram
SV102-3122E:

2 x 82 1/4W
4+n

4+n

VIDEO DOOR PHONE REFERENCES


Atlantico model
N. X
Video door phone
N. X
Bracket
or
Modello Utopia
N. X
Video door phone
N. X
Bracket

Ref. 1703/1
Ref. 1703/955
TC

VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES


Sinthesi model
N. X
Button modules
N. 1
Module camera
N. 1
Video adapter
N. 1
Module with door unit set-up
N. 1
Amplified door unit
N. X/4 Conversation privacy device

VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR

4+n

Ref. 1702/40
Ref. 1202/955

Ref. 1145/11-/12-/13-/14
Ref. 1745/40
Ref. 1742/13A
Ref. 1145/20-/21
Ref. 1145/67
Ref. 1145/74

The panels must be installed in flush-mounting boxes with


module holder frames or in cases with hood for wall-mounted
versions. Refer to Sinthesi panel section of Doorphone and
Videodoorphone system - product technical manual.

4+n
4+n

POWER SUPPLY REFERENCES

4+n

4+n

N. 1
N. X

4+n

DIAGRAM NOTES

Video power supply


Video distributor

Ref. 789/5B
Ref. 955/40

VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR

4+n
4+n

(see section 1)
CU.009

V5.001

VU.002

VX.006

VX.008

VX.014

TC

10+n

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

24 sec.1e

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SV102-3122E
2 x 82
AB

1/4W

R2R1

Output
R1
R2

R1
R2

A
B
CA

IV

R1
R2

R1
R2

A
B

A
B
CA

R1
R2

R1
R2

A
B

A
B
CA

R1
R2

R1
R2

A
B

A
B
CA

R1
R2

R1
R2

A
B

A
B
CA

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

CONNECTION OF SEVERAL COLOUR VIDEO DOOR PHONES


TO 1 VIDEO OUTDOOR STATION
(Mod. Sinthesi)

II

A
B

VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR
Ref.955/40
R1
R2

R1
R2

A
B
CA

A
B

III

Input
AB

R2 R1

AB

R2R1

TO THE FOLLOWING
VIDEO DISTRIBUTOR

Output
R1
R2

R1
R2

IV

II

A
B

A
B
CA

VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR
Ref.955/40
R1
R2

R1
R2

A
B
CA

A
B

III

Input
AB

To the following
module

To the following
conversation
privacy devices

U4
U3
U2
U1

~0
~12

(VX.006)

41

C4
C3
C2
C1

LINE~

(VX.014)
~

41

LIGHT BULB
TRANSFORMER

TV CAMERA UNIT
R2
A
B
+TC
R1
T

(CU.009)

TC

R1
R2
+TC
R1
+R
-6
+6

U1
C2
C1
PS
3
G/T
F
5
4
SN
1
1/~
~
2

(VU.002)

AMPLIFIED
LOUDSPEAKING UNIT

LINE~
~
SE1
AP
SE2

VIDEO
POWER SUPPLY
(VX.008)

PS
1/~
~0
~12
R2

Lock
Release

ELECTRIC LOCK

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1e 25

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

Name tag
lighting

Name tag
lighting

CONVERSATION
PRIVACY DEVICES

BUTTONS MODULE
G/T
~12
~0
~0
~12
G/T

R2 R1

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

SV102-3239: CONNECTION OF 1 VIDEO DOOR PHONE AND 1 DOOR PHONE


TO 1 RISING COLUMN. SINGLE CALLS
SV102-1710D: CONNECTION OF ONE DOOR PHONE IN PARALLEL TO 1 VIDEO DOOR PHONE
SV102-1712F: CONNECTION OF TWO VIDEO DOOR PHONES IN PARALLEL

2x 82

AB

SV102-3239

1/4W

R2R1

Output
R1
R2

R1
R2

R1
R2
III

II

A
B

A
B
CA

A
B
Ref.955/40
VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR

CA1
1
2

R1
R2

R1
R2

IV

A
B

A
B
Input

calls

AB

R2 R1

AB

R2 R1

FROM RISING COLUMN

SV102-1710D
AB

R1R2

Output
R1
R2

R1
R2

R1
R2
I

II

A
B

A
B
CA

A
B
VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR
Ref.955/40

EQUIPMENT
IN PARALLEL
CA1
R1
R2

R1
R2
IV

III

A
B

A
B
Input
AB

Single
call

R1 R2

COMMONS

FROM COLUMN

SV102-1712F
230
LINE~
0
POWER SUPPLY
Ref.789/2

(VX.008)

RL
V2
R2 in
R1
R2 out

AB

R1R2

Output
R2
R1

R2
R1

R2
R1
II

A
B

A
B
CA

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

III
A
B

VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR
Ref.955/40

EQUIPMENT
IN PARALLEL
R2
R1

R2
R1

R2
R1
I

A
B
CA

IV

A
B

A
B
Input
AB

Single
call

R1 R2

COMMONS

FROM COLUMN

26 sec.1e

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SV102-1470C
AB

R1R2

Output
R1
R2

R1
R2

R1
R2
II

I
A
B
CA

A
B

VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR
Ref.955/40

CALL
REPEATER RELAY
Ref.788/52
S3
S1

~~
012

CHIME
12 V~

A
B

R1
R2

C
6

R1
R2
IV

III

A
B

A
B

Input

LINE~

AB
~

~~
0 12

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

SV102-1470C: CONNECTION OF A CALL REPEATER RELAY Ref. 788/52


FOR OPERATING ADDITIONAL RINGER
SV102-3240: CONNECTION OF A CALL REPEATER RELAY Ref. 788/22
FOR OPERATING ADDITIONAL RINGER
SV102-3238: EXAMPLE OF CONNECTION FOR RELEASING DOOR LOCK
DURING A CALL BY THE VIDEO DOOR PHONE

R1 R2

Single
call

TRANSFORMER
Ref.9000/230
(VX.008)

COMMONS

FROM COLUMN
2x 82

1/4W

SV102-3240
AB

R2R1

Output
R1
R2

R1
R2

R1
R2
II

I
A
B
CA

CALL
REPEATER RELAY
Ref.788/22

A
B

A
B

VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR
Ref.955/40

CHCH+
NA
C

R1
R2

~
12
~
LINE~

R1
R2
IV

A
B

Ref.9854/40
RINGER

A
B

Input

~ ~
12 0

calls
Ref.9000/230
TRANSFORMER

III

AB

R1 R2

AB

R1 R2

FROM RISING COLUMN

(VX.008)

SV102-3238
AB

R1R2

Output
R1
R2

R1
R2

R1
R2
II

I
A
B

A
B
CA

CALL
REPEATER RELAY
Ref.788/22

VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR
Ref.955/40
ELECTRICAL
LOCK TIMER
Ref.1032/81

+ CH+L CH+
0L
C
NA NC

+24
+12/~
-/~

~12
~0
0
MAIN~
230

TRANSFORMER
Ref.9000/230

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

R1
R2

R1
R2
IV

III
A
B

A
B

SE2
-/~
AP
NO
C
NC

(C4.023)
(VX.021)

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

SWITCH
NNF

A
B

Input
AB

Single
call

R1 R2

COMMONS

FROM COLUMN

sec.1e 27

DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS

EXAMPLE OF SIGNAL A, SIGNAL B AND POWER (R1, R2) DISTRIBUTION ON


SEVERAL COLUMNS

SV102-2978C
2 x 82Ohm 1/4W

AB

2 x 82Ohm 1/4W

R2 R1

R2 R1

Output
R1
R2

R1
R2

R1
R2

A
B

A
B

II III

VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR
Ref.955/40

A
B
VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR
Ref.955/40

R1
R2
I

A
B

R1
R2

R1
R2
I

IV
A
B

Input

A
B

IV

AB

R2 R1

R2 R1

AB

AB

R2 R1

R2 R1

AB

R1
R2

Output
R1
R2

R1
R2

A
B

A
B

II III

VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR
Ref.955/40

AB

R1
R2

R1
R2
I

IV

Input

A
B
VIDEO
DISTRIBUTOR
Ref.955/40

R1
R2
I

R1
R2
II III

A
B

R1
R2

A
B

Input

Output

A
B

R1
R2
II III

A
B

R1
R2

AB

Output

A
B

A
B

Input
R1 R2

R2 R1

IV
A
B

AB

2 x 82Ohm 1/4W

TO THE
FOLLOWING
COLUMN

AB
R1 R2
Output
R1
R1
R2
R2
I
II
A
B
B
A
955/40
R1
R1
R2
R2
III IV
A
A
B
B
Input

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

AB

TO THE
FOLLOWING
COLUMN

R2 R1

R2 R1

VIDEO
POWER SUPPLY

TC

VIDEO OUTDOOR

The video power unit Ref. 789/5B can power up to 8 video distributors Ref. 955/40 if Atlantico, or
Scaitel monitors are not installed in parallel in the system.
The closing resistors must not be present on the video door phone brackets.

28 sec.1e

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

INSTRUCTIONS FOR URMET DOMUS DEVICE INTERCHANGEABILITY

SECTION 1F
(REV.B)

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

INSTRUCTIONS FOR
URMET DOMUS DEVICE
INTERCHANGEABILITY

Download from:
www.urmetdomus.com
Technical Manuals area
DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1f 1

2 sec.1f

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS


INSTRUCTIONS FOR URMET DOMUS DEVICE INTERCHANGEABILITY

INSTRUCTIONS FOR URMET DOMUS DEVICE INTERCHANGEABILITY

INTERCHANGEABLE DEVICES

INTERCHANGEABLE DEVICES

POWER UNITS

RELAY DEVICES

TRANSFORMERS

APARTMENT
STATIONS

DOOR UNITS

PREVIOUS MODEL

NEW MODEL

SEE PAGE

786/1

786/11

23

786/5A

786/15

786/14

786/11 or 786/12 (*)

23

787/4

786/4

789

789/1A

789

789/5B

789/1A

789/5B

1840/22

1090/850

4340/20

752/20

7073

789/1A

7073/1

789/1A

7073/2

789/1A

7073/5A

789/2

16

9006/1

786/11

12

9006/2

786/11

12

9006/3

786/3A

14

9006/5

786/15

9006/14

786/11 or 786/12 (*)

12

9006/22

786/11 or 786/12 (*)

12

9008/14

786/38A

14

788/1

788/51

16

788/5

788/52

17

788/4

788/54

19

788/8

788/58

18

788/11

788/52

15

788/21

788/52

15

788/30

788/52

17

4330/31

788/51

16

4340/11

788/52

15

4520/10

788/52

15

9330 (II series)

788/52

17

9332/1

788/51

16

9332/5

788/52

17

9332/8

788/58

18

9000/20

9000/230 or 9000/110 (*)

18

1201/1 Ranger

1702/1 Atlantico

20

1201/10

1702/1 Atlantico

20

1704/1 Sentry

1705/1 Artico

22

1704/1A Sentry+

1705/1 Artico

22

1704/10 Sentry

1705/1 Artico

22

1704/10A Sentry+

1705/1 Artico

22

1704/90

1704/102

22

1704/955

1704/102

22

4340/23

752/23

7081/1 Vedette

1704/20 Sentry+

20

7091/1 Sentinel

1704/20 Sentry+

20

7101/1 Explorer

1704/20 Sentry+

20

5150/500

1128/500

14

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

Some devices replace previous models and may be used as spare parts.
The correspondence between versions is:

(*) Not available in Italy.

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1f 3

INSTRUCTIONS FOR URMET DOMUS DEVICE INTERCHANGEABILITY

REPLACING RELAY POWER UNIT Ref. 786/5A AND Ref. 9006/5 WITH Ref. 786/15

REPLACING RELAY POWER UNIT Ref. 786/5A AND Ref. 9006/5 WITH Ref. 786/15
The 786/15 relay power unit can replace the following obsolete models:
Ref. 9006/5
Ref. 786/38A
Follow the following diagrams according to the type of system in which the power unit is being replaced for correct connection.

ELECTRONIC CALL INTERCOM SYSTEMS AND DOOR UNIT


With single calls from door unit and door phones with buzzer (differential call)

Ref.786/5A

Ref.786/15

1A

1P

2P

-J

-P

~0

PS

-J

~0

PS

C1

C2

C2

~12 SN1 SN2

C1 PS2 ~12 SN2

~18

SN1

With single calls from door unit and door phones without buzzer.

Ref.786/5A

Ref.786/15

1A

1P

2P

-J

-P

-J

~0

PS

C1

C2

~0

PS

C2

C1

~12 SN1 SN2 ~18

PS2 ~12 SN2 SN1

With single call from door unit and door phones with buzzer.

Ref.786/5A

1A

1P

2P

-J

-P

~0

PS

C1

C2

-J

~0

PS

C2

C1

~12 SN1 SN2 ~18

PS2 ~12 SN2 SN1

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

Ref.786/15

4 sec.1f

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

TRADITIONAL CALL INTERCOM SYSTEMS AND DOOR UNIT


With single calls from door unit and door phones with buzzer.

Ref.786/5A

Ref.786/15

1P

2P

Ref.9006/5

1P

2P

Ref.786/15

-6

-J

-P

~0

PS

C1

C2

-J

~0

PS

C2

C1

~0

~0

+6

-J

~12 SN1 SN2 ~18

PS2 ~12 SN2 SN1

~12 SN1 SN2 ~18

PS

C2

C1

PS2 ~12 SN2 SN1

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

1A

INSTRUCTIONS FOR URMET DOMUS DEVICE INTERCHANGEABILITY

REPLACING RELAY POWER UNIT Ref. 786/5A AND Ref. 9006/5 WITH Ref. 786/15

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1f 5

INSTRUCTIONS FOR URMET DOMUS DEVICE INTERCHANGEABILITY

REPLACING VIDEO DOOR PHONE POWER UNIT Ref. 789 WITH Ref. 789/1A
REPLACING VIDEO DOOR PHONE POWER UNIT Ref. 789
AND Ref. 789/1A WITH Ref. 789/5B

REPLACING VIDEO DOOR PHONE POWER UNIT Ref. 789 WITH Ref. 789/1A
The 789/1A power unit can replace the obsolete 789 model.
The terminals correspond as follows:
Ref. 789
POWER

OUTPUTS

Ref. 789/1A

110

230

230

~0

~0

~12

~12

~A

~A

~B

~B

+6

+6

-6

-6

PS

PS

SN

SN

1/~

1/~

R1

R1

R2

R2

+TC

+TC

AP

AP

SE1

SE1

SE2

SE2

+6J

+6J

-J

-J

REPLACING VIDEO DOOR PHONE POWER UNIT Ref. 789 AND Ref. 789/1A WITH Ref. 789/5B
The 789/5B video power unit has the following characteristics:
1) It must be powered at 230 V exclusively.
2) It can only be used in video door phone systems with electronic call system (it only has a PS output, no SN output).
3) It can power only two video door phones in stand-by mode (V2).
4) It can power up to 10 video distributors.
5) It is not provided with a -J output for intercom service.
It can therefore replace the Ref. 789 and Ref. 789/1A power units only in systems with the characteristics and limitations above.
In these cases, the terminals correspond as follows:

SV102-1814B

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

POWER SUPPLY
Ref.789/5B
(230V)
MAINS ~
MAINS ~

POWER SUPPLY
Ref.789(230V)
Ref.789/1
(110/230V)
VOLTAGE
UNIT

6 sec.1f

ELECTRONIC
UNIT

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

INSTRUCTIONS FOR URMET DOMUS DEVICE INTERCHANGEABILITY

REPLACING DOOR PHONE POWER UNIT Ref. 1840/22 WITH Ref. 1090/850
REPLACING DOOR PHONE POWER UNIT Ref. 787/4 WITH Ref. 786/4

REPLACING DOOR PHONE POWER UNIT Ref. 1840/22 WITH Ref. 1090/850
The 1090/850 power unit can replace the obsolete 1840/22 model.
The terminals correspond as follows:

POWER

OUTPUTS

Ref. 1840/22

Ref. 1090/850

Notes

~230

~230

~24

Not available

(#)

~24

Not available

(#)

+ (12)

Vout

- (12)

GND

P1

P2

Remove the
jumper between
terminals
P1 and P2 (*)

(#) If a 24Vac output is needed, use a transformer with minimum output current of 0.2 Aac
() because the device 1840/22 actually outputs approximate 14.3 Vdc

REPLACING DOOR PHONE POWER UNIT Ref. 787/4 WITH Ref. 786/4
The Ref. 786/4 power unit can replace the obsolete Ref. 787/4 model.
The terminals correspond as follows:
Ref. 787/4
POWER

110

110

230

230

~0

~0

~12

~12

+6

+6

-6

-6

-J

-J

PS

PS

PS1

PS1

1/~

1/~

SN

SN

NA

NA

NC

NC

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

OUTPUTS

Ref. 786/4

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1f 7

REPLACING TWO-CHANNEL SYSTEM DOOR PHONE APARTMENT STATION


Ref. 4340/23 WITH Ref. 752/23

REPLACING DOOR PHONE TWO-CHANNEL SYSTEM POWER UNIT Ref. 4340/20 WITH Ref. 752/20
REPLACING TWO-CHANNEL SYSTEM DOOR PHONE APARTMENT STATION Ref. 4340/23 WITH
Ref. 752/23
The Ref. 752/20 power unit can replace the obsolete Ref. 4340/20 model.
The Ref. 752/23 two-channel door phone apartment station replaces the Ref. 4340/23 model.
The correspondence between device terminals is shown in the following diagram.

SC101-0211B
TO THE FOLLOWING INDOOR SETS

INDOOR SET
Ref.4340/23

INDOOR SET
Ref.752/23

(V D.007)

-/~
+/~

(V X.006)

(VD.007)

(C 4.007)
TO THE
FOLLOWING
MODULE

PUSH
BUTTONS
MODULE

Name tag
lighting

G/T
~12
~0
G/T

~12
~0
U4
U3
U2
U1

KOMBI FREE-HANDS PANEL


AND DOOR UNIT

Loudspeaker
module

To bulb
transformer

~0
~12
+M
+

4340/27 PANEL
AND DOOR UNIT
MAINS ~

U2
U1
G/T
G/T2
L
Microphone
module

POWER SUPPLY
Ref.752/20

POWER SUPPLY
Ref.4340/20

To bulb
transformer

INSTRUCTIONS FOR URMET DOMUS DEVICE INTERCHANGEABILITY

REPLACING DOOR PHONE TWO-CHANNEL SYSTEM POWER UNIT Ref. 4340/20


WITH Ref. 752/20

To bulb
transformer

(C 4.009)

(C 4.009)

twisted
coupled
wires

twisted
coupled
wires

2
1

Name tag
lighting

(C 4.009)
twisted
coupled wires

~0
~12
Lock
Release

ELECTRIC LOCK

MAINS ~

~
MAIN ~

(VX.014)
~
TRANSFORMER

ELECTRIC LOCK

ELECTRIC LOCK

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

C4.007 - Sinthesi models only:


See instruction booklet provided with
product for connecting terminals G/T,
~0 and ~12 between modules.
C4.009 - IMPORTANT Use cord pairs.
VD.007 = Floor call button.
VX.006 - See the instruction book
provided with the product for fitting
the accessory in the device.
VX.014 - Dusk switch or similar device
for switching lights on, where
relevant.

8 sec.1f

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

REPLACING VIDEO DOOR PHONE POWER UNIT Ref. 7073, Ref. 7073/1 AND Ref. 7073/2 WITH
Ref. 789/1A
The Ref. 789/1 A power unit replace the previous Ref. 7073, Ref. 7073/1 and Ref. 7073/2 power units in all systems except for:
1) Systems with Vidicon camera: Mod. 789 power units are not provided with + LA, -LA outputs for powering lamps.
2) Continuously powered systems.
3) Systems with more than 20 video door phones monitors in stand-by: in this case use a 6 Vdc power unit providing suitable output current
considering that the average consumption of a video door phone in stand-by is 60 mAcc.
4) Systems with simultaneous operation of 2 or more video door phones: in this case, power each supplementary video door phone using local
power unit Ref. 789/2.
5) The Ref. 789/1 video power unit (110-230V) consists of two units connected using the specific wire and plugs (C).
The power unit Ref. is 789/101 (110-230V).
The electronic unit Ref. is 789/102.
Jumpers ~0, ~A and ~12, ~B are pre-fitted.

POWER SUPPLY
Ref.789/1
(110/230V)
MAINS ~

VIDEO
POWER SUPPLY
Ref.7073 OR
7073/1

INSTRUCTIONS FOR URMET DOMUS DEVICE INTERCHANGEABILITY

REPLACING VIDEO DOOR PHONE POWER UNIT Ref. 7073, Ref. 7073/1
AND Ref. 7073/2 WITH Ref. 789/1A

MAINS ~
VIDEO
POWER SUPPLY
Ref.7073/2
MAINS ~

VIDEO
POWER SUPPLY
Ref.7073/1

CALL
GENERATOR
Ref.787/1

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

MAINS ~

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1f 9

SCOUT AND CAMERA SYSTEMS (CCD CAMERA ONLY)


The Ref. 787/1 tone generator is not used because it is replaced by a generator inside the Ref. 789/1 A power unit.
Connect jumpers SE1, ~12 during installation.

SV102-0583A

TONE
GENERATOR
Ref.787/1

POWER SUPPLY
Ref.789/1A
(110/230V)

CCD TV CAMERA UNIT


PUSH BUTTON
PANEL

ELECTRONIC
UNIT

L.U.

LOCK
RELEASE
TV CAMERA UNIT

INSTRUCTIONS FOR URMET DOMUS DEVICE INTERCHANGEABILITY

REPLACING VIDEO DOOR PHONE POWER UNIT Ref. 7073, Ref. 7073/1
AND Ref. 7073/2 WITH Ref. 789/1A

ELECTRIC
LOCK
MAINS ~

MAINS ~
VOLTAGE
UNIT

VIDEO
POWER SUPPLY
Ref.7073/1

SENTINEL, EXPLORER AND RANGER AND CAMERA SYSTEMS (CCD CAMERA ONLY)

SV102-0582A
POWER SUPPLY
Ref.789/1A
(110/230V)

MAINS ~

CCD TV CAMERA UNIT


PUSH BUTTON
PANEL
TV CAMERA UNIT

L.U.

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

ELECTRONIC
UNIT

VIDEO
POWER SUPPLY
Ref.7073/1
MAINS ~

VOLTAGE
UNIT

LOCK
RELEASE

10 sec.1f

ELECTRIC
LOCK

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

SENTINEL, EXPLORER AND RANGER WITH SWITCHBOARD AND CAMERA SYSTEMS (CCD CAMERA
ONLY)
Cut the existing jumpers between terminals ~ A, ~0 and between ~B, ~12 of the Ref. 789/1A power unit during installation.

SV102-0584A
POWER SUPPLY Ref.786/3
NOTE
SINGLES COMMONS
STANDARD
HOUSE
SWITCHBOARD

MAINS ~
POWER SUPPLY
Ref.789/1A (110/230V)

CCD TV CAMERA UNIT

TV CAMERA UNIT

L.U.

PUSH BUTTON
PANEL

ELECTRONIC
UNIT

LOCK
RELEASE
ELECTRIC
LOCK

INSTRUCTIONS FOR URMET DOMUS DEVICE INTERCHANGEABILITY

REPLACING VIDEO DOOR PHONE POWER UNIT Ref. 7073, Ref. 7073/1
AND Ref. 7073/2 WITH Ref. 789/1A

MAINS ~
MAINS ~
VIDEO
POWER SUPPLY
Ref.7073/1

VOLTAGE
UNIT

SENTINEL, EXPLORER AND RANGER AND CAMERA SYSTEMS (VIDICON CAMERA)


The Ref. 789/1A power unit is not provided with +LA and -LA outputs. An auxiliary ~24 V transformer, minimum 24 W (not included), and
Ref. 788/5 control relay is needed to power the lights.

SV102-0655A
POWER SUPPLY
Ref.789/1
(110/230V)

MAINS ~
VIDEO
POWER SUPPLY
Ref.7073/1

VIDICON TYPE
TV CAMERA

TV CAMERA UNIT

L.U.

PUSH BUTTON
PANEL

MAINS ~

ELECTRONIC
UNIT

MAINS ~
LOCK
RELEASE
RELAY
TRANSFORMER
Ref.9332/5 24V~ 25W

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

ELECTRIC
LOCK

sec.1f 11

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

VOLTAGE
UNIT

INSTRUCTIONS FOR URMET DOMUS DEVICE INTERCHANGEABILITY

REPLACING DOOR PHONE POWER UNITS Ref. 9006/1, 9006/2, 9006/14


AND 9006/22 WITH Ref. 786/11

REPLACING DOOR PHONE POWER UNITS Ref. 9006/1, 9006/2, 9006/14 AND 9006/22 WITH
Ref. 786/11
The Ref. 786/11 power unit can replace the following obsolete models:
Ref. 9006/1
Ref. 9006/2
Ref. 9006/14
Ref. 9006/22
The terminals correspond as follows:
Ref. 9006/1
POWER

~0

~220

~230

~0

~0

~12

~12

+6

+6

-6

-6

-J

-J

Ref. 9006/2

Ref. 786/11

~0

~220

~230

OUTPUTS

POWER

OUTPUTS

POWER

Ref. 786/11

~0

~0

~12

~12

+6

+6

-6

-6

Ref. 9006/14

Ref. 786/11

Ref. 786/12 ()

~0

~110

Not available

~110

~220

~230

Not available

~240

Not available

Not available

OUTPUTS

~0

~0

~0

~12

~12

~12

~18

Not available

Not available

+6

+6

+6

-6

-6

-6

-J

-J

-J

Notes

(#)

() Not available in Italy.


(#) If a 18Vac output is needed, use a transformer with minimum output current of 0.5 Aac and connect as shown in the attached diagram:
18Vca

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

MAINS~

~0
~12
-J
-6
+6
~
MAINS~
~

12 sec.1f

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

Ref. 9006/22

Ref. 786/11

Ref. 786/12 ()

~0

POWER

OUTPUTS

~110

Not available

~110

~220

~230

Not available

~240

Not available

Not available

~0

~0

~0

~12

~12

~12

~24

Not available

Not available

+6

+6

+6

-6

-6

-6

-J

-J

-J

Notes

(#)

() Not available in Italy.


(#) If a 24Vac output is needed, use a transformer with minimum output current of 0.5 Aac and connect as shown in the attached diagram:
24Vca
MAINS~

~0
~12
-J
-6
+6
MAINS~

INSTRUCTIONS FOR URMET DOMUS DEVICE INTERCHANGEABILITY

REPLACING DOOR PHONE POWER UNITS Ref. 9006/1, 9006/2, 9006/14


AND 9006/22 WITH Ref. 786/11

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1f 13

INSTRUCTIONS FOR URMET DOMUS DEVICE INTERCHANGEABILITY

REPLACING SWITCHBOARD SYSTEM POWER UNIT Ref. 9006/3 WITH Ref. 786/3A
REPLACING DOOR PHONE POWER UNIT Ref. 9008/14 WITH Ref. 786/38A
REPLACING DOOR UNIT Ref. 5150/500 WITH Ref. 1128/500

REPLACING SWITCHBOARD SYSTEM POWER UNIT Ref. 9006/3 WITH Ref. 786/3A
The Ref. 786/3A power unit can replace the obsolete 9006/3 model.
The terminals correspond as follows:
Ref. 9006/3

POWER

OUTPUTS

Ref. 786/3

~0

~110

Not available

~220

~230

~240

Not available

~0

~0

~12

~12

-15

-15

+15

+15

REPLACING DOOR PHONE POWER UNIT Ref. 9008/14 WITH Ref. 786/38A
The Ref. 786/38A power unit can replace the obsolete 9008/14 model.
The terminals correspond as follows:
Ref. 9008/14

POWER

OUTPUTS

Ref. 786/38A

~0

~110

~110

~220

~230

~240

Not available

~0

~0

~12

~12

~18

~18

+6

+6

-6

-6

-J

-J

REPLACING DOOR UNIT Ref. 5150/500 WITH Ref. 1128/500


Ref. 5150/500

Ref. 1128/500

+
-

1A

1A

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

14 sec.1f

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

REPLACING RELAY BOXES Ref. 788/21, Ref. 788/11, Ref. 4340/11 AND Ref. 4520/10 WITH
Ref. 788/52
The 788/52 relay box can replace the following obsolete models:
Ref. 788/11
Ref. 788/21
Ref. 4340/11
Ref. 4520/10

Ref. 788/21

Ref. 788/52

~12 (R1-1)

12~

CA

CA

0~

0~

2-7

S1

S1

S2

S2

S3

S3

S4

S4

S5

S5

S6

S6

Ref. 788/11

Ref. 788/52

~12 - R1 - 1

12~

2-7

~0

0~

CA

CA

S1

S1

S2 - S3

S3

Ref. 4340/11

Ref. 788/52

~12

12~

~0

0~

CA

CA

S1

S1

S3

S3

Ref. 4520/10

Ref. 788/52

R1

15

15

S1

S1

S2

S3

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

The terminals correspond as follows:

INSTRUCTIONS FOR URMET DOMUS DEVICE INTERCHANGEABILITY

REPLACING RELAY BOXES Ref. 788/21, Ref. 788/11, Ref. 4340/11 AND Ref. 4520/10
WITH Ref. 788/21

sec.1f 15

INSTRUCTIONS FOR URMET DOMUS DEVICE INTERCHANGEABILITY

REPLACING RELAY BOXES Ref. 9332/1, Ref. 4330/31 and Ref. 788/1 WITH Ref. 788/1
REPLACING SUPPLEMENTARY VIDEO DOOR PHONE POWER UNIT Ref. 7073/5A
WITH Ref. 789/2

REPLACING RELAY BOXES Ref. 9332/1, Ref. 4330/31 AND Ref. 788/1 WITH Ref. 788/1
The Ref. 788/51 relay box can replace the obsolete 9332/1 model.
The terminals correspond as follows:
Ref. 4330/31 Ref. 9332/1 Ref. 788/1 Ref. 788/51
2P

2S

4P

4S

AP/P

AP

AP/S

3P

10

10

10

11

11

11

3S

12

12

12

13

13

13

14

14

14

15

15

15

PUL/P

SN1

SN1

SN1

PUL/P

SN2

SN2

SN2

C1

C1

A
B

SN

C2

C2

~12

~12

~0

~0

Note : Terminals C1, C2, ~12 of relay Ref. 788/51 must be connected together by jumpers and connected to ~12.
Note : Terminal not present in Ref. 9332/1 and Ref. 788/51. Add power wire ~0.

REPLACING SUPPLEMENTARY VIDEO DOOR PHONE POWER UNIT Ref. 7073/5A WITH
Ref. 789/2
The Ref. 789/2 power unit can replace the obsolete Ref. 7073/5 model.
The terminals correspond as follows:
Ref. 7073/5
POWER

~110

Not available

~230

~230

R2 in

R2 in

R2 out

R2 out

RL

RL

R1

R1

V2

V2

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

OUTPUTS

Ref. 789/2

16 sec.1f

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

REPLACING RELAY BOX Ref. 9330 (II SERIES) AND Ref. 788/30 WITH Ref. 788/52

REPLACING RELAY BOX Ref. 9332/5 AND Ref. 788/5 WITH Ref. 788/52
The Ref. 788/52 relay box can replace the obsolete 9332/5 and 788/5 model.
The terminals correspond as follows:

RELAY

CONTACTS

Ref. 9332/5

Ref. 788/5

Ref. 788/52

14

14

14

15

15

15

S1

S2

S3

S4

S5

S6

REPLACING RELAY BOX Ref. 9330 (II SERIES) AND Ref. 788/30 WITH Ref. 788/52
The Ref. 788/52 relay box can replace the obsolete 9330 II series model (which is not provided with a 150 ohm resistor in series with terminal
12) and 788/30 model.
The terminals correspond as follows:

RELAY

Ref. 788/30

Ref. 788/52

14

14

14

15

15

15

S1

S2

S3

S4

S5

S6

10

10

11

11

12

12

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

CONTACTS

Ref. 9330 (II series)

INSTRUCTIONS FOR URMET DOMUS DEVICE INTERCHANGEABILITY

REPLACING RELAY BOX Ref. 9332/5 AND Ref. 788/5 WITH Ref. 788/52

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1f 17

INSTRUCTIONS FOR URMET DOMUS DEVICE INTERCHANGEABILITY

REPLACING RELAY BOX Ref. 9332/8 AND Ref. 788/8 WITH Ref. 788/58
REPLACING 12VAC TRANSFORMER Ref. 9000/20 WITH Ref. 9000/230

REPLACING RELAY BOX Ref. 9332/8 AND Ref. 788/8 WITH Ref. 788/58
The Ref. 788/58 relay box can replace the obsolete 9332/8 and 788/8 model.
The terminals correspond as follows:
Ref. 9332/8

Ref. 788/8

AP

AP

AP

1I

1I

1I

2I

-I

API

AP

AP

II

II

1II

II

2II

II

-II

-II
II

-II
II

APII

AP

AP

III

III

1III

III

2III

III

-III

III

III

III

III

AP

AP

APIII

1IV

1IV

1IV

IV

IV

2IV

IV

IV

- IV

2
-

IV

AP

IV

AP

APIV

SN1

SN1

SN1

SN2

SN2

SN2

SN3

SN3

SN3

SN4

SN4

SN4

~0

~0

~12

~12

C1

C1

C2

C2

Note

Ref. 788/58

: Terminals C1, C2, ~12 of relay Ref. 788/58 must be connected together by jumpers and connected to ~12.

REPLACING 12VAC TRANSFORMER Ref. 9000/20 WITH Ref. 9000/230


The 9000/230 transformer can replace the obsolete 9000/20 model.
The terminals correspond as follows:

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

POWER

OUTPUTS

Ref. 9000/20

Ref. 9000/230

~0

Ref. 9000/110 ()
0

~110

Not available

~110

~220

~230

Not available

~240

Not available

Not available

~0

~0

~0

~12

~12

~12

() Not available in Italy.

18 sec.1f

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

INSTRUCTIONS FOR URMET DOMUS DEVICE INTERCHANGEABILITY

REPLACING RELAY BOX Ref. 9332/5 AND Ref. 788/5 WITH Ref. 788/52
REPLACING RELAY BOX Ref. 9330 (II SERIES) AND Ref. 788/30 WITH Ref. 788/52

REPLACING RELAY BOX Ref. 788/4 WITH Ref. 788/54

POWER

COLUMN

INPUT
(A, B, C, D)

POWER

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

Ref. 788/4

Ref. 788/54

GND

GND

IN H

IN H

~B

~B

~A

~A

+TC

+TC

R2

R2

R1

R1

R2

R2

R1

R1

V5

V5

V3

V3

+6

+6

-6

-6

+TC

+TC

R1

R1

V5

V5

V3

V3

SE

SE

~0

~0

~12

~12

C1

C1

SN1

SN1

C2

C2

SN2

SN2

C3

C3

SN3

SN3

C4

C4

SN4

SN4

~12

~12

~0

~0

+6

+6

-6

-6

AP

AP

SE

SE

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

The Ref. 788/54 relay box can replace the obsolete 788/4 model.
The terminals correspond as follows:

sec.1f 19

INSTRUCTIONS FOR URMET DOMUS DEVICE INTERCHANGEABILITY

REPLACEMENT OPTIONS FOR RANGER, EXPLORER, VEDETTE AND SENTINEL


IN TRADITIONAL CALL SYSTEM VIDEO DOOR PHONES SYSTEMS

REPLACEMENT OPTIONS FOR RANGER, EXPLORER, VEDETTE AND SENTINEL IN TRADITIONAL


CALL SYSTEM VIDEO DOOR PHONES SYSTEMS
RANGER VIDEO DOOR PHONES
WINFLAT+ BRACKET Ref. 1202/590 FOR ADAPTING COAX VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS
Ranger video door phones Ref. 1201/1 (and respective brackets Ref. 1201/90) can be replaced in traditional call video door phone systems with
Atlantico video door phones Ref. 1702/1 and specific bracket Ref. 1202/590.
The terminals on Ref. 1202/590 brackets have the same numbers as the Ref. 1201/90 brackets to replace simply by connecting the wires in the
same way.
Note that the replacement is only possible in systems fitting Ranger basic model Ref. 1201/1 with bracket Ref. 1201/90. It is not possible in
systems with switchboard, special systems and intercom systems because bracket Ref. 1202/590 is not suitable for replacing special brackets
Ref. 1201/91, Ref. 1201/761, Ref. 1201/711, Ref. 1201/731 and Ref. 1201/751.
WINFLAT+ BRACKET Ref. 1202/591 FOR ADAPTING VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS WITHOUT COAXIAL CABLE
Ranger video door phones Ref. 955/5 with brackets Ref. 955/74 can be replaced in 5-wire systems with Atlantico video door phones Ref. 1702/1
using adapter bracket Ref. 1202/591.
Replacement is only possible in basic systems.

EXPLORER, VEDETTE, SENTINEL AND VIDOFONO VIDEO DOOR PHONES


SENTRY VIDEO DOOR PHONE WITH BRACKET Ref. 1704/20A FOR ADAPTING EXPLORER, VEDETTE, SENTINEL AND VIDOFONO
SYSTEMS
EXPLORER, VEDETTE and SENTINEL video door phones can be replaced with SENTRY+ Ref. 1704/20A video door phones in traditional call
video door phone systems.
SENTRY+ Ref. 1704/20A is a video door phone with a 4.5 kinescope screen arranged on the longest side in the horizontal direction.
The SENTRY+ Ref. 1704/20A bracket terminals have the same numbers as the EXPLORER, VEDETTE, SENTINEL and VIDOFONO terminal
boards to simply connect the wires in the same way.
This video door phone can be fitted only in traditional basic systems (with 12Vac call). It is not suitable for use in switchboard or intercom systems
because the bracket is not suitable to replace all versions.
SENTRY+ Ref. 1704/20A is complete with bracket and white. The monitor is a reflex version; brightness and contrast can be adjusted by means
of the controls. The call signal is sent to the buzzer fitted on the bracket. The door lock can be released by pressing the
button. The two
service buttons and can be used to operate accessory circuits.
SENTRY+ Ref. 1704/20A video door phones are used to view the picture from a camera arranged to frame a field with the longest side arranged
vertically. This arrangement causes a 25 to 30% reduction of the framed field with respect to EXPLORER, VEDETTE, SENTINEL and VIDOFONO
video door phones.
TO THE FOLLOWING VIDEO DOOR PHONES
Sentry+

(C3)
(C2)
(C5)
(C9)
(C1)
(C4)
(C7)
(C10)
(C6)
(C8)

Ref.1704/20
[1]
[2]
[6]
[10]
[7]
[9]
[X1]
[X2]
[Y1]
[Y2]

Explorer

Sentinel

Scout

Sentry+
Vedette,Vidofono
Sentinel,Explorer

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

Vedette

Vidofono

RISING COLUMN

Sentry+ video door phone is provided with an additional speaker to considerably increase volume of the call.
Connecting the wires to the system is fast via terminal boards on the bracket to which the video door phone is then fitted.

20 sec.1f

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

200 mm

99 mm

230 mm

Service button
Service button
Door opener button
Call volume
Contrast adjustment
Brightness adjustment
The device is provided with the following controls:
).
One door opening button (
Two service buttons (
and ) which can be used, for example, to switch on the staircase lights, open an additional lock or to implement
automatic switch-on function.
Two potentiometers for adjusting picture brightness ( ) and contrast ( ).
One switch for three-position call tone volume adjustment ( ) (minimum, medium and maximum volume).
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Power voltage:
16 18.5Vdc
Intake:
Working:
max. 0.65A
Stand-by:
0A
Power:
Working:
max. 12W
CCIR version:
Vertical frequency
50Hz 2Hz
Horizontal frequency: 15625 400Hz
EIA version:
Vertical frequency
60Hz 2Hz
Horizontal frequency: 15734 400Hz
Video signal:
1Vpp 75 nominal
1Vpp. -6 dB minimum
Kinescope:
4.5 90 neck 20mm
Switch-on delay:
7 max
X-rays:
none
Operating temperature range:
-5 + 50C
Humidity:
max. 90% RH

INSTRUCTIONS FOR URMET DOMUS DEVICE INTERCHANGEABILITY

REPLACEMENT OPTIONS FOR RANGER, EXPLORER, VEDETTE AND SENTINEL


IN TRADITIONAL CALL SYSTEM VIDEO DOOR PHONES SYSTEMS

TERMINAL BOARD
1
Speaker signal
CA
Call signal
2
Microphone signal
6
Power ground
10
9
Door opener control
X1
Service button terminals
X2
Y1
Service button terminals
Y2
R3
Silent video on
R1
Video power negative
R2
Video power positive
RT
Secondary monitor power positive
Composite video signal for second monitor in-out connection
V4
(connect a 75 resistor between V4 and V5 if not present)
V5
Video signal earth
V3
Composite video signal

INSTALLATION
Arrange the duct so that it ends in correspondence with the input hole
on the bracket and proceed as follows:
1) Fasten the bracket to the wall at the height from the floor shown by
means of the four screws.
2) Connect the wires to the specific terminals.
3) Extract the retainer hook A by inserting the tip of a screwdriver and
pulling the hook downwards.
4) Check that switch on back of video door phone is in the A
position.

1,55 m

Bracket

A
B
5) Fasten the monitor to the bracket.
6) Fasten the monitor by pushing the retainer hook A upwards.

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.1f 21

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

}
}

INSTRUCTIONS FOR URMET DOMUS DEVICE INTERCHANGEABILITY

REPLACEMENT OF SENTRY VIDEO DOOR PHONES WITH ARTICO


SENTRY+ BRACKET REPLACEMENT

REPLACEMENT OF SENTRY VIDEO DOOR


PHONES WITH ARTICO
Using the bracket without circuit for the Artico video door phone
Rf. 1705/100 it is possible to replace the Sentry video door phones in
any type of system. Proceed as follows:
1. Remove the Sentry video door phone from the bracket.
2. Disconnect all conductors from the Sentry bracket terminals.
3. Loosen the 4 fastening screws from the wall bracket
4. Remove the printed circuit from the Sentry bracket by loosening
the 2 fastening screws (A).

SENTRY+ BRACKET REPLACEMENT


Procure a plastic support Ref.1704/102 and the Artico bracket
corresponding to the system in use in the installation to replace a faulty
Sentry+ video door phone bracket:
Coax
Ref. 1705/90
5 wires
Ref. 1705/955
Then proceed as follows:
Remove the printed circuit from the Artico bracket.
Artico bracket

Sentry bracket

A
Fasten the printed circuit on the plastic support Ref. 1704/102.
5. Fit the printed circuit on the Artico bracket Ref. 1705/100 using the
2 screws provided (screws B)
6. Fasten the Artico bracket to the wall using the 4 screws fastening
the Sentry bracket

Plastic support
Ref. 1704/102

Bracket Ref. 1705/100

B
7. Reconnect the wires to the specific terminals.
8. Insert the Artico video door phone on the bracket fastening it with
the hook A.

Remove the Sentry video door phone from the bracket.


Disconnect all conductors from the Sentry bracket terminals.
Loosen the 4 fastening screws from the wall bracket.
Fasten the plastic support on the printed circuit to the wall.
Reconnect the wires to the specific terminals.
Fit the video door phone on the bracket.

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

Ref. 1705/1

Bracket
Ref. 1705/100
A

22 sec.1f

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

INSTRUCTIONS FOR URMET DOMUS DEVICE INTERCHANGEABILITY

REPLACING DOOR PHONE POWER UNIT Ref. 786/1 WITH Ref. 786/11
REPLACING DOOR PHONE POWER UNIT Ref. 786/14 WITH Ref. 786/11

REPLACING DOOR PHONE POWER UNIT Ref. 786/1 WITH Ref. 786/11
The Ref. 786/11 power unit can replace the obsolete 786/1 model.
Ref. 786/11

Ref. 786/1
POWER

OUTPUTS

~230

~230

+6

+6

-6

-6

-J

-J

~0

~0

~12

~12

PS

PS

REPLACING DOOR PHONE POWER UNIT Ref. 786/14 WITH Ref. 786/11
The Ref. 786/11 power unit can replace the obsolete 786/14 model.
The terminals correspond as follows:
Ref. 786/1
POWER

OUTPUTS

Ref. 786/11

Ref. 786/12 (*)

~230

~230

Not available

~110

Not available

~110

+6

+6

+6

-6

-6

-6

-J

-J

-J

~0

~0

~0

~12

~12

~12

~18

(#)

(#)

PS

PS

PS

() Not available in Italy.


(#) If a 18Vac output is needed, use a transformer with minimum output current of 0.5 Aac and connect as shown in the attached diagram:

18Vca
MAINS~

~0
~12
-J
-6
+6
~
MAINS~

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

sec.1f 23

REPLACING SCAITEL VIDE DOOR PHONE


Mod.Atlantico (A)

Mod.Artico (A)

Mod.Scaitel (B)

Ref.1702/1

Ref.1705/1

Ref.1732/1
Ref.1132/1
Ref.1132/55

BLACK/WHITE

Video door phone

Bracket

Ref.1202/90

Ref.1705/90

Ref.1732/91

COLOUR

Video door phone

Ref.1702/40

--

Ref.1732/41
Ref.1132/1
Ref.1132/55

Bracket

Ref.1202/90

--

Ref.1732/91

SCAITEL
VIDEO DOOR PHONE
VIDEO MODULE DOOR PHONE

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS

INSTRUCTIONS FOR URMET DOMUS DEVICE INTERCHANGEABILITY

REPLACING SCAITEL VIDE DOOR PHONE

24 sec.1f

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

EASIVOICE

(REV.A)

BASIC DIAGRAMS

SECTION 2

EASIVOICE SYSTEM

EASIVOICE
SYSTEM

Download from:
www.urmetdomus.com
Technical Manuals area
DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.2 1

DOOR PHONE AND VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEM - DIAGRAM - Section 2

SECTION 2 CONTENTS
EASIVOICE
DOOR PHONE AND VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEM - DIAGRAM

Diagram

Sec.

Pag.

EASIVOICE SYSTEM
ELECTRONIC INTERCOM SYSTEM Mod. 926
SYSTEM FEATURES.............................................................................................................................................................................2 ................ 3
EQUIPMENT ..........................................................................................................................................................................................2 ................ 3
INTERCOM DOOR PHONE FEATURES...............................................................................................................................................2 ................ 3
Installation ..........................................................................................................................................................................................2 ................ 3
PUSH BUTTON PANEL AND AMPLIFIED LOUDSPEAKING UNIT......................................................................................................2 ................ 8
POWER SUPPLY Ref. 926/2 .................................................................................................................................................................2 ................ 4
Features .............................................................................................................................................................................................2 ................ 5
Technical data ....................................................................................................................................................................................2 ................ 5
FUNCTIONS...........................................................................................................................................................................................2 ................ 5
Single call ...........................................................................................................................................................................................2 ................ 5
Redial reservation...............................................................................................................................................................................2 ................ 5
Clearing the line..................................................................................................................................................................................2 ................ 5
Conference call...................................................................................................................................................................................2 ................ 6
Follow-me ...........................................................................................................................................................................................2 ................ 6
General calls (only from authorized intercom door phone).................................................................................................................2 ................ 6
Answering a call from the outdoor station...........................................................................................................................................2 ................ 6
PROGRAMMING....................................................................................................................................................................................2 ................ 6
INSTALLATION ......................................................................................................................................................................................2 ................ 6
Wires laying ........................................................................................................................................................................................2 ................ 6
Wire section ........................................................................................................................................................................................2 ................ 7
Connection to the general call unit .....................................................................................................................................................2 ................ 7
Connection to the call station .............................................................................................................................................................2 ................ 7
Installations with one call key .............................................................................................................................................................2 ................ 7
Installations with two or more call keys...............................................................................................................................................2 ................ 7

BASIC SYSTEM DIAGRAMS


INTERCOM CONNECTION OF MAXIMUM 25 INTERCOM DOOR PHONES
Possibility of general call service by means of loudspeakers......................................................................... SC101-0313E ................2 ................ 8
INTERCOM CONNECTION OF MAXIMUM 97 INTERCOM DOOR PHONES
Possibility of general call service by means of loudspeakers......................................................................... SC101-0315E ................2 ............. 10
INTERCOM CONNECTION OF MAXIMUM 16 INTERCOM DOOR PHONES
With possibility to answer to 1 outdoor station
All the intercom house phones are called in parallel from the outdoor station ..............................................SC101-0316G ................2 ............. 12
INTERCOM CONNECTION OF MAXIMUM 16 INTERCOM DOOR PHONES
With possibility to answer to 1 outdoor station The intercoms are divided in two groups of 8.
The outdoor station is equipped with two keys:
with one of them it calls in parallel the 8 intercoms of group I, with the second one those of group II ..........SC101-0361G ................2 ............. 14
INTERCOM CONNECTION OF MAXIMUM 16 INTERCOM DOOR PHONES
With possibility to answer to 1 outdoor station. The intercoms are called separately from theoutdoor station.
Possibility of paging service by means of loudspeakers ................................................................................ SC101-0382F ................2 ............. 16

2 sec.2

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

ELECTRONIC INTERCOM SYSTEM Mod. 926

EQUIPMENT

Electronic intercom Mod. 926 can be installed in any building for


a simple and efficient phonic communication system capable of
supporting several communications simultaneously.

The device forming part of the system are as follows:


Intercom door phone
Intercom door phone and with connection
to loudspeaking unit
Table kit
Power supply for electronic Intercom

Up to 97 intercom door phone can be interconnected. There is no


centralized device to manage the system since each intercom contains
the necessary electronics for handling a dialogue with the rest of the
installation.

Ref. 926/1
Ref. 926/2
Ref. 926/4
Ref. 926/3

There can be up to four independent communications simultaneously.

INTERCOM DOOR PHONE FEATURES

A general call can be made through an independent fifth phonic


channel.

The intercom door phone can either be installed on a wall or on a


table.
Adaptation kit Ref. 926/4, consisting of an inclined stand to facilitate
the use of the intercom itself, is available for table installations.

Programming is very easy and does not require having to open the
intercom door phone.
There are two versions of the intercom door phone which can be easily
distinguished one from the other by the presence or absence of the
door-opener key:
Intercom model
Ref. 926/1
Intercom model that can be connected to
a loudspeaking unit
Ref. 926/2

INSTALLATION
WALL SET

Mod. 926

EASIVOICE
SYSTEM FEATURES - EQUIPMENT - INTERCOM DOOR PHONE FEATURES

ELECTRONIC INTERCOM SYSTEM

ELECTRONIC INTERCOM SYSTEM Mod. 926

There are two versions:


Connection to 97 intercoms max. only with intercom service.
Connection to 25 intercoms max. with intercom service and with
possibility of answer to outdoor station.

SYSTEM FEATURES
The following is a summary of system features:
Connection of a maximum of 97 intercom door phones.
Very easy programming of the door phone codes that can be made
directly from outside (of the same door phone).
4 simultaneous and independent conversations.
Possibility of conference among 4 door phones max.
Possibility of busy line insertion.
Clearing the line (only from an activated door phone).
Possibility to oblige the user to answer.
Possibility to route the call to another door phone (follow-me).
This function - if necessary - can be modified for realizing
automatically the secretary function.
Secretary function, that is the possibility to transfer the incoming
calls from an intercom x to a y one. Anyway y can call x and
the last one can make outgoing calls.
Paging function carried out by means of a 5th independent and
dedicated line, connected to a loudspeaker by means of an amplifier
(only from activated intercom/s).
Possibility of connection to an amplifier able to manage sound and
message diffusion with disk-jockey function (automatic lowering of
the sound diffusion volume during the sounding message).
Possibility to receive door phone calls from a call station appropriately
connected (only for Mod. 926/2).
In case the intercom is already engaged in conversation with another
indoor set, the possible call from the outdoor station is signaled both
visually and acoustically.
Automatic lowering of the sound intensity of the beep on the
loudspeaker when the handset is unhooked and the hook is pressed
with a finger.

about 1,5m

The intercom should be mounted about 1,5m from the floor.


To remove the intercom casing from the base, lift up with a screwdriver
in the area indicated.
Lift off the casing.
Use the screw anchors and screws furnished with the intercom to
fasten the base to the wall.

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

EASIVOICE SYSTEM

The system utilizes a single phonic ground conductor, therefore


it cannot guarantee absolute secrecy of conversation, i.e. during
the course of a conversation, it may be possible to hear another
conversation in course on another line (crosstalk effect) at a
distance. It will be necessary to adopt appropriate measures to
minimize this problem.

sec.2 3

Mod. 926

ELECTRONIC INTERCOM SYSTEM Mod. 926


EASIVOICE
PUSH BUTTON PANEL AND AMPLIFIED LOUDSPEAKING UNIT - POWER SUPPLY Ref. 926/3

ELECTRONIC INTERCOM SYSTEM

TABLE SET

The connection cable wires to the door phone socket wire are very
specific for table installations. They must be connected to the intercom
terminals as follows:
MI
Black
D
Yellow
+12 Red
MF Gray
L1
Green
L2
Blue
L3
Pink
L4
Brown
L5
White
Connection for the loudspeaking unit (Ref. 926/2 only):
CA
Yellow-Gray
2
Pink-Black
1
Yellow-Black
-/~
Black-Gray
AP
Yellow-Pink

For table mounting it is necessary to buy the table kit that includes
stand, cord with socket and accessories Ref. 926/4.

Yellow - Gray
Pink - Black
Yellow - Black
Black - Gray
Yellow - Pink
Proceed as follows:
Remove the intercom casing by means of a screwdriver in the area
indicated, rotating the cover on the two upper hooks.
Release the two side latches E by pressing them from the inside of
zone F.
Fix the plate under the base by means of the proper screws.
Insert under the base, in the proper holes, the two self adhesive
rubbers (included in the socket kit).
Insert the cord with socket and fix it to the hook. Then connect the
system wires to the correspondent terminals of the terminal board.

Black
Yellow
Red
Gray
Green
Blue
Pink
Brown
White

PUSH BUTTON PANEL


LOUDSPEAKING UNIT

AND

AMPLIFIED

The devices normally used in 4+n wire door phone systems can be
employed.

POWER SUPPLY Ref. 926/3


45

h.

75 mm

Sc

mm

6/3

92

EASIVOICE SYSTEM

9
11 0 m
8m m
m

2m

16

This power supply has been designed according to the IEC 12/13
5th Ed. Dec. 1988 International Security Regulations - and is built
following the present market requirements, the tendency of which is to
centralize the electric equipment in proper cabinets.

4 sec.2

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

The power supply 926/3 is set for a medium system of 25 intercoms


(926/1). In case of systems with more intercoms, connect more power
supplies in parallel, up to 4 max. In this case follow carefully the
system schemes.

the intercom is disconnected from the line and it will communicate, on


the data line, the end of the conversation to the caller who, in his turn,
will disconnect his intercom physically and logically from the line. The
handset will be mute until the hanging up.
On the contrary, If the caller hangs up the handset, he will free the line,
physically and logically, and he will communicate to the called party
the end of conversation. This last one, in his turn, will disconnect the
intercom physically.

TECHNICAL DATA
Electrical characteristics
Transformer power:
Powering:
Secondary voltages:

38 VA
110/230 ~
11.5V
24V
24V

0.6 A
40 mA max.
10 mA max.

Powering 11.5 V section:


It supplies powering to the intercoms and max. current of 600 mA;
Phonic line powering section:
It includes 5 identic circuits. Each circuit supplies a constant current
of about 30 mA with max. voltage of 24 V;
Data output:
It supplies a voltage of 24 V with a resistance series 2.2 K per data
wire.
Amplifier output:
On this output the signal coming from the 5th phonic line is injected
and it is uncoupled by means of condenser. The output circuit
includes two schottky diodes with a 150 resistance in parallel.
Operating temperature:
0 C 40C
Dimensions:
Length:
162 mm
Thickness:
75 mm
Width (with side protections):
108 mm
Width (without side protections):
90 mm
Weight:
0.950 Kg
Connections:
by means of terminals with clamping screw

FUNCTIONS
All functions can be activated through the 12-key alphanumeric keypad
located on the base of the intercom:

NOTE:
R = Redial
F = Follow-me

The key located on the upper right of Mod. 926/2 is used for opening
the door. Other functions (clearing a line, general call) can only be
performed from authorized (enabled) intercoms. The activation of
these functions can only be done during the programming phase.
Please consult the chapter on programming for further information.

SINGLE CALL

A conversation cannot last longer than 10 minutes in order to allow


other users access to the phone lines. Once this time has lapsed,
an acoustic end-of-conversation warning signal will be sent to both
intercom door phones.
The communication will be disconnected 10 seconds after the warning
signal.

REDIAL RESERVATION
Caller
If the number called is engaged, an automatic redial reservation can
be activated by pressing the R key before hanging up. Then listen for
the tone:
No tone: automatic redial reservation was accepted hang up.
Persistent busy tone: automatic redial reservation was not accepted
because the number called already has an automatic redial reserved
onto its line from another intercom hang up and try again later.
When the intercom door phone that was reserved to becomes free,
the caller who initiated the reservation will automatically receive a
call-back.
Attention: there will be situations in which the call-back will not take
place. These situations will be described in the Called Party section
below.
Called Party
During the course of a normal conversation, any reservations to the
line will be indicated by a blinking led on the intercom. The user who is
the subject of a reservation has two courses of action:
He can decide a priori to eliminate the reservation by pressing the
R key either during the course of the conversation or immediately
after hanging up (within 5 seconds).
He can decide to talk to whoever had reserved by hanging up and
waiting for the system to automatically set up the communication
and then for his intercom to ring.
If all of the phonic lines are not engaged, this will take place
within 5 seconds after hanging up. If, however, all the lines are
engaged, the system will attempt to establish the communication
every 15 seconds, up to maximum of 10 trials. The reservation will
be canceled if the tenth attempt was also unsuccessful.

CLEARING THE LINE


Caller (only from authorized intercom door phones)
Lift the handset and dial the number of the called party. If this party is
on the line (busy tone is heard and led is off), the line can be cleared
i.e. the conversation in course can be disconnected. To do so, simply
dial the special 00 number.
Conversation will be established with the cleared intercom door phone
within 20 seconds.

Caller
To talk to another intercom station:
Lift the handset.
Dial the TWO DIGIT number of the other-party.
Listen for the tone and observe the led:
Ringing tone: wait for the called party to answer.
Busy tone and led off: the number called is engaged try again
later or activate the automatic redial function or the clear the line
function (if authorized).
Busy tone and led on: the 4 telephone lines are engaged try
again later.

Called Party
A clearing request during the course of a normal conversation will be
identified both acoustically and visually (blinking led).
At this point, the called party will have 20 seconds in which to terminate
the conversation in course.
There are two possible courses of action:
Hang up within 20 seconds. The intercom will ring and when the
handset is lifted, communication will be established with the caller
who had initiated the clearing.
If the called party does not hang up within 20 seconds, he will be
disconnected from his current conversation and connected with the
caller who had requested the clearing.

Called Party
When the phone rings, lift up the handset and begin the conversation.
At the end of the conversation, if the called party hangs up the handset

The line clearing function WILL HAVE NO EFFECT on another


intercom which is also authorized to clear lines or if the intercom is in
communication with the outdoor station.

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.2 5

EASIVOICE SYSTEM

FEATURES

Mod. 926

EASIVOICE
FUNCTIONS

ELECTRONIC INTERCOM SYSTEM

ELECTRONIC INTERCOM SYSTEM Mod. 926

Mod. 926

ELECTRONIC INTERCOM SYSTEM Mod. 926


EASIVOICE
PROGRAMMING - INSTALLATION

ELECTRONIC INTERCOM SYSTEM

CONFERENCE CALL
The conference function can connect up to four different users in one
phonic communication. Only the intercom which made the first call
can call other intercom in the course of a conversation. In order to
include another intercom in the conversation, simply dial the extension
number. One of the following situations will occur:
The intercom door phone called is free: when the handset is lifted,
the called party will be included in the conversation in course.
The intercom door phone is free: if the handset is not lifted within 30
seconds, the call will not go through.
The intercom door phone called is engaged: there will be a busy
tone of a short duration.

FOLLOW-ME
This function allows incoming calls to be routed to another intercom.
Up to a maximum of eight other intercoms can be routed to one
intercom. Several consecutive reroutings of calls from one intercom
can be made to several different intercoms.
How to forward calls from one intercom door phone to another
Go to the other intercom door phone.
Lift the handset of the other intercom.
Press the dedicated F key and dial the number of your intercom
door phone.
Listen for the tone on the handset; one of the following two situations
will take place:
Dial tone: the operation was successful hang up.
Busy tone: calls cannot be routed because calls to 8 other
intercoms have already been forwarded to that intercom hang
up.
How to reset your intercom door phone
Return to your intercom.
Lift the handset.
Press the dedicated F key and dial your own number.
Hang up.
Secretary function
This function permits the user to route his own incoming calls to
another intercom (i.e. the secretary one). All his own incoming calls
are routed to the secretary intercom EXCEPT the call that arrives
from the same secretary. In this way the secretary can, if needed,
announce the calls; anyway it cannot transfer the call. The routed
set can always make outgoing calls (and then it can call again the
person announced by the secretary). This function can be carried
out by modifying the follow me as regard to the last paragraph (the
crossed one).

EASIVOICE SYSTEM

GENERAL CALLS (only from authorized intercom


door phone)
A general call can be made through a loudspeaker connected to a
suitable amplifier.
The general call can take place at the same time as four other
conversations, without interfering with them. General call can only be
made from intercoms which were explicitly defined for making such
calls during the programming phase.
To make a general call:
Lift the handset.
Dial the special 99 number.
Wait for the ding-dong to be generated.
Make the announcement.
Redial the special 99 number.
Hang up.

ANSWERING A CALL FROM THE OUTDOOR


STATION
This feature is only available on Ref. 926/2 intercom door phone.
A call from the outdoor station produces a different acoustic signal
from the normal one and can be easily recognized. Lift the handset to
establish communication; the open-door key can be used to operate
the electric lock at any point.

6 sec.2

When a user, engaged in conversation with the outdoor station,


receives a call from the inside, he visualize the call on the led without
the possibility to be interrupted (not even with the clearing the line
function).
Vice versa, when a user, engaged in conversation with another internal
user, receives a call from an outdoor station, he will see the blinking
led up to the call key is pressed and he will hear an acoustic signal that
indicates the call with more emphasis.

PROGRAMMING
All the intercom door phones are produced and tested by URMET
DOMUS. They are all programmed with the following values during the
testing phase:
Number: 98
General call function disabled: 0
Line clearing disabled: 0
The devices must all be programmed with two digits, e.g. from 01 to
09, from 10 to 19, from 20 to 25, or with any other number from 01 to
97.
These values can be changed at any time through the keypad by
following the procedure described below:
Simultaneously press the R and the F keys for two seconds. If
one or two beeps are heard while the keys are pressed, it means
that the two keys were not pressed simultaneously repeat the
operation.
When the led is lit and a brief acoustic tone is heard, release the two
keys.
Enter the number to be assigned to the intercom.
The led will go off for a short interval and then go on again,
coinciding with a brief acoustic tone.
Set authorization (1) or disable (0) for the general call function.
The led will go off for a short interval and then go on again,
coinciding with a brief acoustic tone.
Set authorization (1) or disable (0) for the line clearing function.
The led goes off definitively, coinciding with a brief acoustic tone.
If the procedure described above is not completed within 30 seconds,
the intercom will return to normal operating conditions, without storing
the setting that were entered.

INSTALLATION
WIRES LAYING
All system intercom door phones must be interconnected in parallel
using 9 wires (or 8 if the general call installation is not provided for).
These wires have the following functions:
1 for the power supply voltage
+ 12
1 for the logical ground
ML
1 for the data line
D
4 for the 4 phonic lines
L1, L2, L3, L4
1 for the general call phonic line (this wire can be
omitted on installations where this feature is not required)
L5
1 for the phonic ground
MF
In addition, installations connected to a Call Station must be considered
4+N additional wires, which increase the number of wires to the
installation to 13+N (where N depends on the number of call keys used
usually 1 or 2).
These 4+N wires are used as follows:
3 for the talk volume (F1, F2 and ground).
1 for the door-opener.
N for the call.
If the GENERAL call amplifier is not used do not connect the wire L5.
The maximum distance between the power supply and the furthest
intercom must be less than 200 meters.
The maximum distance between two intercom door phones to ensure
a relatively low cross-talk effect is 200 meters. The cross-talk effect
increases progressively with an increase in distance.
It is therefore advisable to avoid unnecessary connections distances.
DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

WIRE SECTION
The section of the wires to be used depends on the distance between
the two intercoms furthest from the installation.
Note carefully the following table:
Max distance (meters) 50
Section (mm2)
0,50
R (Ohm/Km)
35

100
0,80
21,8

200
1
17,5

Should it be necessary to have larger installations, it would be possible


to resort to a solution in which more branches lead off from one point,
as illustrated in the figure below. In this case, the cross-talk effect
would remain unchanged within each individual branch ( the maximum
distance between any two intercoms must therefore be less than 200
meters). However, intercoms on different branches would not have any
effect on each other. This type of solution can also be used on normal
installations, i.e. for short distances, to further reduce the cross-talk
effect.

of 926/2 intercoms which can be connected in parallel depends, in


this case, on the total number of intercoms (926/1 + 926/2) in the
installation.
The following table summarizes the situation for standard installations
with just one power supply.
Total numbers
of intercoms
(926/1 + 926/2)

Number of 926/2
which can be connected
to a Call Station
on one call button

1
2
.
.
.
15
16

1
2
.
.
.
15
16

17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25

15
14
14
13
12
12
11
10
10

Mod. 926

EASIVOICE
INSTALLATION

ELECTRONIC INTERCOM SYSTEM

ELECTRONIC INTERCOM SYSTEM Mod. 926

Note that when the total number of intercom door phones in the
installation is less than 16, they can all be type 926/2 and can be
connected to the Call Station on the one call key. As the total number
of intercoms in the installation is increased, the number of 926/2 which
can be connected to a Call Station decreases progressively to 10.

INSTALLATIONS WITH TWO OR MORE CALL KEYS

CONNECTION TO THE GENERAL CALL UNIT


A suitable amplifier must be connected between the A+ and the
A- terminals of the power supply in order to equip the installation
with a general call system. The amplifier must have a 0,775 mV (or
dBm) input with an input impedance greater than 50 Ohm and with
its output power selected in function of the number and power of the
loudspeakers to be used.
It is recommended that the amplifier be placed as close to the power
supply as possible and be connected to it with a shielded cable.

This type of installation is used in small buildings (2/4/8/ apartments)


where intercommunications and the Follow-me feature would be of
interest. In this case, the cable conduit would be 8 (or 9) + 4 + N wires,
which would limit possible applications to small user bases.
Type 926/2 intercoms must be used. They must be grouped in several
groups (usually 1, 2 or 3 units each), each of which is assigned to a call
key. When there is a call, all intercoms within the same group will ring
simultaneously. The first intercom to answer will automatically exclude
the other intercom door phone in that group, thus ensuring secrecy of
conversation.
The table in the previous section remains valid, even though the
number of 926/2 intercoms that are connected to each call key is
generally 1 or at maximum, 2 or 3, in this type of installation.

CONNECTION TO THE CALL STATION

EASIVOICE SYSTEM

Installation can be made with up to two Call Stations with automatic


switching (through a 788/1 relay box). Each Call Station must consists
of a Loudspeaking Unit and a certain number of call keys.
Power to the Call Station must be supplied separately by a dedicated
power supply (e.g. Ref. 786/1A). Connections to the loudspeaking unit
must be made through terminal 1A. The electric lock must be activated
through a Ref. 788/21 repeater relay. The door-opener is always a
free door-opener, i.e. the door can be opened at any time by pressing
the door opener-key.

INSTALLATIONS WITH ONE CALL KEY


A basic installation is one in which several intercoms (type 926/2) are
connected to a Call Station and can all answer a single call key. In
this case, when there is a call, all 926/2 intercoms will ring at the same
time. The first intercom to answer will automatically exclude the other
intercom, thus ensuring conversation privacy. The maximum number

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.2 7

BASIC DIAGRAMS

EASIVOICE

INTERCOM CONNECTION OF MAXIMUM 25 INTERCOM DOOR PHONES


Possibility of general call service by means of loudspeakers

FEATURES

EQUIPMENT

This system allows an intercom service up to 25 intercom door phones


maximum and with possibility of 4 simultaneous and independent
conversations.
It is possible to make a general call by means of a 5th independent
phonic channel.
All the intercom door phones must be programmed with two digits,
i.e. from 01 to 09, from 10 to 19, from 20 to 25, or any other number
between 01 and 97.

For said installation (Scheme SC101-0313E) the following:


N. 25
N. 1

Intercom door phones


Power supply

N. 1

Amplifier
Possible and not supplied by URMET DOMUS
Loudspeakers
Possible and not supplied by URMET DOMUS

N. X

Ref. 926/1
Ref. 926/3

Connect the GENERAL CALL installation only if necessary. It is


recommended that the amplifier be placed as close to the power
supply as possible and be connected to it with a shielded cable.
The power supply Ref. 926/3 is sized for an average installation of 25
intercoms. A larger number of intercoms will require additional power
supplies connected in parallel, each of which will supply power to its
own group of 25.
It is recommended that the power supply Ref. 926/3 be placed at the
center of the installation to minimize the cross-talk effect.

25

24

WIRES
As indicated in Scheme SC101-0313E.
9 wires common to all the intercom door phones coming from the
power supply are necessary.
In case the amplifier is not used for the GENERAL CALL, do not
connect the wire L5 among the several intercoms. The common wires
are reduced to 8.

DIAGRAM NOTES
(see section 1)
CY.001
CY.002
CY.003
CY.004
VX.008

2
9
9

01

EASIVOICE SYSTEM

02

8 sec.2

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

EASIVOICE

AMPLIFIER
(CY.004)

EASIVOICE SYSTEM

(CY.002)

LINE
(VX.008)
POWER SUPPLY

shielded cable

ELECTRONIC INTERCOM SETS Mod.926

LOUDSPEAKER

SC101-0313E

BASIC DIAGRAMS

COLLEGAMENTO INTERCOMUNICANTE DI UN MASSIMO DI


INTERCOM CONNECTION OF MAXIMUM 25 INTERCOM DOOR PHONES
Possibility of general call service by means of loudspeakers

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

sec.2 9

BASIC DIAGRAMS

COLLEGAMENTO INTERCOMUNICANTE DI UN MASSIMO DI


INTERCOM CONNECTION OF MAXIMUM 97 INTERCOM DOOR PHONES
Possibility of general call service by means of loudspeakers

EASIVOICE

FEATURES

EQUIPMENT

This system allows an intercom service up to 97 intercom door phones


maximum and with possibility of 4 simultaneous and independent
conversations.
It is possible to make a general call by means of a 5th independent
phonic channel.
The intercom door phones must all be programmed with two digits,
i.e. from 01 to 09, from 10 to 19, from 20 to 25, or any other number
between 01 and 97.

For said installation (Scheme SC101-0315E) the following:


N. 97
N. 4

Intercom door phones


Power supplies

N. 1

Amplifier
Possible and not supplied by URMET DOMUS
Loudspeakers
Possible and not supplied by URMET DOMUS

N. X

Ref. 926/1
Ref. 926/3

Connect the GENERAL CALL installation only if necessary. It is


recommended that the amplifier be placed as close to the power
supply as possible and be connected to it with a shielded cable.
The power supply Ref. 926/3 is sized for an average installation of 25
intercoms. A larger number of intercoms will require additional power
supplies connected in parallel, each of which will supply power to its
own group of 25.
It is recommended that the power supply Ref. 926/3 be placed at the
center of the installation to minimize the cross-talk effect.

50

2
2

97

As indicated in Scheme SC101-0315E.


7 wires common to all the intercom door phones coming from the
power supply are necessary.
Each power supply feeds its group of 25 intercoms with 2 wires
common to the intercoms of that group.
In case the amplifier is not used for the GENERAL CALL, do not
connect the wire L5 among the several intercoms. The common wires
are reduced to 6.

DIAGRAM NOTES

26

76

25

75

2
2

WIRES

(see section 1)
CY.001
CY.002
CY.003
CY.004
VX.008

01

51
22

EASIVOICE SYSTEM

7 22

10 sec.2

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

(VX.008)
(CY.002)

(VX.008)
(CY.002)

II GROUP

(VX.008)
(CY.002)

III GROUP

(VX.008)
(CY.002)

IV GROUP

II GROUP OF 25 SETS

shielded cable

LINE~
AMPLIFIER
(CY.004)

III GROUP OF 25 SETS

LOUDSPEAKER

IV GROUP OF 22 SETS

SC101-0315E

sec.2 11

BASIC DIAGRAMS

EASIVOICE

EASIVOICE SYSTEM

POWER SUPPLY

I GROUP

I GROUP OF 25 SETS

ELECTRONIC INTERCOM SETS Mod.926

INTERCOM CONNECTION OF MAXIMUM 97 INTERCOM DOOR PHONES


Possibility of general call service by means of loudspeakers

BASIC DIAGRAMS

EASIVOICE

INTERCOM CONNECTION OF MAXIMUM 16 INTERCOM DOOR PHONES


With possibility to answer to 1 outdoor station
All the intercom door phones are called in parallel from the outdoor station

FEATURES

EQUIPMENT

This system allows an intercom service up to 16 intercom door phones


maximum and with possibility to answer to the calls coming from the
outdoor station. It is possible to make 4 simultaneous conversations
among the several intercoms plus one with the outdoor station.
The outdoor station has only one call key. When it is pressed all the
intercom door phones 926/2 ring simultaneously: the first intercom that
answers automatically excludes all the other ones, guaranteeing the
secrecy of conversation.

For said installation (Scheme SC 101-0316G) the following:

The intercom door phones must all be programmed with two digits,
i.e. from 01 to 09, from 10 to 19, from 20 to 25, or any other number
between 01 and 97.
Due to absorption problems, no more than 16 intercoms can be called
in parallel. It is recommended that the power supply Ref. 926/3 be
placed at the center of the installation to minimize the cross-talk
effect.

16

13

N. 16
N. 1

Intercom door phones


Power supply

N. 1

Power supply
for door phone system

N. 1

Relay

Ref. 926/2
Ref. 926/3
28VA
28VA
28VA
38VA

Ref. 786/11
Ref. 786/1
Ref. 786/14
Ref. 786/38
Ref. 788/21

OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES


Mod. Sinthesi
N. 1
Module with door unit set-up
N. 1
Door unit

Ref. 1145/21
Ref. 1145/500

Mod. K-Steel
N. 1
Module with door unit

Ref. 1155/21

Mod. 725
N. 1
Panels with 1 button
N. 1
Door unit

Ref. 725/101
Ref. 5150/500

Domus Aura model


N. 1
Panels with 1 button
N. 1
Door unit

Ref. 1110/1
Ref. 5150/500

NOTE: for correct installation of panels refer to Door phone and


Video door phone Product Technical Manual.

13
02

WIRES

01

As indicated in Scheme SC101-0316G.


13 wires common to all the intercom door phones are necessary, 8 of
which coming from the power supply Ref. 926/3 and 5 from the push
button panel, power supply and relay.

13

13

The electric lock will be released through the relay box Ref. 788/52.

DIAGRAM NOTES

EASIVOICE SYSTEM

(see section 1)
CY.001
CY.002
CY.003
VX.008

12 sec.2

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

POWER SUPPLY

MAINS~

lock
release

U1
G/T

ELECTRIC
LOCK

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0

Name tag
lighting

L5
L4
L3
L2
L1
ML
+12
D
MF

+12

+12

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

EASIVOICE SYSTEM

POWER SUPPLY
FOR HOUSE
PHONE SYSTEM

-A
+A

RELAY

MAINS~

L
1
1A
2
+
-

AP

AP

(CY.002)

2
-/~

-/~

ML

ML

L1

L1

MF

L2

L2

CA

L3

L3

MF

L4

L4

CA

L5

L5

(CY.003)

ELECTRONIC INTERCOM SETS Mod.926 Ref.926/2

INTERCOM CONNECTION OF MAXIMUM 16 INTERCOM DOOR PHONES


With possibility to answer to 1 outdoor station
All the intercom door phones are called in parallel from the outdoor station

SC101-0316G

sec.2 13

BASIC DIAGRAMS

EASIVOICE

BASIC DIAGRAMS

EASIVOICE

INTERCOM CONNECTION OF MAXIMUM 16 INTERCOM DOOR PHONES


With possibility to answer to 1 outdoor station The intercoms are divided in two
groups of 8. The outdoor station is equipped with two keys: with one of them it calls in
parallel the 8 intercoms of group I, with the second one those of group II

FEATURES

EQUIPMENT

This system allows an intercom service up to 16 intercom door phones


maximum and with possibility to answer to the calls coming from the
outdoor station. It is possible to make 4 simultaneous conversations
among the several intercoms plus one with the outdoor station.
The outdoor station has only two call keys: with one of them it calls in
parallel the 8 intercoms of group I, with the second one those of group
II. The first intercom that answers automatically exclude all the other
ones, guaranteeing the secrecy of conversation.

For said installation (Scheme SC 101-0361G) the following:

The intercom door phones must be programmed with two digits, i.e.
from 01 to 09, from 10 to 19, from 20 to 25, or any other number
between 01 and 97.
Due to absorption problems, no more than 16 intercoms can be called
in parallel. It is recommended that the power supply Ref. 926/3 be
placed at the center of the installation to minimize the cross-talk
effect.

08

13

13

13

16

13

02

10

N. 16
N. 1

Intercom door phones


Power supply

N. 1

Power supply
for door phone system

N. 1

Call repeater relay

Ref. 926/2
Ref. 926/3
28VA
28VA
28VA
38VA

Ref. 786/11
Ref. 786/1
Ref. 786/14
Ref. 786/38
Ref. 788/21

OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES


Mod. Sinthesi
N. 1
Module with door unit set-up
N. 1
Door unit

Ref. 1145/22
Ref. 1145/500

Mod. K-Steel
N. 1
Module with door unit

Ref. 1155/22A

Mod. 725
N. 1
Panels with 2 buttons
N. 1
Door unit

Ref. 725/102
Ref. 5150/500

Domus Aura model


N. 1
Panels with 2 buttons
N. 1
Door unit

Ref. 1110/2
Ref. 5150/500

NOTE: for correct installation of panels refer to Door phone and


Video door phone Product Technical Manual.

WIRES
01

13

13

09

14

As indicated in Scheme SC101-0361G.


12 wires common to all the intercom door phones are necessary, 8 of
which coming from the power supply Ref. 926/3 and 4 from the push
button panel, power supply and relay.
Moreover from the push button panel two other wires, for calls, start;
each of them is connected in parallel to the 8 intercoms of the
correspondent group.

10
The electric lock will be released through the relay box Ref. 788/52.

DIAGRAM NOTES

EASIVOICE SYSTEM

(see section 1)
CY.001
CY.002
CY.003
VX.008

14 sec.2

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

-/~

AP

-/~

AP

ELECTRIC
LOCK
MAINS~

EASIVOICE SYSTEM

POWER SUPPLY
FOR DOOR
PHONE SYSTEM

-A
+A

CALL REPEATER RELAY

lock
release

L
1
1A
2
+
-

U2
U1
G/T

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

(CY.002)

POWER SUPPLY

L5
L4
L3
L2
L1
ML
+12
D
MF

MAINS~

(CY.003)

ELECTRONIC INTERCOM SETS Mod.926-Ref.926/2

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0

Name tag
lighting

D
D

+12
+12

ML
ML

L1
L1

MF

L2
L2

CA

L3
L3

CA

L4
L4

MF

L5
L5

SC101-0361G

BASIC DIAGRAMS

INTERCOM CONNECTION OF MAXIMUM 16 INTERCOM DOOR PHONES


With possibility to answer to 1 outdoor station The intercoms are divided in two
EASIVOICE
groups of 8. The outdoor station is equipped with two keys: with one of them it calls in
parallel the 8 intercoms of group I, with the second one those of group II

sec.2 15

BASIC DIAGRAMS

INTERCOM CONNECTION OF MAXIMUM 16 INTERCOM DOOR PHONES


EASIVOICE With possibility to answer to 1 outdoor station. The intercoms are called separately
from theoutdoor station. Possibility of paging service by means of loudspeakers

FEATURES

EQUIPMENT

This system allows an intercom service up to 16 intercom door phones


maximum and with possibility to answer to the calls coming from the
outdoor station. It is possible to make 4 simultaneous conversations
among the several intercoms plus one with the outdoor station.
The outdoor station calls the several intercoms separately.
The intercom door phones must all be programmed with two digits,
i.e. from 01 to 09, from 10 to 19, from 20 to 25, or any other number
between 01 and 97.

For said installation (Scheme SC101-0382F) the following:

The GENERAL CALL must be connected only if necessary. It is


recommended to place the amplifier as close as possible to the power
supply and to connect them with a shielded cable.
Due to absorption problems, no more than 16 intercoms can be called
in parallel. It is recommended that the power supply Ref. 926/3 be
placed at the center of the installation to minimize the cross-talk
effect.

N. 16
N. 1

Intercom door phones


Power supply

N. 1

Power supply
for door phone system

Ref. 926/2
Ref. 926/3
28VA
28VA
28VA
38VA

N. 1

Call repeater relay

N. 1

Amplifier
Possible and not supplied by URMET DOMUS
Loudspeakers
Possible and not supplied by URMET DOMUS

N. X

Ref. 786/11
Ref. 786/1
Ref. 786/14
Ref. 786/38
Ref. 788/21

OUTDOOR STATION REFERENCES

08

14
13+n-7

13+n-2

02

14

13+n-1
01

14

14

13+n-8

09

13+n-9

13+n-14
14

Ref. 1145/20-/21-/22
Ref. 1145/500
Ref. 1145/11-/12-/13-/14

Mod. K-Steel
N. 1
Module with door unit
N. X
Button modules

Ref. 1155/20-/21-/22A
Ref. 1155/11-/12A-/13A-/14A

Mod. 725
N. 1
Panels with 2 buttons
N. 1
Door unit

Ref. 725/102
Ref. 5150/500

Domus Aura model


N. 1
Panels with 2 buttons
N. 1
Door unit

Ref. 1110/2
Ref. 5150/500

15

14
14

Mod. Sinthesi
N. 1
Module with door unit set-up
N. 1
Door unit
N. X
Button modules

NOTE: for correct installation of panels refer to Door phone and


Video door phone Product Technical Manual.

16

WIRES
2

13+n
9+n

As indicated in Scheme SC101-0382F.


13 wires common to all the intercom door phones are necessary, 9 of
which coming from the power supply Ref. 926/3 and 4 from the push
button panel, power supply and relay.
Moreover from the push button panel all single call wires start towards
each intercom.
In case the amplifier is not used for the GENERAL CALL, do not
connect the wire L5 among the several intercoms. The common wires
are reduced to 12.
The electric lock will be released through the relay box Ref. 788/52.

DIAGRAM NOTES

EASIVOICE SYSTEM

(see section 1)
CY.001
CY.002
CY.003
CY.004
VX.008

16 sec.2

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

POWER SUPPLY
(CY.002)

-A
+A

MAINS~

lock
release

AMPLIFIER
(CY.004)

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0
G/T

LOUDSPEAKER

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

EASIVOICE SYSTEM

MAINS~

POWER SUPPLY FOR


DOOR PHONE SYSTEM

L5
L4
L3
L2
L1
ML
+12
D
MF

CALL REPEATER RELAY

L
1
1A
2
+
-

U2
U1
G/T

U4
U3
U2
U1

G/T
~0
~12
~12
~0

ELECTRIC
LOCK

(C4.007)
(C4.008)

AP

AP

TO THE
FOLLOWING
MODULE

-/~

CA

CA

-/~

MF

MF

L1

L1
ML

L2

L2

+12

L3

L3

+12

L4

L4

ML

L5

L5

ELECTRONIC INTERCOM SETS Mod.926-Ref.926/2


(CY.003)

SC101-0382F

sec.2 17

BASIC DIAGRAMS

INTERCOM CONNECTION OF MAXIMUM 16 INTERCOM DOOR PHONES


With possibility to answer to 1 outdoor station. The intercoms are called separately EASIVOICE
from theoutdoor station. Possibility of paging service by means of loudspeakers

BASIC DIAGRAMS
EASIVOICE SYSTEM

EASIVOICE

18 sec.2

DOOR PHONE - VIDEO DOOR PHONE SYSTEMS: Installation Diagrams

load

n
Dow

FRE

Today, you can observe, retrieve information, choose and add all Urmet Domus products to your system estimate with a few simply clicks of a
mouse on your computer without having to browse, read and understand catalogues and manuals.
This and more thanks to our Domus Draw program which has now become an indispensable working tool for professionals (installers,
wholesalers, retrofitters, architects, etc.).
Domus Draw implements a few, simple commands for:
Creating and saving all system estimates either automatically and/or manually.
Printing estimates to paper or pdf file.
Creating system estimates using different user modes.
Retrieving information about systems and applications by consulting instruction booklets and technical documents of the various products or
consulting the wiring diagrams of the system to be created.
Watching demo footage with sound for easily understanding how to use the program.
Connecting to the Urmet Domus web site to find out about new features and get real-time updates.
Searching for cost-effective, ready-to-use kits which can be adapted to your system needs.
Saving and printing all your customer data in a specific database.
Browsing a comprehensive photograph and description database presenting all Urmet Domus products in detail.
Accessing these functions is very easy: just press the corresponding function button on the program home page:

Domus Draw can be downloaded free of charge from www.urmetdomus.com

You might also like